US20050018636A1 - Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels - Google Patents
Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20050018636A1 US20050018636A1 US10/922,427 US92242704A US2005018636A1 US 20050018636 A1 US20050018636 A1 US 20050018636A1 US 92242704 A US92242704 A US 92242704A US 2005018636 A1 US2005018636 A1 US 2005018636A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- time
- channel
- frequency
- information signals
- time slots
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Abandoned
Links
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 121
- 238000012545 processing Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 88
- 238000004891 communication Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 40
- 230000005540 biological transmission Effects 0.000 claims description 82
- 239000000872 buffer Substances 0.000 claims description 49
- 230000002441 reversible effect Effects 0.000 claims description 27
- 230000010363 phase shift Effects 0.000 claims description 9
- 230000003252 repetitive effect Effects 0.000 abstract description 3
- 238000012546 transfer Methods 0.000 description 103
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 description 73
- 230000006870 function Effects 0.000 description 66
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 description 30
- 238000001514 detection method Methods 0.000 description 22
- 238000010586 diagram Methods 0.000 description 22
- 230000001360 synchronised effect Effects 0.000 description 14
- 230000009471 action Effects 0.000 description 13
- 230000006835 compression Effects 0.000 description 13
- 238000007906 compression Methods 0.000 description 13
- 239000003550 marker Substances 0.000 description 13
- 230000001934 delay Effects 0.000 description 12
- 238000012549 training Methods 0.000 description 12
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 11
- 238000006243 chemical reaction Methods 0.000 description 10
- 238000012360 testing method Methods 0.000 description 10
- 238000009432 framing Methods 0.000 description 9
- 238000005070 sampling Methods 0.000 description 9
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 description 6
- 230000003111 delayed effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- 230000002093 peripheral effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- 230000000630 rising effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- 238000003786 synthesis reaction Methods 0.000 description 6
- 238000004364 calculation method Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000001419 dependent effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 238000013461 design Methods 0.000 description 5
- 238000002955 isolation Methods 0.000 description 5
- 238000012986 modification Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000004048 modification Effects 0.000 description 5
- 238000010845 search algorithm Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000007704 transition Effects 0.000 description 5
- 230000003139 buffering effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000013078 crystal Substances 0.000 description 4
- 238000001914 filtration Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000012544 monitoring process Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000005562 fading Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000000977 initiatory effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000003780 insertion Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000037431 insertion Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000011159 matrix material Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000007246 mechanism Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000011664 signaling Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000010200 validation analysis Methods 0.000 description 3
- 241000722270 Regulus Species 0.000 description 2
- 230000003044 adaptive effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000004458 analytical method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000013459 approach Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000015556 catabolic process Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000013479 data entry Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000006731 degradation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000009977 dual effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000005259 measurement Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000010926 purge Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000003595 spectral effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000001228 spectrum Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000008093 supporting effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 241000590419 Polygonia interrogationis Species 0.000 description 1
- 230000018199 S phase Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000003213 activating effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000003321 amplification Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000008901 benefit Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002457 bidirectional effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000903 blocking effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000009172 bursting Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000005465 channeling Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002860 competitive effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000295 complement effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012937 correction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000004122 cyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 238000000586 desensitisation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000005516 engineering process Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000009434 installation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002452 interceptive effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012423 maintenance Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000014759 maintenance of location Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007726 management method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000013507 mapping Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000000203 mixture Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000003199 nucleic acid amplification method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000002360 preparation method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000011084 recovery Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000012163 sequencing technique Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000000638 solvent extraction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000036962 time dependent Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001960 triggered effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000013598 vector Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000012795 verification Methods 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W84/00—Network topologies
- H04W84/02—Hierarchically pre-organised networks, e.g. paging networks, cellular networks, WLAN [Wireless Local Area Network] or WLL [Wireless Local Loop]
- H04W84/10—Small scale networks; Flat hierarchical networks
- H04W84/14—WLL [Wireless Local Loop]; RLL [Radio Local Loop]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04M—TELEPHONIC COMMUNICATION
- H04M1/00—Substation equipment, e.g. for use by subscribers
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04B—TRANSMISSION
- H04B7/00—Radio transmission systems, i.e. using radiation field
- H04B7/02—Diversity systems; Multi-antenna system, i.e. transmission or reception using multiple antennas
- H04B7/04—Diversity systems; Multi-antenna system, i.e. transmission or reception using multiple antennas using two or more spaced independent antennas
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04B—TRANSMISSION
- H04B7/00—Radio transmission systems, i.e. using radiation field
- H04B7/02—Diversity systems; Multi-antenna system, i.e. transmission or reception using multiple antennas
- H04B7/04—Diversity systems; Multi-antenna system, i.e. transmission or reception using multiple antennas using two or more spaced independent antennas
- H04B7/08—Diversity systems; Multi-antenna system, i.e. transmission or reception using multiple antennas using two or more spaced independent antennas at the receiving station
- H04B7/0837—Diversity systems; Multi-antenna system, i.e. transmission or reception using multiple antennas using two or more spaced independent antennas at the receiving station using pre-detection combining
- H04B7/0842—Weighted combining
- H04B7/0865—Independent weighting, i.e. weights based on own antenna reception parameters
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/0001—Systems modifying transmission characteristics according to link quality, e.g. power backoff
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/0001—Systems modifying transmission characteristics according to link quality, e.g. power backoff
- H04L1/0002—Systems modifying transmission characteristics according to link quality, e.g. power backoff by adapting the transmission rate
- H04L1/0003—Systems modifying transmission characteristics according to link quality, e.g. power backoff by adapting the transmission rate by switching between different modulation schemes
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/0001—Systems modifying transmission characteristics according to link quality, e.g. power backoff
- H04L1/0006—Systems modifying transmission characteristics according to link quality, e.g. power backoff by adapting the transmission format
- H04L1/0007—Systems modifying transmission characteristics according to link quality, e.g. power backoff by adapting the transmission format by modifying the frame length
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/004—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using forward error control
- H04L1/0056—Systems characterized by the type of code used
- H04L1/0057—Block codes
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/0078—Avoidance of errors by organising the transmitted data in a format specifically designed to deal with errors, e.g. location
- H04L1/0084—Formats for payload data
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/02—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by diversity reception
- H04L1/06—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by diversity reception using space diversity
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/12—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using return channel
- H04L1/16—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using return channel in which the return channel carries supervisory signals, e.g. repetition request signals
- H04L1/1607—Details of the supervisory signal
- H04L1/1642—Formats specially adapted for sequence numbers
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/12—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using return channel
- H04L1/16—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using return channel in which the return channel carries supervisory signals, e.g. repetition request signals
- H04L1/18—Automatic repetition systems, e.g. Van Duuren systems
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/12—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using return channel
- H04L1/16—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using return channel in which the return channel carries supervisory signals, e.g. repetition request signals
- H04L1/18—Automatic repetition systems, e.g. Van Duuren systems
- H04L1/1867—Arrangements specially adapted for the transmitter end
- H04L1/188—Time-out mechanisms
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/12—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using return channel
- H04L1/16—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using return channel in which the return channel carries supervisory signals, e.g. repetition request signals
- H04L1/18—Automatic repetition systems, e.g. Van Duuren systems
- H04L1/1867—Arrangements specially adapted for the transmitter end
- H04L1/1887—Scheduling and prioritising arrangements
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L5/00—Arrangements affording multiple use of the transmission path
- H04L5/14—Two-way operation using the same type of signal, i.e. duplex
- H04L5/143—Two-way operation using the same type of signal, i.e. duplex for modulated signals
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W40/00—Communication routing or communication path finding
- H04W40/02—Communication route or path selection, e.g. power-based or shortest path routing
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W52/00—Power management, e.g. Transmission Power Control [TPC] or power classes
- H04W52/04—Transmission power control [TPC]
- H04W52/18—TPC being performed according to specific parameters
- H04W52/20—TPC being performed according to specific parameters using error rate
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W72/00—Local resource management
- H04W72/04—Wireless resource allocation
- H04W72/044—Wireless resource allocation based on the type of the allocated resource
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W72/00—Local resource management
- H04W72/04—Wireless resource allocation
- H04W72/044—Wireless resource allocation based on the type of the allocated resource
- H04W72/0446—Resources in time domain, e.g. slots or frames
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W88/00—Devices specially adapted for wireless communication networks, e.g. terminals, base stations or access point devices
- H04W88/08—Access point devices
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04J—MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
- H04J3/00—Time-division multiplex systems
- H04J3/02—Details
- H04J3/06—Synchronising arrangements
- H04J3/0635—Clock or time synchronisation in a network
- H04J3/0638—Clock or time synchronisation among nodes; Internode synchronisation
- H04J3/0647—Synchronisation among TDM nodes
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04J—MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
- H04J3/00—Time-division multiplex systems
- H04J3/02—Details
- H04J3/06—Synchronising arrangements
- H04J3/0635—Clock or time synchronisation in a network
- H04J3/0682—Clock or time synchronisation in a network by delay compensation, e.g. by compensation of propagation delay or variations thereof, by ranging
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/0001—Systems modifying transmission characteristics according to link quality, e.g. power backoff
- H04L1/0023—Systems modifying transmission characteristics according to link quality, e.g. power backoff characterised by the signalling
- H04L1/0026—Transmission of channel quality indication
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/004—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by using forward error control
- H04L1/0056—Systems characterized by the type of code used
- H04L1/0061—Error detection codes
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L1/00—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received
- H04L1/08—Arrangements for detecting or preventing errors in the information received by repeating transmission, e.g. Verdan system
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W24/00—Supervisory, monitoring or testing arrangements
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W28/00—Network traffic management; Network resource management
- H04W28/02—Traffic management, e.g. flow control or congestion control
- H04W28/06—Optimizing the usage of the radio link, e.g. header compression, information sizing, discarding information
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W28/00—Network traffic management; Network resource management
- H04W28/02—Traffic management, e.g. flow control or congestion control
- H04W28/10—Flow control between communication endpoints
- H04W28/14—Flow control between communication endpoints using intermediate storage
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W28/00—Network traffic management; Network resource management
- H04W28/16—Central resource management; Negotiation of resources or communication parameters, e.g. negotiating bandwidth or QoS [Quality of Service]
- H04W28/24—Negotiating SLA [Service Level Agreement]; Negotiating QoS [Quality of Service]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W28/00—Network traffic management; Network resource management
- H04W28/16—Central resource management; Negotiation of resources or communication parameters, e.g. negotiating bandwidth or QoS [Quality of Service]
- H04W28/26—Resource reservation
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W36/00—Hand-off or reselection arrangements
- H04W36/12—Reselecting a serving backbone network switching or routing node
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W4/00—Services specially adapted for wireless communication networks; Facilities therefor
- H04W4/18—Information format or content conversion, e.g. adaptation by the network of the transmitted or received information for the purpose of wireless delivery to users or terminals
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W52/00—Power management, e.g. Transmission Power Control [TPC] or power classes
- H04W52/02—Power saving arrangements
- H04W52/0209—Power saving arrangements in terminal devices
- H04W52/0212—Power saving arrangements in terminal devices managed by the network, e.g. network or access point is leader and terminal is follower
- H04W52/0216—Power saving arrangements in terminal devices managed by the network, e.g. network or access point is leader and terminal is follower using a pre-established activity schedule, e.g. traffic indication frame
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W56/00—Synchronisation arrangements
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W72/00—Local resource management
- H04W72/02—Selection of wireless resources by user or terminal
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W72/00—Local resource management
- H04W72/04—Wireless resource allocation
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W72/00—Local resource management
- H04W72/04—Wireless resource allocation
- H04W72/044—Wireless resource allocation based on the type of the allocated resource
- H04W72/0453—Resources in frequency domain, e.g. a carrier in FDMA
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W72/00—Local resource management
- H04W72/12—Wireless traffic scheduling
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W72/00—Local resource management
- H04W72/20—Control channels or signalling for resource management
- H04W72/23—Control channels or signalling for resource management in the downlink direction of a wireless link, i.e. towards a terminal
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W74/00—Wireless channel access
- H04W74/04—Scheduled access
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W76/00—Connection management
- H04W76/10—Connection setup
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04W—WIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
- H04W84/00—Network topologies
-
- Y—GENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
- Y02—TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
- Y02D—CLIMATE CHANGE MITIGATION TECHNOLOGIES IN INFORMATION AND COMMUNICATION TECHNOLOGIES [ICT], I.E. INFORMATION AND COMMUNICATION TECHNOLOGIES AIMING AT THE REDUCTION OF THEIR OWN ENERGY USE
- Y02D30/00—Reducing energy consumption in communication networks
- Y02D30/70—Reducing energy consumption in communication networks in wireless communication networks
Definitions
- a system for the wireless transmission of multiple information signals utilizing digital time division circuits between a base station and a plurality of subscriber stations.
- the subscriber stations may be fixed or movable.
- the movable subscriber stations may be relatively fast and relatively slow moving.
- the number of time division circuits is determined by the transmission quality of the signals.
- the base station is interconnected with an external information network, which may be analog and/or digital.
- the information signals are selected from the group consisting of voice, data, facsimile, video, computer and instrumentation signals.
- the modulation level of the signals and the power applied to the system are adjusted in accordance with signal error detection in the system.
- the system is provided with spatial diversity by using a plurality of antennas selectively spaced from each other to provide relatively high signal reception despite signal fading.
- the base station operates over a plurality of RF channel pairs.
- Each channel pair operation is implemented by the combination of a transmit channel circuit for processing a given plural number of information signals received simultaneously over telephone company trunk lines for simultaneous transmission to different subscriber stations over a given radio frequency (RF) channel, and a receive channel circuit for processing a plurality of signals received simultaneously over a given RF channel from different subscriber stations to provide information signals for transmission over the trunk lines.
- RF radio frequency
- Separate conversion devices are respectively connected to each of the trunk lines for converting the information signals received over the trunk lines into digital signal samples.
- the transmit channel circuit includes a given plural number of separate signal compression devices for simultaneously compressing the digital signal samples respectively derived from separate ones of the conversion devices to provide the given number of separate compressed signals; a channel control unit connected to the compression devices for sequentially combining the compressed signals into a single transmit channel bit stream, with each of the respective compressed signals occupying a repetitive sequential slot position in the transmit channel bit stream associated with a predetermined one of the separate compression devices and a unit for providing a transmit channel signal for transmission over the predetermined RF channel in response to the transmit channel bit stream.
- An exchange couples the respective separate conversion devices to indicated ones of the separate compression devices.
- a remote-connection processor unit is coupled to the trunk lines and responds to an incoming call request signal received over one of the trunk lines by providing a slot assignment signal indicating which one of the separate compression devices the exchange is to connect to the one of the separate conversion devices connected to the one trunk line, and thereby assigns to the one trunk line the slot in the transmit channel bit stream associated with the one of the separate compression devices that is so connected by the exchange.
- the remote-connection processor maintains a memory of which slots are so assigned and consults such memory upon receipt of an incoming call request and then provides the slot assignment signal that effects the connection to a compression device associated with one of the slots that is not assigned to another trunk line.
- a call processor is connected to the remote-connection processor and responds to the slot assignment signal by causing the exchange to complete the connection indicated by the slot assignment signal.
- the receive channel circuit includes a receiver unit for receiving a receive channel signal and for processing the receive channel signal to provide a receive channel bit stream containing separate compressed signals in different respective repetitive sequential slot positions; a given plural number of separate signal synthesis devices each associated with a different slot position in the receive channel bit stream for reconstructing digital signal samples from separate compressed signals contained in the associated respective slot positions of the receive channel bit stream; and a control unit for segregating the separate compressed signals from the receive channel bit stream and distributing the segregated signals to the separate synthesis devices associated with the respective time slots from which the signals are segregated.
- Each of the separate reconversion devices are respectively connected to each of the trunk lines for reconverting digital signal samples to information signals for transmission over the respective trunk lines.
- Each of the separate reconversion means is associated with one of the separate conversion means and is connected to a common one of the trunk lines with the associated separate conversion means.
- the exchange couples the respective separate reconversion devices to indicated ones of the separate synthesis devices.
- the remote-connection processor responds to the incoming call request signal received over the one trunk line by providing a slot assignment signal for indicating which one of the separate synthesis devices the exchange is to connect to the one of the separate reconversion devices connected to the one trunk line and thereby assigns to the one trunk line the slot in the receive channel bit stream associated with the one of the separate synthesis devices that is so connected by the exchange means.
- the remote-connection processor maintains a memory of which slots in the receive channel bit stream are so assigned and consults such memory upon receipt of the incoming call request and then provides to the call processor the slot assignment signal for effecting the connection to a synthesis device associated with one of the slots that is not assigned to another trunk line.
- the system of the present invention makes use of advanced digital and large-scale-integration electronics techniques to bring low-cost, reliable, high-quality communications to various market segments.
- One preferred embodiment uses a fixed base station installation centrally located to communicate with a large number of subscriber stations placed in the nearby geographic area.
- the central base station may be connected to a central office of a public switched telephone company (Telco) network through a private branch exchange switch (PBX) connected to incoming telephone trunks.
- PBX private branch exchange switch
- the subscriber stations in the system may be either fixed-base portable or mobile in nature, and may be operational in either relatively slow or fast motion.
- the subscriber stations communicate with the base station via UHF radio channels and with the user via standard two-wire DTMF touchtone telephone equipment or via RS-232C or via non-standard phone stations (e.g., 4-wire).
- the system may be used to replace existing hard-wired local subscriber loops or to provide quality telephone service to areas where wired connections are not feasible or economical.
- One feature of the system of the present invention is the ability to use time division multiple access (TDMA) and digital speech encoding to allow simultaneous multiple use of frequencies within a given network.
- TDMA time division multiple access
- Any feasible number of high-quality voice circuits may be operating on a given frequency channel (with 25 KHz channel spacing) at a time. Four such circuits are used for illustrative purposes. This provides both a spectral and an economic advantage over existing analog radio-phone systems which can provide for only one conversation at a time on a given frequency channel.
- a much larger population of subscribers must be accommodated than can be supported simultaneously on a given pair of 25 KHz channels.
- a 12-channel-pair system which supported 47 simultaneous calls might have a total off-hook plus on-hook population of 500 subscribers (with the maximum constrained by the desired peak-hour blocking probability).
- a subscriber call-request control scheme which provides reasonable call-connection delays is also an important feature of the present invention.
- FIG. 1 is block diagram generally showing the RF subscriber telephone system of the present invention.
- FIG. 2 is a block diagram of a representative preferred embodiment of the base station in the system of FIG. 1 ;
- FIG. 3 is a block diagram of a preferred embodiment of a subscriber station in the system of FIG. 1 .
- FIG. 4 illustrates the sequence of messages generated by the subscriber stations and the base station to establish a connection between two subscriber stations.
- FIG. 5 illustrates various data processing modules implemented in the remote-control processor unit (RPU) in the base station of FIG. 2 .
- RPU remote-control processor unit
- FIG. 6 illustrates the processing of incoming and outgoing BCC messages by the RPU in the base station of FIG. 2 .
- FIG. 7 illustrates the processing of incoming and outgoing PBX messages by the RPU in the base station of FIG. 2 .
- FIG. 8 illustrates the processing of logger messages by the RPU in the base station of FIG. 2 .
- FIG. 9 illustrates a memory map of the RPU in the base station of FIG. 2 .
- FIG. 10 illustrates the processing of messages relating to the RCC state by the message processing module (MPM) shown in FIG. 5 .
- MPM message processing module
- FIG. 11 illustrates the processing of messages relating to the channel state by the message processing MPM shown in FIG. 5 .
- FIG. 12 is a block diagram of the subscriber terminal interface unit (STU) in the subscriber station of FIG. 3 .
- STU subscriber terminal interface unit
- FIG. 13 shows the signal interface between the PBX and the VCU in the base station of FIG. 2 .
- FIG. 14 shows the signal interface between the STU and the VCU in the subscriber station of FIG. 2 .
- FIG. 15 shows the timing relationships for the PBX-VCU interface signals shown in FIG. 13 and for the STU-VCU interface signals shown in FIG. 14 .
- FIG. 16 shows the signal interface between the VCU and the CCU in both the base station of FIG. 2 and the subscriber station of FIG. 3 .
- FIG. 17 shows the timing relationship for the transmit channel signals of the VCU-CCU signal interface shown in FIG. 16 .
- FIG. 18 shows the timing relationship for the receive channel signals of the VCU-CCU signal interface shown in FIG. 16 .
- FIGS. 19A and 19B respectively show the timing relationships for the transmit and receive speech blocks that are transferred between the VCU and CCU for 16-level PSK modulation.
- FIG. 20A shows the input and output data timing and content for the receive channel between the VCU and the PBX (or STU) for 16-level PSK modulation.
- FIG. 20B shows the input and output data timing and content for the transmit channel between the VCU and the PBX (or STU) for 16-level PSK modulation.
- FIG. 21 (on Sheet 5) is a block diagram of the CCU of both the base station of FIG. 2 and the subscriber station of FIG. 3 .
- FIG. 22 shows the software-implemented functional architecture of the CCU of FIG. 21 .
- FIG. 23 is a timing diagram for transferring RCC and 16-level PSK voice data on the transmit bus of the CCU of FIG. 22 .
- FIG. 24 is a timing diagram for transferring RCC and 16-level PSK voice data on the receive bus of the CCU of FIG. 23 .
- FIG. 25 (on sheet 3) is a block diagram of the modem of the base station of FIG. 2 and the subscriber station of FIG. 3 .
- FIG. 26 shows the signal interface between the CCU, the modem and the STIMU in the base station of FIG. 2 .
- FIG. 27 shows the signal interface between the modem and the RFU in the base station of FIG. 2 and in the subscriber station of FIG. 3 .
- FIG. 28 is a block diagram of the antenna interface circuit for the subscriber station of FIG. 3 .
- FIG. 29 is a block diagram of the antenna interface circuit for the base station of FIG. 2 .
- the illustrated system operates on common carrier frequency channel pairs within the 454 MHz to 460 MHz band.
- This particular set of frequencies contains 26 specified channels.
- the channels are spaced 25 KHz apart with an authorized bandwidth of 20 KHz. Spacing between transmit and receive channels is 5 MHz with the center frequency of the lower of the two frequencies being assigned to the base station transmissions.
- the system may also operate on other UHF channel pairs.
- the mode of transmission from the base station to the subscriber station is time division multiplexed (TDM).
- the transmission from the subscriber station to base station is time division multiple access (TDMA).
- Communication between the base station 11 and the subscriber stations 10 is accomplished digitally by filtered multiphase differential phase shift keying (MDPSK) modulation on 25 KHz spaced full duplex channels in the 454 to 460 MHz band, thereby satisfying the requirements of 20 KHz bandwidth such as designated in FCC rule Parts 21, 22 and 90 (e.g., 21.105, 22.105 and 90.209).
- MDPSK multiphase differential phase shift keying
- This system may also be used for other band widths and spacings within any feasible portion of the VHF, UHF and SHF spectrums.
- the base station is capable of transmitting and receiving on any or all of the available FCC 25 KHz spaced frequency channels in the 454 to 460 MHz band wherein the channels are selectable.
- Channel frequency selection for each voice channel is accomplished automatically by the base station, one at a time, but may be overridden at an operator console interface provided at the base station.
- the base station may have a transmitter power output of, typically, 100 watts for each frequency channel.
- the base station provides modulation control, and time slot and frequency channel assignments to the subscriber stations.
- adaptive power control over the subscriber stations is exercised by the base station to minimize sequential time slot differences and adjacent channel interference.
- Switching among Telco (telephone company) trunk lines and the TDM slots on the selected channel is accomplished by the base station using preferably a digital switch, although it is possible to substitute an analog switch.
- the subscriber station is capable of operating with three branch diversity.
- the transmitter power is typically adjustable between 0.1 and 25 watts, but it can be adjusted over other ranges of power. While voice communications through the subscriber station are perceived as being real time full-duplex, the RF system operates at half-duplex by utilizing appropriate time division multiplex timing methods.
- the subscriber station interfaces with any telephone instrument for voice communications, or the telephone may be built into the system.
- a data connection such as an RS-232C standard 25-pin connection is provided for 9600 band rate data transmission between subscribers.
- the base station and the subscriber station may obtain operating power from any feasible source, either internal or external.
- FIG. 2 is a block diagram of an embodiment of the base station that supports the simultaneous operation of two pairs of transmit and receive frequency channels.
- Each channel can process up to four phone connections simultaneously.
- the PBX 15 is a model UTX-250 system, an off-the-shelf product developed by the United Technologies Building Systems Group. Many of the existing features of the generic PBX system are utilized in the control of Telco interfaces required in the system of the present invention.
- the PBX 15 also converts voice information to/from the PSTN to 64 Kbps .mu.-law companded pulse coded modulation (PCM) digital samples. From this point on, the voice information is processed in a digital format throughout the base station and the subscriber stations, right up to the interface circuitry connecting to the subscriber telephone, or as far as the subscriber transmitter and receiver permits.
- PCM pulse coded modulation
- Digital voice information from the PBX 15 is next processed by a voice compression system known as a codec 16 , which reduces the voice information rate from 64 Kbps to approximately 14.6 Kbps or less.
- the codec 16 uses either a Residual Excited Linear Predictive (RELP) algorithm or an SBC encoder-decoder to perform this voice rate compression.
- RELP Residual Excited Linear Predictive
- SBC encoder-decoder SBC encoder-decoder
- four codecs 16 reside in a single voice codec unit (VCU) 17 for performing voice compression for the four or more time slots in each frequency channel.
- Each base station VCU 17 can process four or more full-duplex voice connections for both the transmit channel and the receive channel of each channel pair. Connections by the PBX 15 determine which voice call is processed by which VCU 17 and by which codec 16 in the selected VCU 17 .
- the circuits of each VCU 17 are hardware-mapped such that a voice call an a specific frequency and slot assignment
- Properly formatted transmit data from each CCU 18 is transferred at a 16K symbol/second rate to the modem corresponding 19 .
- Each modem 19 takes these synchronous symbols and converts them to a Gray-coded multi-level phase shift keyed (PSK) format.
- the transmit channel output of the modem 19 is a modulated IF signal.
- This signal is fed into the RF/IF processing unit (RFU) 21 which then converts the IF signal to the RF UHF signal in the 450 MHz range.
- Control signals for the modem 19 and the RFU 21 are provided by the corresponding CCU 18 , working under the overall control of the RPU 20 .
- the UHF signal is amplified by power amplifiers in the RFU 21 and transferred through an antenna interface unit 22 to a transmit antenna 23 for open-air broadcast.
- the remote-control processor unit (RPU) 20 is the central control processor which conveys connection data and control messages to the CCU.
- the RPU 20 includes a general-purpose computer based on a Model 6800 microprocessor which performs the sophisticated system management functions and control mechanisms for call setup, teardown, and maintenance.
- the RPU 20 also communicates with a call processor 24 in the PBX 15 to control the interconnections between the codecs 16 and the Telco trunks accomplished by a switch matrix 25 of the PBX 15 .
- Each subscriber station is a relatively small unit which is located at each user site in the system.
- the subscriber station connects the user's standard telephone set and/or data terminal or integrated acoustical transmitter/receiver to the base station through the UHF radio channel.
- the subscriber station's function is very similar to that of the base station. However, whereas the base station can operate on one or more frequency channels simultaneously, each offering the capacity to support several voice circuits, the subscriber station normally operates on only one frequency at a time.
- FIG. 3 is a block diagram of a subscriber station.
- the functional partitioning is very similar to that of the base station ( FIG. 2 ).
- the user interface function is performed by the subscriber telephone interlace unit (STU) in the subscriber station.
- the associated function in the base station is performed by the PBX module.
- the STU in the subscriber station also performs all control functions of the subscriber station just as the RPU functions in the base station.
- the subscriber stations act as slaves to the master base station in the overall system control architecture.
- the STU may interface with an external instrument or may transmit and receive acoustically.
- the user voice or data information is first processed by a subscriber terminal unit (STU) 27 .
- the voice signal inputs from the user telephone are received and digitized in the VCU 28 .
- the format for the digitized voice signals is identical to the format used by the PBX 15 in the base station.
- the subscriber station includes a VCU 28 , CCU 29 , modem 30 a and a RFU 31 a that perform similar functions as the like units described above in the base station architecture description related to FIG. 2 .
- One difference in the subscriber station operation is that usually it is limited to only one voice channel at a time.
- the half-duplex operation of the subscriber station offers opportunity to make more efficient use of the available subscriber station hardware.
- the subscriber station VCU and CCU function in essentially identical manner as in the base station, at least as far as voice data handling is concerned.
- the modem 30 a is set up to operate in a half-duplex mode so that either the receive or transmit portion of the modem are used, but not at the same time.
- the primary savings here is that the RFU 31 a need only operate in half-duplex mode. This saves power in that the RF power amplifier is active for no more than half the time.
- the RF transmit antenna 32 a can be switched to operate as a second receive antenna during the receive portions of the frame using an RF antenna switch function. Furthermore, no duplexer is required.
- Each subscriber station also includes a diversity network including three modems and a diversity combiner circuit 33 .
- the diversity combiner circuit 33 gathers demodulated receive information from each of the demods of the three modems 30 a , 30 b , 30 c and combines the three streams to form a single “best-guess” symbol stream which is then sent on to the CCU 29 to process.
- the demodulation circuits or demods in the three modems 30 a , 30 b , 30 c are connected to separate RX RFUs 31 a , 31 b , 31 c and thereby to separate antennas 32 a , 32 b , 32 c.
- three receiver antennas 34 a , 34 b and 34 c are placed an appropriate distance from each other to provide uncorrelated spatially diverse signals to be processed by a diversity network.
- the operation of the diversity network is transparent to the CCU function and therefore can be replaced by a single modem function at any time that the diversity function is not required.
- the base station also includes a spatial diversity network for each transmit and receive channel pair.
- the base station diagram of FIG. 2 is the same as that shown in the subscriber station diagram of FIG. 3 , which shows the connection of the diversity network for a single transmit and receive channel pair.
- each transmit and receive channel pair in the base station actually contains three demods and one modem connected to a diversity combiner circuit as shown in FIG. 3 .
- Timing synchronization between base station and the subscriber stations is critical in the overall system.
- the master timing base for the entire system is provided by the base station. All subscriber units in a given system must synchronize to this time base, in terms of frequency, symbol timing and frame timing.
- the base station includes a system timing unit (STIMU) 35 which provides a high accuracy timing reference clock signal at 80.000 MHz.
- This 80 MHz reference clock signal is divided down to produce a 16 KHz clock signal and a 22.222 Hz (45 msec duration) frame strobe marker signal. All base station transmit timing is generated from these three synchronous master references.
- the 80 MHz clock signal is used by the modems 19 and the RFUs 21 for accurate IF and RF frequency bases.
- the 16 KHz clock signal provides the symbol rate timing for transmissions on all base station frequencies.
- the 45 msec marker signal is used to denote the first symbol in a new frame. This marker is active for a period of one symbol time (62.5 microseconds, equal to ⁇ fraction (1/16000) ⁇ Hz).
- the three timing signals (80 MHz, 16 KHz and start of frame ⁇ SOF ⁇ marker) are provided to each modem 19 in the base station.
- the modem 19 distributes the appropriate clock signals to the CCU 18 and RFU 21 in the same series-connected transmit and receive channel pair.
- the 16 KHz and SOF marker are used by the CCU 18 to time the transmission of voice and control symbols according to the current frame structure on that frequency.
- the receive timing in the base station is ideally identical to the base station transmit timing. That is, the SOF marker and symbol clock signals should be exactly lined up between the transmit and receive signals.
- the base station modem's 19 receive timing must match the incoming symbols from the subscriber station. This is required so that the sampling period in the base station modem 19 receive function provides the best estimate of the symbol being received from the subscriber station.
- a small elastic buffer in the CCU 18 interfaced with the modem 19 receive function compensates for this slight timing skew.
- the subscriber stations in the overall system synchronize their time references to the master time base in the base station. This synchronization is achieved through a multiple step procedure whereby the subscriber station initially acquires the base station time reference through the use of the RCC messages from the base station. This procedure is described below.
- a tracking algorithm in the demods of the subscriber station modems 30 a , 30 b , 30 c keeps the subscriber station receive timing accurate.
- the subscriber station advances its own transmissions back to the base station by a small amount of time to offset the transmission round-trip delay due to the subscriber station ranging. This method results in the transmission from all subscriber stations being received by the base station in proper phase in relation to each other.
- the system timing unit (STIMU) 35 provides the time base for all transmissions in the base station.
- the STIMU 35 includes a high-accuracy (3.times.10-9) ovenized crystal oscillator operating at a fixed frequency of 80 MHz. This basic clock frequency is divided by 5000 in the STIMU 35 to form the 16 KHz symbol clock signal and again by 720 to form a start of frame (SOF) marker signal. These three time references are buffered and provided to each of the base station modems.
- the subscriber timing unit (SUBTU) (not shown in FIG. 3 ) provides a 80 MHz clock signal, a 16 KHz symbol timing signal and a 45 msec duration frame marker signal for the subscriber stations. These signals are identical to those in the base station STIMU, except that the 16 KHz clock signal is used as the receive symbol timing in the subscriber station. The 16 KHz clock signal is used for transmit timing in the base station. Transmit timing in the subscriber station is provided by a delayed version of the subscriber station receive timing. The delay is a variable amount determined by the ranging computation performed between the base station and the subscriber station.
- the timing reference signal for the subscriber station is provided by a voltage controlled crystal oscillator (VCXO) operating at a nominal 80 MHz frequency.
- VCXO voltage controlled crystal oscillator
- the actual frequency is adjusted by the subscriber station modem to be frequency locked to the base station timing reference as received at the subscriber RF unit input.
- the system uses 20 KHz BW full duplex channels in the 450 MHz spectral region on 25 KHz centers and accommodates several simultaneous conversations per channel.
- Each full duplex channel consists of a receive and a transmit frequency separated by 5 MHz.
- the lower frequency of each channel is assigned to the base station for transmission and is called the forward frequency.
- the higher frequency of each channel, called the reverse frequency is assigned to the subscriber stations for transmission.
- the base station transmits on the forward frequency and receives on the reverse frequency. The opposite is true for the subscriber stations.
- the capability of the system to provide a spectrally efficient method of transmitting up several voice channels on a single frequency is primarily dependent on the modem operation.
- the modem 19 must operate in such a manner as to provide 3.2 bits/Hz efficiency when operating in a 16-phase DPSK mode at a 16K symbol/second rate.
- the modem 19 is strictly a mechanism to convert the 1, 2, 4 or more bit symbols from the CCU 18 to a phase-modulated IF carrier for transmission, and to reverse the process on the receive side. All control for frame timing and mode selection is performed by the CCU 18 .
- An interface between the CCU 18 and modem 19 may consist of two four-bit unidirectional synchronous (16K symbols/second) data busses (Tx and Rx).
- Tx and Rx unidirectional synchronous (16K symbols/second) data busses
- an 8-bit status/control bus provides control information to the modem and reports status from the modem to the CCU 18 .
- the modem 19 also provides the CCU 18 with the master 16 KHz symbol clock signal.
- this clock signal is received from the master oscillator in the system timing unit 35 , to which the entire base station (and therefore the entire system) is synchronized.
- this clock is derived from the incoming symbols received from the base station. Therefore, all transmissions are referenced to the time base in the base station.
- a major function of the subscriber modem operation is to synchronize the local subscriber clock signal to the base station time reference by decoding the timing from the received symbols.
- the modem transmitter modulator section uses an FIR digital filter to create a digital representation of the waveform which is used to modulate the RF carrier.
- the resultant digital stream is converted to analog format and mixed to an IF transmit frequency of 20.2 MHz.
- the signal is then sent on to the RFU for filtering, further conversion to RF and amplification prior to transmission.
- the modem receiver demodulator section takes in the IF receive signal from the RFU 21 at the receive IF frequency of 20 MHz. This signal is down-converted to baseband, then digitized with an A/D converter function. The resultant digital samples are processed by a microprocessor-based signal processing unit. This function performs filter equalization and synchronization algorithms on the input samples and then demodulates the PSK signal to yield the symbol stream at 16K symbols/second.
- the signal processing unit also functions in a self-training mode, which is used to teach the processing unit the imperfections of the analog filters used in the receive stream. Once the signal processing unit is trained, the demodulator digital equalization process compensates the input samples for these imperfections in the analog filter components. This technique allows the use of less expensive lower-tolerance analog components and adds to the overall system ability to demodulate weak or noisy signals.
- the modem demodulated symbols are output at the symbol rate to the CCU 18 during the receive function.
- the modem 19 provides the timing associated with this symbol stream. Both the base station and the subscriber stations derive receive function timing from the incoming receive signal.
- the basic TDM/TDMA channel per subscriber offers a total of 16 Kbps in each direction dedicated to each conversation. Of this channel capacity, 1.43 Kbps in each direction are required for control overhead and demodulation preambles.
- the VCU therefore operates at a fixed data rate of 14.57 Kbps. This is equivalent to 328 bits per codec frame period, defined as being one-half of the modem frame period or 22.5 msec.
- each channel is divided into “slots” via a time division multiplexing (TDM) scheme.
- TDM time division multiplexing
- These slots specify the system frame format.
- the length of the system frame consists of a predetermined constant number of symbols.
- the system frame duration has been optimized considering the voice coding rate and the number of acquisition symbols required by the modem 19 at the start of each burst.
- the number of slots within the system frame is dependent on the modulation-level of the channel. For instance, if the modulation-level of the channel is QPSK, then the system frame consists of two slots per frame. By increasing the modulation-level of the channel, the number of bits of information encoded per symbol increases and, therefore, the data rate of the channel increases.
- the system frame divides into four slots, each handling the voice data rate for one conversation. It is important to note that even at the higher modulation levels, the number of symbol times required for modem synchronization remains constant.
- the format of the system frame ensures that the modem 19 in the subscriber stations never needs to operate in a full-duplex manner (i.e., transmitting and receiving at the same time).
- the slots on the reverse and forward frequencies are offset in time by at least one slot time.
- the system frame for the system is fixed at 45 msec in duration.
- the symbol transmission rate is fixed at 16K symbols/second.
- Each symbol is transmitted for an equal amount of time, equal to ⁇ fraction (1/16000) ⁇ th of a second (62.5 microseconds). This results in a fixed 720 symbols per frame, numbered 0 to 719 from the start of the system frame. These 720 symbols may consist of 1, 2 or 4 bits of information each, corresponding to modulation rates of 2, 4 or 16 phases.
- the system frame time (45 msec) is further divided in 2 or 4 time division slots, depending on the modulation format for the slots which compose the frame.
- Each slot can be one of three slot types: (1) radio control channel (RCC), (2) 4-ary voice channel, and (3) 16-ary voice channel.
- RCC radio control channel
- the RCC is always transmitted in a binary (2-phase) modulation mode.
- the resulting bit rate is 16 Kbps, the same as for the 16-ary voice channel. The same number of bits (not symbols) are reserved for modem overhead and control purposes, so that the voice information rate is 14.57 Kbps, as it is in the 16-ary voice channel slot type.
- the system frame on any given frequency channel may be composed of any combination of these three slot types within the following five constraints:
- the slots within the system frame are numbered by position in the frame structure.
- the numbering system need not be contiguous. When one or more of the slots in the frame consist of a 4-ary voice channel slot type, the numbering system will “skip” over the second slot period that is included in the longer 4-ary slot.
- the slot numbering system for the reverse frequency (i.e., subscriber) transmissions is staggered from the numbering of the base station (forward frequency) transmission. Therefore, a subscriber that receives information on slot 2 of the forward frequency transmits on slot 2 on the reverse frequency, which is half a frame offset in time. Tables 1 through 5 illustrate possible frame formats and the numbering associated with each slot.
- the filter startup period which is included at the beginning of every slot type, is a time in which no energy is transmitted, giving the receive section of the modem 19 time to purge its filters in preparation for the new slot.
- a degenerated 16-ary pattern is transmitted which simulates an alternating BPSK signal.
- the receive section of the modem 19 uses this field to establish the phase reference of the transmitter section of the modem 19 .
- a twelve bit code word is used to determine synchronization between the subscriber and base station and to exchange control and status information. Code words are used to exchange the current state of the connection, link quality and power and timing adjustments. Each control word is encoded into ten bits using a Hamming code, which allows single error correction and double error detection.
- the CCU 18 determines the gain and loss of synchronization by tracking the number of consecutive code words received correctly or incorrectly; and the CCU 18 passes synchronization changes to the RPU 20 in the base station. In the subscriber station, the CCU 29 passes synchronization changes to the STU 27 .
- parity bits are calculated from the received data bits and compared with the received parity bits. If the calculated overall parity bit is different from the received overall bit, then the calculated parity bit is exclusive-or'd with the received bits to indicate the address of the bit in error. If the calculated and received overall bits are the same and the other four bits are not, two errors have been detected. If all parity bits are the same, the data has been received correctly.
- Table 2 shows the symbol structure for the 4-ary voice channel. The structure is very similar to that of the 16-ary voice channel. Differences exist because certain allocations of symbols are dependent on a fixed number of symbols required per slot for overhead purposes, where other bit allocations are made on a fixed number of bits.
- the format of the radio control channel slot is the same for the forward and reverse channels except for the following fields.
- the first eight symbols of a control slot transmitted by the base station (the forward channel) contains an amplitude modulation gap (“AM Hole”) which is a period in which no energy is transmitted. This gap is used by the subscriber stations to uniquely identify the control channel.
- AM Hole amplitude modulation gap
- All slots contain eight symbols of “null” transmission, the filter startup field, which enables the modem to purge its receive filters in order to prepare for the new slot.
- the next field of the slot is a fixed-bit sync pattern.
- the pattern transmitted is an alternating BPSK signal.
- the receive modem uses this field to establish a phase reference and frequency lock to the transmitting modem.
- the CCU 18 constantly searches for a unique word (UW), which is an eight-symbol sequence, in order to identify an incoming RCC message.
- UW unique word
- the base station CCU 18 must exhaustively check for a valid RCC message in every RCC slot. It performs this task by scanning for the unique word in a window of .+ ⁇ 0.3 symbols about the nominal UW location, based upon master system timing.
- the search algorithm starts with the nominal UW position and shifts one symbol right and left until it (1) finds the UW pattern and (2) verifies a correct RCC checksum. The search terminates as soon as (1) and (2) are satisfied or all possibilities have been exhausted.
- the shift information, RCC message and power information are sent to the RPU 20 following a successful search.
- the subscriber station CCU 29 when receiving RCC data, can be in one of two modes: frame search or monitor.
- the frame search mode is used to acquire receive frame timing from the incoming RCC data and is invoked automatically when RCC sync is lost.
- the monitor mode is entered whenever receive frame synchronization has been acquired.
- the subscriber station CCU 29 When in the frame search mode, the subscriber station CCU 29 must exhaustively check for a valid RCC message immediately after an RCC slot is received at the subscriber station. Like the base station CCU 18 , it 29 performs this task by scanning for the unique word in a window of .+ ⁇ 0.3 symbols about the nominal UW location, based upon timing derived from modem AM hole detection.
- the search algorithm starts with the nominal UW position and shifts one symbol right and left until it (1) finds the UW pattern and (2) verifies a correct RCC checksum. The search terminates as soon as (1) and (2) are satisfied or all possibilities have been exhausted.
- the shift information from a successful search is used to adjust the CCU generated receive framing markers. Acquisition terminates when (1) and (2) above are satisfied for three consecutive frames with the UW in its nominal position.
- the STU 27 is informed of framing acquisition when it occurs. RCC messages are not forwarded to the STU 27 during the frame search mode.
- the subscriber station CCU 29 When framing acquisition is accomplished, the subscriber station CCU 29 enters the monitor mode. Only the nominal UW position is checked to avoid the possibility of false UW acquisitions. If no UW is detected for five consecutive frames then the channel is declared out of sync and frame search mode is entered (this transition should be very unlikely or system performance is unacceptable). The STU 27 is informed of this out-of-sync condition. During the monitor mode, RCC messages that have a correct checksum and subscriber ID number (SIN) are passed on to the STU 27 .
- SIN subscriber ID number
- the rest of the slot is used to exchange information between the base station and the subscriber stations.
- the data section consists of twelve bytes.
- the first eight bits of data contain a link field which passes information regarding the status of the system, collision, detection and reservation information.
- the link field includes “idle transmission”, “system busy”, “collision”, “transmission detected”, and “slot reservation” bits. These bits are set by the base station CCU 18 and read by the subscriber station CCU 29 .
- the idle transmission bit is set by the base station to indicate that an idle message has been transmitted.
- a subscriber unit receives a slot with this bit set, it performs the usual synchronization and error checks, but does not pass the message on to the respective RPU 20 or STU 27 if the message was received without error.
- the system busy bit indicates that all the voice channels are allocated and no new call requests should be attempted (for some fixed time).
- the collision bit resolves contentions involving two or more subscriber stations attempting to transmit in the same control slot.
- the slot reservation bit reserves the next slot on the reverse control channel.
- the message is not passed from the CCU 18 to the RPU 21 in the base station, or by the CCU 29 to the STU 27 in the subscriber station.
- the subscriber station When a subscriber station first powers up and comes on-line, the subscriber station must acquire system timing and synchronization referenced from the base station. This acquisition is achieved via transmission exchanges on the radio control channel (RCC) and a refinement on the voice channel.
- RRC radio control channel
- the subscriber stations communicate with the base station by sending messages over the reverse RCC slot.
- the traffic attributes of the subscriber stations trying to access the RCC can be characterized as stochastic in nature.
- some form of control mechanism must arbitrate which subscriber station is allowed to transmit, singe multiple subscriber stations could be trying to transmit in the same slot.
- the slotted Aloha scheme is well-suited to the context of a large population of subscribers requiring relatively infrequent random accesses on the RCC channel.
- the slotted Aloha scheme allows subscriber stations to transmit messages in the designated RCC slot completely independent of whether other subscriber stations are also attempting to transmit in the same control slot.
- This independence of action is that messages from different subscriber stations may be transmitted at the same time and therefore collide.
- this scheme requires that a positive acknowledgment (ACK) be sent by the base station following the correct receipt of the subscriber station's message. If the ACK is not received within the maximum allotted time require transmission and processing delays in each direction (approximately 1-2 frame times), the subscriber station must retransmit the message. Retransmission may be caused by an error in reception of the ACK at the subscriber station. In general, the subscriber stations cannot determine the cause of the problem. Thus, a random delay is selected by the subscriber stations prior to the retransmission of the message to avoid repeated collisions with other senders that may be involved in a previous collision.
- a complication that arises in an Aloha scheme is the fact that the channel may become unstable if random retransmission delays are not long enough. When this happens, the channel becomes clogged with retransmission and throughput falls to zero.
- a backoff technique minimizes this problem by increasing each subscriber station's average randomized retransmission delay with successive retransmission.
- the total average delay with one retransmission is then 450 msec (i.e., on average the delay includes: one frame delay the original transmission, plus one frame delay for the acknowledgment, plus the eight frame random delay).
- a population of 1000 subscribers each making a call on the average every half minute can be supported by a 45 ms frame time with access delays of about 45 ms when one retransmission is required, and an average access time of approximately 70-80 ms.
- the price paid for the much lower average delay is an increased delay variance, which for the 20% or less utilization should rarely exceed two retransmission times, i.e., one second.
- the Aloha scheme approach appears well-suited to a system having a large population of subscribers requiring relatively infrequent random accesses on the control channel, and should allow the design goal of setup delays of less than one second to be achieved for the expected population parameters. In contrast, polling and fixed-TDMA techniques give unacceptable delays.
- All phases of call processing including call establishment, call disconnection, and slot connection, require information exchange over the control channel and/or the control portion of the voice slot.
- the following describes the different phases of call processing in regards to both subscriber station processing and base station processing.
- the subscriber station's subscriber identification number (SIN) and the dialed digits are two call control items that must be supplied in a CALL REQUEST message to the base station on every call made by a subscriber station.
- the user dials the number into a register in the subscriber station's memory.
- the user initiates the communication with the base station by pushing the send key or allowing a time-out. Only when the number is completely assembled and stored in the subscriber station is the radio channel used. Thus, the customer can dial at a slow rate without tying up valuable radio control channel (RCC) bandwidth or time.
- RRC radio control channel
- the sequence of messages generated by the subscriber stations and the base station to establish a connection between two subscriber stations are shown in FIG. 4 .
- the control channel link level protocol is used to check the various error conditions that arise due to channel errors. Further, messages that are received by the base station on the reverse control frequency are automatically acknowledged in the next control slot on the forward control frequency.
- the base station When the base station receives a CALL REQUEST message on the control channel from a subscriber station A, it first checks the received SIN for errors. If the SIN is in error, the message is dropped. Without a valid SIN, the base station does not know who sent the message. If the dialed digits are incorrect or incomplete, the base station sends a CLEAR INDICATION message on the forward control channel frequency to the requesting subscriber station A with status information specifying the problem.
- the voice channel is allocated for the originating subscriber station A and the base station sends a PAGE in the form of an incoming-call message on the forward control frequency to destination subscriber station B. If the destination subscriber station B does not answer the PAGE with a CALL ACCEPTED message after two attempts or returns a busy condition indication via a CLEAR-REQUEST message, then the base station transmits a CLEAR-INDICATION message to the originating subscriber station A with status information of busy (i.e., destination unit off-hook) or that the destination subscriber station is not answering the page.
- a CALL-ACCEPTED message is transmitted back to the base station and the voice channel is allocated.
- voice channel synchronization is achieved, the destination subscriber station B generates an audible ring heard at the destination subscriber station B and also generates the RINGBACK tone over the voice channel to the originating subscriber station A.
- the control portion of the voice slot changes from a sync-ring indication to a sync-offhook indication and CALL PROGRESS messages are provided over the voice channel via the base station between the two subscriber stations.
- the destination subscriber station B terminates the audible ring and disconnects the RINGBACK tone from the voice channel at this point.
- the circuit is now complete, and voice/data exchange can begin.
- Placing a call to an external telephone is a performed in the same manner as calling another subscriber station.
- the subscriber station merely dials the desired digits and presses the send button or waits for time-out. This generates a radio request message to the base station.
- the base station decides whether to page another subscriber station or to seize an external trunk line. In this case, an external trunk line is seized, and the dialed digits are out-pulsed on the trunk line. While the digits are being out-pulsed, the voice frequency for the originating subscriber station is allocated.
- the CALL-CONNECT message it changes frequency and synchronizes itself to the assigned voice channel. Once the voice channel is ready, the subscriber station handset is disconnected from local silence and connected to the external trunk line. From this point on, the destination Telco central office generates all the call progress tones.
- An incoming external call seizes a trunk line into the base station.
- the originating central office sends in from 2 to 5 digits, identifying the unique digits of the destination subscriber station SIN, to the base station over the direct inward dialing (DID) trunk line. If the dialed subscriber station is not busy, the base station sends a PAGE MESSAGE over the RCC to the appropriate subscriber station.
- Three possible situations can occur. First, the subscriber station accepts the incoming call and processing proceeds as described below. Second, no response is received. In this case, the base station retries the paging process two times. If the base station exhausts the retry count without an answer from the subscriber unit, then a RINGBACK tone is generated in the originating unit. The third condition is a result of the subscriber station being busy dialing (i.e., off-hook) and returning a CLEAR-REQUEST message on the control channel. In this case, a busy tone is returned to the originating subscriber station.
- the voice channel is allocated, external ring is generated at the destination subscriber station's handset while an audible RINGBACK tone is generated back to the originating party, from the subscriber station.
- the destination subscriber station answers the call (i.e., the base station detects an onhook to offhook transition)
- the external ring and the channel RINGBACK message are both removed.
- the voice channel is ready for a conversation.
- a normal call termination is initiated by the subscriber going on-hook.
- the base station detects the offhook to onhook transition via the control portion of the voice channel. Upon detecting the transition, the base station deallocates the voice channel. The channel is not allowed to be used again until the base station sees the subscriber station lose synchronization on that channel. If the call being disconnected is to another subscriber station, an onhook indication is sent to the second subscriber station in the control portion of the voice channel.
- the subscriber stations resynchronize themselves to the RCC's transmissions and send CLEAR-REQUEST messages to the base station.
- Termination of a call also takes place five seconds after the base station loses radio contact with a subscriber station.
- a voice connection can be “lost” due to fading or channel interference at the destination receiver.
- the following conditions are checked at the subscriber stations and the base station to determine if the connection is experiencing problems: The link quality value returned from the subscriber or base station receiver is below a predetermined threshold for successive receptions; a loss of word synchronization has been detected for several successive transmissions.
- Base station originated messages are broadcast to all active subscriber stations. These messages are transmitted by the base station over the radio control channel. The purpose of the broadcast message is to notify all active subscriber stations of changes in operation of the system (i.e., change in frequency of the RCC, or a command to the modems to go into self-test mode, etc.). These messages are not acknowledged by the subscriber stations.
- RPU Remote-Control Processor Unit
- the RPU functions as the control computer within the base station architecture; it interfaces with the CCUs 18 , which communicate with the radio equipment, and the PBX 15 , as shown in FIG. 2 .
- the RPU 20 coordinates the necessary actions for radio call processing.
- the RPU 20 exchanges messages with the subscriber stations, the PBX 15 and the CCUs 15 in order to make connections and disconnections. Included in the call processing functions is the allocation and deallocation of the radio channels.
- the RPU 20 also maintains a database that reflects the current state of the system; the database contains information on the status of the equipment, subscriber stations, connections and the radio channels within the system.
- Call establishment begins when the RPU receives a message either from the PBX call processor 24 for a call received from an external line, or from a subscriber, for a call destined for an external phone or another subscriber. Communication from a subscriber comes in over the radio control channel (RCC) via a base station CCU 18 .
- RCC radio control channel
- the RPU allocates a voice channel and exchanges messages with the subscriber station, the PBX 15 and the CCU 18 in order to establish the connection.
- a disconnection begins by a message being a received from the PBX 15 or a subscriber indicating that a phone was hung up or from the CCU 18 indicating that synchronization was lost over the radio channel.
- the RPU informs the CCU 18 and the PBX 15 of the disconnect and the RCC is deallocated.
- the RPU software performs the following functions:
- the RPU software supports one serial interface to the PBX call processor 24 . It also supports serial interfaces to each of the CCUs 18 in the base station configuration.
- the RPU hardware includes a Motorola Model 68000 based general-purpose computer. This machine is configured with one Mbyte of random access memory (RAM) and 10 Mbytes of non-volatile hard disk storage.
- I/O consists of a system console and a unit which supports eight asynchronous serial data interfaces.
- the RPU software package simulates a system that includes a scheduler module 40 , a BCC interface module(s) 41 a , 41 b . . . 41 n , a PBX interface module 42 , a console module 43 , a logger module 44 , a message processing module (MPM) 45 , and a database module 46 .
- All modules, except the database module 46 are called to run from the scheduler module 40 .
- the modules communicate with each other through a system of mailboxes.
- the database module 46 is based upon a collection of subroutines for accessing information in the database.
- the scheduler module 40 provides mainline code for the RPU software. It is responsible for scheduling and activating all other modules. It also is responsible for maintaining event timers and mailboxes which allow intra- and inter-process communication.
- the BCC interface modules 41 a , . . . 41 n support a serial asynchronous interface and a link level protocol. They also monitor the state of communication with the CCUs 18 .
- the PBX interface module 42 supports a serial asynchronous interface to the PBX call processor 24 .
- the console module 43 provides a system operator interface which allows system status queries and modifications and message exchange between the RPU 20 and the rest of the system.
- the logger module 44 provides raw transaction information for diagnostic and system analysis purposes.
- the message processing module 46 processes all received RCC, BCC and PBX messages. It performs all subscriber call set up and tear down not performed by the PBX 15 and allocates the radio channels. It also includes a background task which monitors the state of the CCUs 18 .
- the database module 46 provides a consistent interface to all of the data structures required for call processing. It includes a frequency allocation task which assigns the radio channels.
- the RPU database contains structure describing the system configuration including information on all subscribers and the state of all radio channels. These structures are described as follows:
- the RPU database contains a baseband control channel (BCC) data structure for each CCU 18 in the system.
- BCC baseband control channel
- a subscriber identification table contains a sorted list of all valid subscribers. The list is sorted to facilitate subscriber validation. The SIN table has one entry for every subscriber in the system.
- the RPU software performs a portion of the subscriber unit call processing. This processing is done in the message processing module. Call processing is accomplished by means of message exchanges between the MPM 45 , the PBX module 42 and all of the BCC modules 41 .
- a subscriber (the “originating subscriber”) goes off-hook, dials a valid phone number (the phone number of the “destination”) and presses the send button or waits for a time-out.
- the originating subscriber station sends a CALL REQUEST message over control channel to the base station.
- the RPU BCC modules 41 receives the RADIO REQUEST message and forward it to the MPM 45 .
- the MPM 45 performs some simple dialed digit validation and sends a RADIO REQUEST message to the PBX module 42 which forwards the message to the PBX control processor 24 .
- the PBX call processor 24 validates the dialed digits and returns a PLACE CALL message to the RPU 20 .
- the MPM 45 assigns a voice slot to the originating subscriber station.
- the MPM 45 generates a CHANGE CHANNEL command to the CCU 18 that contains the voice slot that the originating subscriber station is assigned to.
- the MPM 45 generates a CALL CONNECT command to the originating subscriber station, which command assigns the voice frequency and slot to the originating subscriber station.
- the MPM 45 generates an ALLOCATE message to the PBX call processor 24 which tells the PBX call processor 24 to allocate a message channel.
- the originating subscriber station is completely set up. It is now awaiting a connection through the PBX switch matrix 25 to the “destination”.
- the “destination” can be either another subscriber station or a telephone that must be accessed over a Telco trunk line 14 , it makes no difference.
- the PBX call processor 24 determines that a phone call is destined for a subscriber station.
- the PBX call processor 24 generates an INCOMING CALL message. This message contains information about the nature of the incoming call, specifically whether the call is coming from an external trunk line 14 or from another subscriber station.
- the RPU PBX module 42 receives the PBX message from the PBX call processor 24 and forwards it to the MPM 45 . If the call is coming from another subscriber station, the MPM 45 sets the subscriber-to-subscriber index of both the “originating” and “destination” subscriber stations and commands the CCUs involved 18 to go into internal mode.
- the MPM 45 generates a PAGE message to the subscriber station specified in the INCOMING CALL message. The proper subscriber station responds with a CALL ACCEPT message. The MPM 45 responds to the CALL ACCEPT message by generating a CHANGE CHANNEL message to the appropriate CCU 18 and a CALL CONNECT message to the appropriate subscriber station. The MPM 45 then generates an ALLOCATE message to the PBX call processor 24 which causes the PBX switch matrix 25 to make the final connection for the incoming call.
- the CCU 18 handling the voice channel which fades sees the channel lose synchronization.
- the CCU 18 generates a NO-SYNC event message.
- the BCC module 41 receives the event message and forwards it to the MPM 45 .
- the MPM 45 sends an ONHOOK message to the PBX call processor 24 and sets the subscriber to the idle state and the channel to the on-hook state.
- a BCC message is passed via a 9600 baud asynchronous interface from the CCU 18 to the RPU 20 .
- the BCC module 41 which handles that particular CCU interface reads in the message and checks the link-level information bits to verify the integrity of the incoming message. If the BCC module 41 determines that the message is acceptable, an appropriate acknowledgment is returned to the sending CCU 18 . Otherwise a retry or negative-acknowledgment is returned.
- the BCC module 41 now sends the message to the MPM 45 . This message is placed in the message processing mailbox 48 utilizing the mailboxes provided by the scheduler module 40 . (See FIG. 6 .)
- the BCC module 41 “blocks”, and control passes to the scheduler module 40 .
- the scheduler module 40 activates the next module in the round-robin schedule, and this module runs until it blocks. The scheduler module then activates another, and so on. At some later point, the scheduler module activates the MPM 45 .
- the MPM 45 then reads in the BCC message, along with any other messages that have been queued up for it in its mailbox 48 .
- the BCC message is identified and processed. Such processing may include changes to the database and the generation of new messages.
- FIG. 6 illustrates the data path of an incoming message.
- FIG. 6 also illustrates the data path of an outgoing BCC message.
- An outgoing BCC message is generated by the MPM 45 in response to some particular event. The message is constructed within the MPM 45 and is mailed to the BCC module 41 which handles the destination CCU 18 . After this message, and any other necessary messages are sent, and if there are not more messages in the MPM's mailbox 48 , the MPM “blocks”, and control is returned to the scheduler module.
- the BCC module reads the message from its mailbox 49 and adds the appropriate link level bits to the outgoing message. It then transmits the message out the serial data port to the CCU 18 .
- An incoming RCC message is handled exactly like an incoming BCC message since an RCC message is a type of BCC message. Also, an outgoing RCC message is created and transmitted in the same way as an outgoing BCC message.
- a PBX message is received from the PBX call processor 24 . This message is passes via a 9600 baud asynchronous interface to the RPU 20 .
- the RPU PBX module 42 reads in the PBX message and sends it to the MPM mailbox 48 . When there are no more incoming characters and the PBX mailbox 50 containing outgoing PBX messages is empty, the RPU PBX module 42 “blocks”, and control is passed back to the scheduler module 40 .
- the MPM 45 reads in the PBX message, along with any other messages that have been queued up for it in its mailbox 48 .
- the PBX message is processed based on the type of the message and the current state of the subscriber specified in the message. Processing may include changes to the database, changes in the subscriber state and the generation of new messages.
- FIG. 7 illustrates the data path of the incoming PBX message.
- an outgoing PBX message is generated by the MPM 45 in response to an event.
- the message is constructed within the MPM 45 and is mailed to the PBX module 42 . After this message, and any other necessary messages are sent, and if there are no more messages in the MPM mailbox 48 , the MPM 45 “blocks”, and control is returned to the scheduler module 40 .
- the scheduler module 40 continues to activate other modules in the round-robin schedule until the RPU PBX module 42 is activated.
- the RPU PBX module 42 reads the PBX message from its mailbox 50 and then transmits the message out the serial data port to the PBX call processor 24 .
- FIG. 8 illustrates the logger data paths.
- console module 43 input section provides command prompting and recognition along with command validation.
- Valid console commands have the capability to query and update the RPU database and send messages to RPU modules.
- the output resulting from console display commands will be output directly to the console port.
- the scheduler module 40 is considered to be a special system module and is responsible for scheduling all the other RPU modules. The main responsibilities of the scheduler module 40 are to select the next module to be executed and to provide inter- and intra-module communication.
- the scheduler module 40 which performs the round-robin dispatching of the other RPU modules.
- the scheduler module 40 manages the stack for each of the pseudo RPU modules by allocating a fixed part of stack space to each of the pseudo modules at startup time. Then just before each module is scheduled to run, the stack pointer is changed by the scheduler module 40 to point to the appropriate stack address for the proper module.
- a memory map of the RPU 20 is shown in FIG. 9 .
- Each RPU module runs until it blocks. When a module blocks, it returns control back to the scheduler which allows another module to be scheduled and run.
- a module can block in several ways: by call GETEVENT( ) which forces the module to block until an event is pending, or by calling WAIT( ) which blocks for a certain number of seconds, or by calling BLOCK( ) which blocks for one tour of the round-robin scheduling loop.
- Another major function that the scheduler module 40 performs is inter-module communication between modules.
- Mailboxes are used as the means form sending or receiving messages to or from other modules.
- Each module can check for mail in its mailbox by using the MAILREAD( ) call.
- a module can send mail to another module by using the MAILSEND( ) call.
- the scheduler module maintains a separate mailbox for each of the modules that are in the scheduling loop. When one module sends a message to another module, the message is copied into the destination's mailbox. Later, when it is the destination's turn to run, the scheduler module checks its mailbox to determine whether there is a message in the mailbox. If so, the scheduler module 40 generates an event of type MAIL which forces the module to be unblocked, if blocked by a GETEVENT( ), and thus scheduled to run.
- An event list is also maintained by the scheduler module for each module in the scheduling loop.
- Events can consist of mail or timer events.
- Mail events are generated whenever the scheduler module determines that messages are pending for the currently running module.
- a module can put a timer event on the event list by calling PUTEVENT( ) with the number of seconds to wait before an event is to be generated.
- the scheduler module 40 checks the module's event list each tour through the round-robin scheduling loop searching for timer expirations. When a timer expiration is detected, the appropriate module is scheduled to run and the event is returned to the module through the GETEVENT( ) call.
- the scheduler module 40 contains routines that are used to initialize RS-232 interfaces between the CCU 18 and the RPU 20 and between the PBX 15 and the RPU 20 . These routines, which take exclusive software control over the RS-232 interfaces, turn off the usual processing of control sequences by the Regulus operating system. Other routines are used to flush the I/O buffers and to read and write terminal input and output. The scheduler module 40 also keeps track of the system times for all the RPU modules.
- Each BCC module 41 provides an interface between a CCU 18 and the other software modules in the RPU 20 .
- the messages exchanged between the CCU 18 and the RPU 20 consists of variable length binary data which are transmitted over an asynchronous communication link.
- the BCC module 41 is responsible for providing message integrity over the communications link which includes error detection, message sequencing and message acknowledgments.
- the hardware interface between the CCU 18 and the RPU 20 consists of a 9600 baud RS-232 asynchronous interface.
- Inputs to this module 41 include messages received from the CCU or from other RPU software modules. Messages are output from this module to either the CCU via the RS-232 interface or to other RPU software modules via the proper mailbox.
- this module 41 The purpose of this module 41 is to process message traffic between the RPU 20 and the CCU 18 .
- This module 41 continually checks for messages received from the CCU 18 and routes them to the proper RPU software module. Likewise, this module is continually checking for messages from other RPU software modules that are destined for a CCU 18 .
- An alternating bit protocol is utilized to limit outstanding messages (i.e., unacknowledged) to one in each direction. Sequence and acknowledgment bits serve as the necessary flow control to accomplish this function. The protocol is described in greater detail in the following paragraphs.
- the ACK bit is as expected if it is the same as the SEQ bit of our last transmitted message.
- the SEQ bit is as expected if it differs from the SEQ bit of the last received message.
- the expected conditions are that an incoming message acknowledges our last message and we also expect each new arrival to be a new message.
- the Reset bit is used to reset the SEQ and ACK bits.
- it should be accepted as a new message regardless of its SEQ bit, and it should be acknowledged.
- the PBX module 42 provides the interface between the UTX-250 PBX call processor 24 and the other software modules of the RPU 20 .
- the messages exchanged between the two machines are to consist of an ASCII character oriented message exchange.
- the ASCII character is defined here to be 7 or 8-bit ASCII.
- Both the PBX call processor 24 and the RPU 20 must be capable of accepting characters with odd, even or no parity.
- the text of the messages consist of variable length strings or printable characters.
- the hardware interface between the PBX call processor 24 and the RPU 20 consists of a 9600 baud RS-232 asynchronous interface.
- Inputs to the PBX module 42 include messages received from the PBX call processor 24 or from other RPU software modules. Messages are output from this module to either the PBX call processor 24 or to other RPU software modules via the proper mailbox.
- the purpose of the PBX module 42 is to process message traffic between the RPU 20 and the PBX call processor 24 .
- This module continually checks for messages received from the PBX call processor 24 and routes them to the proper RPU software module. Likewise, this module is continually checking for messages from other RPU software modules that are destined for the PBX call processor 24 .
- Every character that is received from the PBX call processor 24 is checked for equality with the greater-than character>which indicates the beginning of a message or a carriage return character which indicates the end of a message.
- This module is capable of handling full-duplex message traffic.
- the console module 43 is the operator's window into the current state of the RPU 20 .
- the console provides capability to display information regarding the current state of the subscribers and the radio channels, modify connection and channel states and send messages to the PBX 15 and the CCUs 18 .
- the console processes the input stream from the terminal and executes the desired command.
- the console module 43 provides the interface to the base station operator's terminal.
- the console module 43 processes the input from the terminal and executes the command. Data is retrieved from and written into the database, displays are output to the terminal screen and messages are sent to other modules.
- the interfaces for this module include:
- a set of parser routines input characters from the operator's keyboard.
- a data entry prompt is displayed at the beginning of each command line, the data is buffered, the editing characters processed, the input echoed to the display and the data delimited into tokens.
- the parser performs recognition on the data entered, responds to question marks and displays guide words for data entry.
- Each token is checked that it is the type of data expected; keywords are matched with the list of acceptable entries and numbers are converted to integers.
- Commands break into three categories: (1) commands that display information from the database, (2) commands that modify the database and (3) commands that send messages. Information can be displayed on subscriber, connection, CCU and channel status. All display commands require information to be retrieved from the database and formatted data output to the operator's display.
- the modification commands include the ability to force a subscriber's connection on a particular channel and the ability to enable and disable channels. The modification commands are used in testing the frequency allocation algorithm. All modification commands write into the database.
- PBX, BCC and RCC messages can be sent from the console module 43 to various other modules in the system.
- a SENDMSG commands prompt the operator for all information needed for the message, the message is formatted and forwarded to the indicated module.
- PBX messages are sent to the RPU PBX module 42 which sends the message out to the PBX call processor 42 .
- BCC and RCC messages can be sent from the RPU 20 to the CCUs 18 via the BCC modules 41 , which add the link level protocol bits to the outgoing messages. Input from the CCUs 18 is stimulated and messages, including both BCC and RCC messages, are forwarded to the MPM 46 .
- the logger module 44 is responsible for logging RPU events or messages.
- the logger module 44 maintains the following three disk files: a transaction log with information similar to billing information, an error log consisting of error messages, and a message log which consists of system warning messages.
- the logger module 44 consists of a set of subroutines which are called from the other RPU modules. Each subroutine is responsible for time stamping the message and writing the message to the proper disk file. Each subroutine has a global flag which determines whether messages are to be logged or not. The global flags are set and reset by using console commands.
- MPM Message Processing Module
- the MPM 45 performs the high-level call processing functions between the PBX 15 and the subscriber stations. It is responsible for call processing functions such as initiating pages, allocating voice channels and controlling call progress tones form both subscriber an external telephones.
- the MPM 45 also processes status messages that it receives from the CCUs 18 . For example, channel status information consisting of link quality or subscriber hook status is processed by the MPM 45 .
- the MPM 45 is organized as a state machine where PBX and BCC messages are tokens to the messages processing state machine.
- the MPM 45 processes the tokens by updating the database, outputting the necessary responses and then transitioning to the next state.
- the MPM 45 uses the system mailboxes, which are maintained by the scheduling module 40 , to receive and transmit messages to and from the other RPU modules. Also, the MPM 45 utilizes subroutines in the database module to retrieve or update state information in the database.
- the MPM 45 is organized as a state machine. Tokens, which force some processing to be performed, consists of messages, or timeouts. The MPM 45 determines the type of token (i.e., timer, RCC message, PBX message, etc.) and the subscriber station or channel that is affected by the token. The MPM 45 processes the token by generating the proper message responses and transitioning to the next state.
- Tokens which force some processing to be performed, consists of messages, or timeouts.
- the MPM 45 determines the type of token (i.e., timer, RCC message, PBX message, etc.) and the subscriber station or channel that is affected by the token.
- the MPM 45 processes the token by generating the proper message responses and transitioning to the next state.
- the changes of state for a typical external to subscriber call are as follows.
- An external call message is received from the PBX call processor 24 , which message includes the phone number of the destination subscriber station of the call.
- a PAGE message is sent out to the subscriber station and the state of the subscriber station is set to PAGE.
- ACTIVE When a CALL ACCEPT message is received from the subscriber station, the state of the subscriber station is set to ACTIVE.
- a channel is assigned, and the PBX call processor 24 , CCU 18 and the subscriber station are informed of the channel assignment.
- the channel is placed into the RING SYNC-WAIT state ( FIG. 11 ).
- the CCU 18 indicates the synchronization has been acquired, the channel state is set to SYNC RING.
- CCU 18 indicates that the subscriber has gone offhook
- the channel is set to the SYNC OFFHOOK state.
- the SYNC OFFHOOK state indicates that a voice connection is established.
- a subscriber-to-subscriber call begins with a CALL REQUEST message being received from the originating subscriber station.
- the originating subscriber station is placed into the DIAL state and a RADIO REQUEST message is sent to the PBX call processor 24 .
- the PBX call processor 24 then returns a PLACE CALL message for the originating subscriber station and an INCOMING CALL message for the destination subscriber station.
- a channel is allocated, the PBX call processor 24 , the CCU 18 and originating subscriber station are informed of the assignment.
- the channel state of the originating subscriber is set to OFFHOOK SYNC WAIT until the channel goes into synchronization.
- the base station CCU 18 When the base station CCU 18 detects the transmission from the originating subscriber, it generates a SYNC OFFHOOK channel event message.
- the RPU 20 processes the channel event message by changing the state of the channel to the SYNC OFFHOOK state.
- An incoming call message for the destination subscriber station is processed in the same manner as the external call message as described above.
- the channels involved in the connection are set to internal mode once both subscribers are in synchronization.
- a disconnection begins when one of the parties involved in a connection goes ONHOOK.
- an ONHOOK message is received by the MPM 45 from the PBX call processor 24 .
- the CCU 18 sends a message which indicates that the subscriber station is ONHOOK.
- the other party is informed of the disconnect, the channel is placed into the DISCONNECT state and the subscriber station is placed into the TEARDOWN state.
- the CCU 18 indicates that synchronization has been lost, the channel and the subscriber station are placed back into the idle states.
- a background task routine is implemented by the MPM 45 .
- the background task initially communicates with the CCUs 18 after a cold or warm restart. Also, once the system is operation, the background task monitors the CCUs 18 in order to keep the database current and a RCC assigned.
- Data is written into and retrieved from the database.
- all CCUs 18 are sent BASEBAND QUERY messages in order for the RPU 20 to determine the current state of the system. All information received from baseband event or response messages is stored in the RPU database. When the RPU 20 receives a baseband event message, which indicates that a CCU 18 is ready and not reset (i.e., the CCU 18 has not just powered up), the frequency assigned to the CCU 20 is marked as allocated. The CCU 18 is then sent CHANNEL QUERY messages in order to update the database to the current state of the system. CCU initialization is complete once each CCU 18 has either responded to all outstanding query messages or it is determined that the CCU 18 is down.
- each CCU 18 that indicated it was ready and reset i.e., the CCU had just powered up
- the RPU 20 attempts to assign the control channel.
- the first choice is to assign the control channel to the CCU 18 on the first frequency, since this is where the subscriber first looks for the RCC.
- the next choice is any CCU 18 with slot 0 not in use and the last choice is a CCU 18 with a connection on slot 0 . If all the operational CCUs 18 already have a connection on slot 0 , then one of the connections on slot 0 is terminated and the control channel is assigned to that slot.
- the state of the CCUs 18 is monitored via status messages received from the CCUs 18 or the BCC modules 41 .
- the BCC modules 41 are continually monitoring the communication path to each CCU 18 .
- a CCU 18 is considered out of operation when a baseband event message is received indicating that the CCU 18 is not ready. At this time, the CCU 18 is marked as not ready in the database. Further, all connections are torn down, all channels are returned to the default state and the frequency assigned to the CCU 18 is deallocated. If the CCU 18 contained the control channel, then a new control channel is assigned.
- the CCUs 18 are queried from the RPU 20 for their initial states.
- the CCUs 18 also send in event messages whenever they power up or change state.
- the exchange of messages keeps the RPU database up to date with the current state of the system.
- the database module 46 contains the database interface routines necessary for database access. They provide a concise single-thread interface into the database for any module requiring access to the information within.
- the bulk of the access routines are concerned with the SIN table and the BCC Table. Access to all fields within these tables is provided by the access routines.
- the database module also provides the following:
- the database module 46 is a collection of routines which allow controlled access to the database by other modules. By channeling all accesses through the database routines, the database is essentially hidden from outside modules. This allows the database to change without requiring modifications to any of the other modules. When the database changes, only the interface routine to the changed portion of the database needs to be changed.
- the frequency allocation task is used by the MPM during call setup. It makes extensive use of the data structures within the database module.
- the first is the external-source category and the second is the internal-destination category.
- the internal-destination category covers the incoming part (i.e., destination) of an internal call.
- the external-source category covers all other cases which includes external calls whether they are incoming or outgoing or the origination of an internal call.
- Input into the frequency allocation task consists of an index into the SIN table of the subscriber station requesting a channel and the index into the SIN table of the originating subscriber station.
- the index of the originating subscriber station is only valid when the channel is being set up for an internal-destination call. At all other times, the originating subscriber index is a predefined illegal index defines as DB NULL. These indexes provide access to all the information required to allocate an appropriate channel (i.e., frequency and slot).
- Each frequency is divided into four TDM slots.
- the RPU database maintains a count of how may slots are available in each position.
- a slot is selected from the slot position with the greatest vacancy count. Once a slot position is selected, the first frequency with that slot available is selected. Actually, it doesn't matter which slot is selected when a request falls within this category. However, this technique tends to distribute the system load evenly across all slots and, more importantly, it increases the probability of optimal slot assignments for both parties of an internal call. This is true because system timing calculations have shown that the optimal slot assignment for a subscriber-to-subscriber call is to have the base station's transmit slot for each subscriber in the same slot on different frequencies.
- the destination subscriber station By assigning the originator of a subscriber-to-subscriber call to the most available slot position, the probability is greater than when the time comes, the destination subscriber station will be able to allocate that same slot position on another frequency. For example, if position No. 2 is the most available position then it is selected. When the destination subscriber station's allocation request is processed, it is more probable that another slot in position No. 2 is available to be selected, thus allowing the optimal slot-to-slot assignment to occur.
- the slot to be assigned is chosen from a selection table.
- a selection table contains lists, ordered from the most to the least desirable slot position assignments for the destination subscriber. This ordering is based on the slot assignment of the originating subscriber.
- modulation type has not been mentioned. This is because the basic allocation rules do not change for 4-ary and 16-ary slot selections, except for one important exception. That is, only slot 0 or slot 2 may be allocated for a 4-ary type connection. Because of this exception, and due to the fact that the two subscribers could be set to different modulation types, a total of four unique selection tables are required in order to cover all possible call combinations.
- the first input is the index into the SIN table for the subscriber station requesting a channel.
- frequency allocation can determine the default modulation type of the requesting subscriber. It also tells the routine where to put the results of its selection algorithms (i.e., the frequency and slot numbers).
- the second input to the frequency allocation task indicates the category of the frequency-slot request.
- the value of the second input is either an index into the SIN table, or it is the previously defined illegal value DB NULL. If a valid index is received, the frequency allocation request is identified as the destination side of a subscriber-to-subscriber call and the selection tables should be utilized. If DB NULL is received, the request is considered to fall into the external-source category and the “most available slot position” algorithm is utilized.
- the frequency allocation task returns TRUE if a frequency-slot combination is successfully allocated, otherwise it returns FALSE. It also causes one desirable side effect. If allocation is successful, the baseband index and slot fields of the SIN table are filled in for the requesting subscriber.
- the frequency allocation algorithm can be broken down into two stages.
- the first stage called the classification stage, determines the category of the allocation request.
- the second stage called the selection stage, finds and allocates a frequency-slot combination using the appropriate algorithm as determined by the allocation request category.
- the classification stage first determines if an automatic frequency selection is to occur. If the requesting subscriber has been put into manual mode, the specified manual-modulation-level, manual-frequency and manual-slot values specify the frequency-slot-modulation to be allocated. If the frequency-slot specified is available, they are assigned to the requesting subscriber. If the frequency-slot specified is not available, the routine exits returning a FALSE value. If the requesting subscriber has been put into automatic mode, further classification is required.
- the frequency allocation algorithm determines the request category.
- request categories are as follows: “External-In” applies when a destination subscriber station is called from an external phone; “External-out” applies when an originating subscriber station calls an external phone; “Internal-out” applies when an originating subscriber station calls another subscriber station; “Internal-in” applies when a destination subscriber station is called from another subscriber station.
- a slot position is selected by searching for the most available position. Once the position is selected, all frequencies are sequentially searched until a vacant slot (or adjacent slot pair in the case of 4ary request) of the desired position is found. At this point, the routine puts the appropriate values into the SIN table and exits, returning a value of TRUE. If the request falls into the final category (internal-in), further information is required.
- a “slot count” array keeps track of the number of available slots for each slot position. These counts are maintained by the database module and are referenced by the frequency allocation task.
- the SIN table contains pertinent information on each of the subscribers recognized by the system. The following accesses are made to the SIN Table.
- the BCC table is used by the frequency allocation routines search for an available frequency-slot combination. The following accesses are made to the BCC table:
- STU Subscriber Telephone Interface Unit
- the PCM codec 55 uses the .mu. ⁇ 255 companding algorithm to digitize the voice signals into 8-bit samples at an 8 KHz rate.
- the PCM codec 55 is full-duplex in nature.
- the digitized voice samples are then fed over line 56 to a “mode select” multiplexer (MUX) 57 .
- the mode of operation the MUX is determined by the subscriber controller unit SCU 58 which interfaces with the MUX 57 by a transmit and receive FIFO 59 .
- the SCU 58 essentially includes a Model 803 microcontroller.
- the SCU is coupled to the CCU 29 . Through an RS-232 interface circuit 60 and further controls the operation of the SLIC 53 .
- the STU can essentially operate in one of three distinct modes.
- the first, the most basic, mode is the voice mode.
- voice samples from the PCM codec 55 are transferred through the mode select MUX 57 and a VCU driver/receiver circuit 61 to the VCU 28 , where they are further processed to reduce the bit rate from 64 Kbps to 14.6 Kbps and then sent on for transmission to the base station.
- the second mode of operation is the data mode.
- the 64 Kbps stream to/from the VCU 28 does not involve voice information; rather, the information conveyed to the base station is a reformatted data stream from an external data source at a rate of up to the 14.6 Kbps channel data transmission rate.
- the STU also includes a RS-232 data port 62 to allow the connection of a data device (e.g., terminal) via a line 63 using a standard asynchronous RS-232 interface operating up to 9600 baud.
- the STU includes an UART and timer circuit 64 to synchronize the data from the RS-232 data port 62 .
- the VCU 28 packetizes the synchronized data so that it will pass through the 14.6 Kbps limitation of the channel. Full-duplex data transmission is supported in this mode.
- the third STU mode is the call setup mode. In this mode, no data is conveyed from the STU 27 to the VCU 28 through the mode select MUX 57 . However, a ringback tone generator circuit 65 is connected to the mode select MUX 57 . This circuit digitally synthesizes the tones used in call placement procedures, such as busy and error tones. During call placement, DTMF digits dialed by the user are detected by a DTMF detector circuit 66 and processed by the SCU 58 to place the call. The ringback tone generator circuit 65 returns appropriate tones to the user's head set. A ring generator 67 is connected to the SLIC 53 . A timing generator 68 provides timing signals to the PCM codec 55 , the VCU driver receiver circuit 61 and the ringback tone generator 65 . Once the call placement is complete, the STU will switch to either the voice mode or the data mode for communications with the base station.
- the 8031 micropro controller in the SCU 58 performs the functions of the RPU 20 and PBX call processor 24 in the base station. It communicates to the base station RPU 20 via messages sent on the radio control channel (RCC) and controls all the individual functions of the STU 27 .
- the SCTU also communicates to the subscriber station CCU 29 via the baseband control channel (BCC).
- BCC baseband control channel
- the RS-232 interface to the CCU 29 operates at 9600 baud and is used to convey control information between the CCU 20 and STU 27 in the subscriber station.
- VCU Voice Codec Unit
- the voice codec unit implements four full-duplex RELP voice compression systems.
- the VCU design is identical for the base station and the subscriber stations. In the subscriber station only one-fourth of the overall functionality is used (that is, only one of the four channels).
- the interface to the STU 27 in the subscriber station is identical to the interface used by each of the four PBX channels in the base station VCU 17 interface.
- the VCU 17 , 28 uses an entirely digital scheme to implement the RELP voice algorithm, as described in co-pending U.S. patent application Ser. No. 667,446 entitled “RELP Vocoder Implemented in Digital Signal Processors”, filed Nov. 2, 1984 by Philip J. Wilson, the disclosure of which is incorporated herein by reference.
- a sub-band codec may be used.
- the processed data is provided to the CCU 18 , 29 on a common parallel bus interface which is controlled by the CCU software.
- the CCU 18 , 29 sends the VCU 17 , 28 control signals to determine the mode of operation and configuration in the VCU 18 , 29 .
- the modes of operation, functional description and implementation considerations associated with the VCU 17 , 28 are described below.
- the interfaces between the PBX 15 and the VCU 17 are shown in FIG. 13 .
- the interfaces between the STU 27 and the VCU 28 are shown in FIG. 14 .
- the STU 27 interfaces are a subset of the PBX 15 interfaces in that the STU 27 provides only one full duplex voice channel operation.
- the timing relationships for the PBX and STU interfaces are identical and are shown in FIG. 15 .
- Table 10 describes the characteristics represented by the symbols used in FIG. 15 .
- the PBX SDAT 0 , 1 , 2 and 3 lines 70 , 71 , 72 , 73 carry data signals from the PBX 15 to the VCU 17 in the base station.
- the data signal is carried on the STU SDAT 0 line 74 from the STU 27 to the VCU 28 ( FIG. 14 ).
- 8-bit .mu. ⁇ 255 companded serial data is sent to the voice codec during the active portion of the PBX/STU GATEO or PBX GATE 1 . . . 3 at a clock rate of 256 KHz. Data is clocked into the VCU 17 , 28 on the rising edge of the 256 KHz clock.
- the VCU SDAT 0 1 , 2 and 3 lines 75 , 76 , 77 , 78 carry data signals from the VCU to the PBX 15 in the base station.
- the VCU SDATO line 29 carries data from the VCU 28 to the STU 27 in the subscriber station.
- 8-bit .mu. ⁇ 255 companded serial data is sent to the PBX 15 or STU 27 from the voice codec during the active high portion of PBX/STU GATEO or PBX GATE 1 . . . 3 at a 256 KHz clock rate. Data is clocked out of the VCU 17 , 28 on the rising edge of the 256 KHz clock.
- the PBX GATE 0 , 1 , 2 and 3 lines 80 , 81 , 82 , 83 carry gate signals from the PBX 15 to the VCU 17 in the base station.
- the STU GATE 0 line 84 carries a gate signal from the STU 27 to the VCU 28 in the subscriber station.
- the gate signal is an active high signal used to enable transfer of PBX/STU SDAT 0 , PBX SDAT 1 . . . 3 and VCU SDAT 0 . . . 3 . This gate signal is active for eight consecutive clock periods every 125 microsecond.
- the PBX CLKO, 1 , 2 and 3 lines 85 , 86 , 87 , 88 carry 256 KHz clock signals form the PBX 15 to the VCU 17 in the base station.
- the STU CLKO line 89 carries a 256 KHz clock signal from the STU 27 to the VCU 28 in the subscriber station.
- a 256 KHz clock signal is used to clock the PBX/STU SDAT 0 and PBX SDAT 1 . . . 3 signals into the VCU 17 , 28 and the VCU SDAT 0 . . . 3 signal into the PBX 15 or STU 27 .
- the clocks are not synchronized with any clocks generated within the VCU 17 , 18 , CCU 18 , 29 or modem 19 , 30 .
- the PBX-VCU interface converts four channels of synchronous 64 Kbps serial data into 8-bit parallel data, which is then made available to the four transmit voice codecs 16 at an 8 KHz sampling rate.
- the subscriber station only one channel (channel 0 ) is converted by the STU-VCU interface.
- the necessary clocks and gates are provided by the PBX 15 and the STU 27 .
- the PBX-VCU and STU-VCU interfaces also perform the complementary function for the receive voice codecs.
- 8-bit parallel data received from the four codec channels, is converted into four 64 Kbps synchronous serial channels for transmission back to the PBX 15 .
- one voice channel is converted and sent back to the STU 27 .
- FIG. 16 The hardware interfaces between the VCU 17 , 28 and the CCU 18 , 29 are shown in FIG. 16 .
- the timing relationships for the transmit and receive channels between the VCU and the CCU are shown in FIGS. 17 and 18 respectfully.
- Tables 11 and 12 describe the characteristics represented by the symbols used in FIGS. 17 and 18 respectively.
- FIGS. 17 and 18 detail the events that occur during the VCBTP shown in FIGS. 19A and 19B .
- the individual interface signal definitions are given in the following paragraphs.
- TABLE 11 Symbol Characteristic Min Max Unit td1 voice codec block transfer period — 750 .mu.sec td2 TCVC response time 1.25 15 .mu.sec td3 CCU DMA response time 1.25 .mu.sec td4 handshake delay 15 nsec td5 VC block period delay 150 .mu.sec th1 control data hold nsec th2 status data hold nsec th3 TC data hole nsec ts1 control data setup nsec ts2 status data setup nsec ts3 TC data setup nsec tw1 write width nsec tw2 read width nsec tw3 block request width 1.5 .mu.sec
- FIGS. 19A and 19B show the timing relationships between the various transmit and receive speech blocks that are transferred between the VCU 17 , 18 and CCU 18 , 19 for 16-level phase shift keying (PSK) modulation.
- PSK phase shift keying
- At the top of the FIG. 19A is the system frame timing to which all transfers are referenced. This frame timing is also applicable to FIG. 19B .
- One modem frame is 45 msec in length and includes of four voice slots (or channels). Each voice slot consists of two system voice block periods (SVBP) of speech data each containing 82 symbols (requiring 5.125 msec) and an additional 16 overhead data symbols requiring 1.0 msec of frame time.
- SVBP system voice block periods
- one block of 328 bits (41 bytes) of processed speech is transferred from the VCU 17 , 28 to the CCU 18 , 29 prior to the beginning of each SVBP during a voice codec block transfer period (VCBTP).
- VCU's 64 Kbps input data stream which is associated with a processed speech block, is shown to be partitioned into voice coder block periods (VCBPs) that are 22.5 msec in length.
- VCBPs voice coder block periods
- unprocessed VC input data in VCBPs OA 1 and OB 1 is associated with processed data in VCBTPs OA 1 and OB 1 .
- the VCBPs for channels 0 and 2 are staggered by one-half of a VCBP (i.e., 11.25 msec) from the VCBPs for channels 1 and 3 .
- one block of 328 bits (41 bytes) of processed speech is transferred from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 at the end of each SVBP during a VCBTP.
- the time skew of the VCBP to the VCBTP is implementation dependent and a (maximum) offset of one VCBP is shown in FIG. 19B .
- FIGS. 19A and 19B To understand the relationship of voice codec's input and output data, refer to FIGS. 19A and 19B .
- compressed speech data transferred during VCBTPs OA 10 and OB 10 is associated with the processed expanded data stream in VCBPS OA 10 and OB 10 .
- the TCADDR lines 90 carry transmit channel address signals from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 . These three address lines are used to select the current transmit channel address.
- the TCDATA bus 91 carries transmit channel data signals between the VCU 17 , 28 and the CCU 18 , 29 .
- the TCDAV line 92 carries a transmit channel data available signal from the VCU 17 , 28 to the CCU 18 , 29 .
- the TCDAV/signal indicates to the CCUI 18 , 29 that a data byte is available in the TCDATA register.
- the TCDAV signal remains low until a TCDACK signal is activated.
- the TCDACK line 93 carries a transmit channel data acknowledgment signal from the CCU 18 , 29 to VCU 17 , 28 .
- the TCDACK/signal gates the data onto the TCDATA bus and resets the TCDAV/.
- the TCSCWR line 94 carries a transmit signal status/control write signal from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 .
- the TCSCWR signal writes the voice codec control word into the appropriate transmit channel control register determined by the TCADDR lines. Data is latched into the register on the rising edge of the TCSCWR signal.
- the TCSCRD line 95 carries a transmit signal status/control read signal from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 .
- the TCSCRD signal gates the status byte onto the TCDATA bus from the voice codec status register designated by the TCADDR lines.
- the BLOCKRQ line 96 carries a block request signal from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 .
- the BLOCKRQ signal is used to initiate a 41 byte block transfer of data from the voice codec (specified by the TCADDR lines) to the CCU 18 , 29 over the TCDATA bus.
- BLOCKRQ is used by the voice codec for start of VCBP timing.
- the TCVCRST line 97 carries a transmit channel voice codec reset signal from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 .
- the transmit voice codec specified by the TCADDR lines is reset.
- the RCADDR lines 98 carry receive channel address signals from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 . These address lines are used to select the current receive channel address as follows.
- the RCDATA bus 98 carries receive channel data signals between the CCU 18 , 29 and the VCU 17 , 28 .
- the RCDAV line 100 carries a receive channel data available signal from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 .
- the RCDAV signal indicates to the voice codec specified by the RCADDR lines that a data byte is available in the RCDATA register.
- the RCDAV signal gates the data onto the RCDATA bus and into the RCDATA register, and resets the RCDACK line.
- the RCDACK line 101 carries a receive channel data acknowledge signal from the VCU 17 , 28 to the CCU 18 , 29 .
- the RCDACK signal indicates to the CCU 18 , 29 that the data has been read from the RCDATA register and that another byte may be transferred from the CCU 18 , 29 .
- the RCSCWR line 102 carries a receive channel status/control write signal from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 .
- the RCSCWR signal writes the control word into the appropriate voice codec control register determined by the RCADDR lines. Data is latched into the register on the rising edge of RCSCWR signal.
- the RCSCRD line 103 carries a channel status/control read signal from the VCU 17 , 28 to the CCU 18 , 29 .
- the RCSCRD signal gates the voice codec status word onto the RCDATA bus from the status register designated by the RCADDR lines.
- the BLOCKRDY line 104 carries a block ready signal from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 .
- the BLOCKRDY signal is used to initiate a 41 byte block transfer of data from the CCU 18 , 29 to the voice codec specified by the RCADDR lines.
- the BLOCKRDY signal is used by the voice codec for start VCBP timing.
- the CCU 18 , 29 is required to have a data byte available in the RCDATA register prior to the rising edge of the BLOCKRDY signal.
- the RCVCRST line 105 carries a receive channel voice codec reset signal from the CCU 18 , 29 to the VCU 17 , 28 .
- the voice code specified by the RCADDR lines is reset by the RCVCRST signals.
- the receive channel VCU hardware receives 41 byte blocks of input data from the CCU 18 , 29 during a VCBTP as shown in FIG. 20A .
- the 8-bit .mu.-law companded data is transferred at an 8 KHz rate to the PBX (STU) interface module.
- Data buffering is performed within the VCU 17 , 28 to simplify the input/output requirements of the CCU 18 , 29 .
- Control information is passed between the VCU 17 , 28 and the CCU 18 , 29 via a set of control and status ports for each receive channel at the beginning of a VCBTP as shown in FIG. 18 .
- the following operating modes are supported by the receive codecs:
- Speech bandwidth expansion is performed with an input data rate of 14.6 Kbps (328 bits every 22.5 msec), and an output data rate of 64 Kbps.
- Speech data may also include DTMF tones.
- FIG. 20A provides an example of the input and output data timing and content for 16 PSK modulation.
- the transmit channel VCU hardware receives 8-bit .mu.-law companded PCM (at 8 KHz sampling rate) from the PBX/STU interface. Mter processing the data according to the current mode of operation, the output data is transferred to the CCU 18 , 29 in blocks of 41 bytes during a voice codec block transfer period (VCBTP) as shown in FIG. 19A . Data buffering is performed within the VCU 17 , 28 to simplify the input/output requirements of the CCU 18 , 29 . Control information is passed between the VCU 17 , 28 and the CCU 18 , 29 via a set of control and status ports for each transmit channel at the beginning of a VCBTP as shown in FIG. 17 . The following operating modes are supported by the transmit codecs:
- Speech bandwidth compression is performed with an output data rate of 14.6 Kbps. (328 bits every 22.5 msec.) Processed speech data is transferred in 41 byte blocks to the CCU 18 , 29 . Speech data may also include Dual-Tone-Multi-Frequency (DTMF) tones.
- DTMF Dual-Tone-Multi-Frequency
- previously processed speech data is passed from the PBX 15 or the STU 27 through the VCU 17 , 28 and into the CCU 18 , 29 .
- the 64 Kbps input data stream consists of an idle byte patter (FF hex), one sync byte (55 hex), 41 previously processed compressed speech data bytes, and additional idle bytes until the next sync byte occurs.
- the voice codec monitors the input data for the sync byte, which occurs on a byte boundary, then buffers the 41 bytes of speech data.
- the speech block is then transferred to the CCU 18 , 29 during the next VCBTP as described above.
- FIG. 20B provides an example of the input and output data timing and content for 16-PSK modulation. Segment 1 on the output channel is a sync byte; and 2 is a processed speech byte. The cross-hatched segment represents an idle byte pattern. Note that the sync and speech data bytes will not occur across VCBP boundaries.
- a codec frame is defined according to the implementation requirements of the RELP algorithm, but the frame must be an integer sub-multiple of the voice coded block period (VCBP), which is 22.5 msec.
- VCBP voice coded block period
- VCBTPA After a reset of any one (or all) codecs, VCBTPA will be the first block transferred from the CCU 18 , 29 , as shown in FIG. 19A , for example.
- Control Channel Unit (CCU)
- the channel controller unit performs similar functions in both the subscriber stations and the base station.
- the hardware used in the two station types for the CCU function is, in fact, identical.
- the software in the subscriber station differs slightly from that in the base station.
- the CCU performs many functions pertaining to the information formatting and timing associated with operation on the time-division transmission channels.
- Basic inputs to the CCU come from four sources.
- This data may be encoded voice samples or data samples from the RS-232 data port 10 in the STU.
- FIG. 12 . In any case, the digital channels operate at 16 Kbps.
- the second input to the CCU comes via the baseband control channel (BCC) from the STU 27 (in the subscriber station) or the RPU 20 (in the base station). This second input provides control messages pertaining to modes of operation, status and control information. Many of the BCC messages from the CCU 18 , 20 are radio control channel (RCC) messages which have been received by the CCU 18 , 29 .
- BCC baseband control channel
- RRC radio control channel
- the CCU 28 , 29 forwards the control information from the RCC messages to the STU 27 or the RPU 20 and, in response, receives control messages from the RPU 20 or the STU 27 . This determines what the CCU 18 , 20 is to do with the data from the VCU 17 , 28 .
- the third input source provides timing and status information from the modem 19 , 30 a .
- the modem 19 provides the master clock signal used in the VCU-CCU-modem chain.
- the modem 19 , 30 a provides status on the accuracy of its bit-tracking synchronization, RF AGC level settings and other “goodness” indicators which are used by the CCU 18 , 29 to determine if adequately reliable communications are occurring over the channel.
- the CCU 18 , 29 attempts to control the “fine-tuning” of the instantaneous modem 19 , 30 a operation through commands to vary the transmit power levels, the AGC levels and the timing/ranging computation. Quality level measurements of modem transmissions are reported to the RPU 20 or the STU 27 .
- the fourth input source is the actual modem data received as symbols of up to four bits each (depending on the modulation levels). These symbols are buffered, demultiplexed and output to the VCU 17 , 28 receive circuits for decoding.
- FIG. 21 is a block diagram of the CCU.
- the architecture of the CCU is essentially that of two one-way direct memory access (DMA) data channels with an intelligent microprocessor controller.
- the function of the DMA channels is to transfer data from the VCU to the modem and vice versa.
- the CCU interface to the VCU includes two parallel DMA buses, a TX bus 107 for the transmit channel (VCU to CCU to modem) and a RX bus 108 for the receive channel (modem to CCU to VCU).
- Data processed by the transmit circuits in the VCU is buffered in the VCU memory until the CCU requests a DMA transfer. Forty-one bytes are transferred to the CCU during each block transfer period.
- the CCU receives these transmit bytes via a transmit voice codec interface module (TVCIM) 109 and buffers them in a transmit memory module (TMM) 110 .
- TVCIM transmit voice codec interface module
- TMM transmit memory module
- a CCU processor embodied in a microcontroller module (MCM) 111 appends a control/sync header to the coded voice bytes, thereby formatting a complete voice packet for transmission to the modem via a transmit modem interface module 112 .
- MCM 111 maintains frame timing information and transfers the data to the modem at the proper time. Before being transferred to the modem the transmit data is converted by the MCM 111 from the eight-bit byte format used by the CCU to a symbol format containing 1, 2 or 4 bits per symbol, depending on the modulation levels for that slot.
- the reverse process is performed for the receive data from the modem.
- Data from the modem is received by a receive modem interface module (RMIM) 114 and buffered in a receive memory module (RMM) 115 .
- This data is then converted from the 1, 2 or 4-bit-per-symbol format used by the modem to the eight-bit byte format used internally by the CCU and all other baseband processing.
- the overhead and control bits are stripped from the incoming data stream on the RX bus 108 by the MCM 111 according to its knowledge of the frame timing, which is provided by the modem to a frame timing module (FTM) 116 and its own identification of various code words in the symbol stream.
- the converted data is provided to the VCU via a receive voice codec interface module (RVCIM) 117 .
- RVCIM receive voice codec interface module
- the CCU also provides the link-level control of the radio control channel (RCC) transmissions at both the base and subscriber stations.
- RCC radio control channel
- the CCU controls the reception and formatting of messages from the RPU in the base station to the STU controller in the subscriber stations.
- This control function of the CCU involves detection and error control in the RCC messages as well as the formatting and packetizing of the RCC information for transmission across the radio link.
- the CCU also detects collisions on the incoming RCC at the base station.
- the CCU controls the power and ranging computations for subscriber stations performing initial acquisition efforts. The protocol for acquisition and other RCC functions have been described above.
- FIG. 22 shows the software-implemented functional architecture of the CCU.
- the CCU has three separate data paths: the transmit bus TX 107 , the receive bus RX 108 and the microcontroller local bus 119 .
- the microcontroller 111 shares the TX bus 107 with a memory access (DMA) controller 120 and shows the RX bus 108 with a director DMA controller 121 .
- the microcontroller 111 uses these remote buses to control the DMA controller peripherals, the control/status registers 122 and to access both the transmit buffer memory 110 and the receive buffer memory 115 .
- the control and status registers 122 off of the microcontroller local bus 119 provide interfaces to the RFU, the modem and the CCU hardware.
- An RS-232C link 123 between the RPU and the CCU is supported by a UART on the microcontroller chip 111 . In the subscriber station, the RPU is replaces by the STU, but the interface remains the same.
- the microcontroller 111 has access to three physically separate RAM areas: local RAM, the transmit buffer and the receive buffer. Local RAM can further be broken down into on-chip RAM and off-chip RAM. The transmit buffer and the receive buffer can only be accessed by the microcontroller when the respective DMA controller is idle.
- the transmit buffer 110 is divided into a number of distinct segments. Each segment contains the skeleton of a voice or RCC packet, ready for transmission over the channel.
- the preamble and unique word (RCC only) are constants initialized by the microcontroller 111 after a CCU reset.
- the code word (voice only), voice data and RCC data are written into the transmit buffer 110 by the microcontrollerjust prior to the DMA transfer to the modem 19 , 30 a . Since the RCC “null ACK” is a fixed message sent with a high frequency, it is stored as a separate entity in the transit buffer 110 .
- the receive buffer 115 is divided into a number of distinct segments.
- One segment is for the storage of voice data, which is buffered and transferred on a VCU block basis.
- RCC data is buffered separately from voice data to allow its retention over a longer period of time. If necessary, the microcontroller 111 can maintain a two frame RCC history in the receiver buffer 115 , making the RCC copy task (from buffer to local RAM) less of a time critical event.
- the local RAM contains the working variables used by the microcontroller 111 .
- One important data structure stored there supports the baseband control channel (BCC) between the CCU and the RPU.
- BCC baseband control channel
- One register bank of the local RAM is assigned to provide basic queue information to the RS232C interrupt handler.
- a pointer and length field in this bank defines the active transmit data block (TXDB), from which data is read and transmitted.
- TXDB contains length and pointer information to the next TXDB in the queue; hence forming a linked list.
- a circular buffer is used to store incoming data bytes. When a complete message is received, the interrupt handler flags the serial code to interpret it.
- the microcontroller 111 uses its local bus 119 to access the modem, RFU and CCU control/status registers 122 .
- the bus also provides access, through isolation logic circuits 124 and 125 to the TX bus 107 and the RX bus 108 respectively.
- isolation logic circuits 124 and 125 to the TX bus 107 and the RX bus 108 respectively.
- the remote buses 107 , 108 are only accessed by the microcontroller 111 when the respective DMA controller 120 or 121 is idle.
- BCC baseband control channel
- Asynchronous characters are eight-bit binary and are transmitted at 9600 baud. One start bit and one stop bit are used for data byte framing. Messages are terminated by a unique byte with byte stuffing employed to avoid having the unique byte occur within a message. An alternating bit protocol and an eight bit checksum are used to ensure link integrity.
- Two external interrupts are supported by the microcontroller. One is generated by the transmit DMA controller 120 and the other is generated by the receive DMA controller 121 . These interrupts occur when the respective controller 120 , 121 completes its block transfer; hence, releasing control of its bus to the microcontroller 111 .
- the BCC interface is driven by an internal interrupt.
- the software is interrupted upon receipt or transmission of a byte.
- the CCU microcontroller 111 is responsible for controlling and monitoring the entire four channel data path assigned to it, which includes the VCU 17 , 28 , the CCU 18 , 29 , the modem 19 , 30 a and the RFU 20 , 31 a .
- the microcontroller 111 controls and monitors the same hardware, but supports only one data path.
- the CPU in turn, is controlled by the RPU (in the base station) or the STU (in the subscriber station).
- the CCU provides the VCU with mode of operation information. Mode changes occur only on system slot boundaries.
- the CCU also provides the VCU with information as to the position of the VCU block within the system slot (there are two VCU blocks per system slot).
- VCU addressing is established by the CCU prior to a data transfer, which accomplishes the MUX/DEMUX task.
- VCU status is read by the CCU after each block transfer and appropriate statistics are maintained by the CCU.
- the CCU can also initiate a VCU hard reset and/or a VCU.
- the microcontroller 111 provides the current modulation level to a symbol-to-byte converter 126 on the RX bus 108 and a byte-to-symbol converter 127 on the TX bus 107 .
- the modem is provided with information concerning the type of data being received, RCC or voice, due to the different acquisition procedures used in their reception.
- the modem provides the CCU with a fractional clock offset, AGC level and link quality value every slot.
- the CCU frequency assignment is provided by the RPU or STU.
- the CCU controls the initiation of a modem hard reset, self test or receive side training mode.
- the CCU handles full duplex data flow via the transmit and receive buses 107 , 108 .
- transmit voice data originating at the VCU is block transferred to the transmit buffer 110 via the transmit DMA controller 121 .
- Each block is one VCU block in length; hence, two such transfers are required for each voice channel.
- the CCU provides the VCU with the appropriate channel address prior to the transfer, thus effecting the multiplexing operation.
- the transmit DMA transfers data from the transmit buffer to the reclocking FIFO stock 129 while the modem receives data from the FIFO stock 128 as required.
- Byte to symbol conversion is accomplished by the byte-to-symbol converter 127 during the transfer.
- Control of the transmit DMA peripheral is handled by the microcontroller, along with the creation and insertion of the voice packet code word.
- Receive data flow is verbs much a mirror image of the transmit side.
- Data is written into the reclocking FIFO stack 129 as it appears from the modem 19 , 30 a .
- the receive DMA controller 121 empties the FIFO stack 129 into the receive buffer 115 as required. Symbol-to-byte conversion is accomplished by the symbol-to-byte converter 126 and frame timing is accomplished by the clock circuit 130 . Byte boundary alignment occurs automatically once the channel is in sync. Once a complete VCU block is received, it is DMA block transferred to the appropriate VCU. Control of the receive DMA controller is handled by the microcontroller 111 .
- Code word detection is performed for every slot.
- the microcontroller 111 performs this task by copying the code word byte into the local RAM and comparing it to a list of valid code words.
- the modem 19 , 30 a provides a fractional symbol offset and an AGC value. These are read by the microcontroller 111 and interpreted appropriately. If power or ranging problems exist, the subscriber station is informed of this via the transmit code word.
- Transmit RCC data is synthesized in the transmit buffer 110 by the CCU according to the contents of the RCC message queue. If the RPU has sent an RCC message to the CCU, this message is formatted in the transmit buffer 110 . Otherwise the NULL KNOWLEDGE message, permanently stored in the transmit buffer 110 , is used. Once the RCC packet is ready, the RCC preamble, unique word and RCC data is DMA transferred to the modem 19 , 30 a as it is needed. The CCU performs collision detection and sets the outbound RCC collision detection bit accordingly.
- the receive RCC data handler has two modes: “frame search” and “monitor”.
- frame search mode the RCC channel is considered to be out of sync. Every incoming RCC message must be synchronized using a unique word detection algorithm.
- monitor mode the RCC channel is in sync and the unique word search algorithm is not invoked.
- the base station is always in the frame search mode since subscribers may burst in with bad timing at any time.
- the RCC data handler is in the monitor mode unless the station has not acquired RCC synchronization.
- unique word detection is performed after every RCC slot.
- the microcontroller 111 performs this task by scanning for the unique word in a window about the “nominal” unique word location. Successful unique word detection provides the CCU with symbol timing information.
- Receive RCC data is DMA transferred from the modem 19 , 30 a to the receive buffer 115 . Once the transfer is complete, the RCC data is copied into the local microcontroller RAM for processing. Receive RCC packets are filtered by the CCU. An RCC packet is passed to the RPU only if the unique word is detected and the CRC is correct.
- the corresponding VCU channel is placed in standby. No data transfers occur between the VCU and the CCU during this channel period, both on the transmit and receive data paths 107 , 108 .
- the software executes on an Intel 8031 microcontroller 111 .
- Program storage is provided for by external EPROM on the microcontroller local bus.
- the software is required to respond to DMA service requests in real time, maintaining up to a 64 Kbps data flow in both directions without loss of data.
- FIFO buffering by the stacks 128 and 129 on the modem interface provides the required slack time for the microcontroller 111 to perform the DMA block transfers and system control functions.
- the software is divided into five separate modules: supervisor, data transfer, BCC transceiver, BMM control and utility. Each module is designed to have only one entry and exit point, with the exception of interrupts and error conditions. A further exception to this is the utility module, which contains an assortment of utility routines accessed directly from the other modules. In general, inter-module communication takes place through the use of global variables defined in a separate data segment.
- the supervisor module includes an initialization function, maintains overall program control and performs basic self test functions.
- the data transfer module supports the control of data transfer over the TX bus 107 and the RX bus 108 for both voice and RCC, performs sync word detection for all modulation levels on both voice and RCC data, and supports the CCU-RPU RS-232 communication link 122 .
- the BCC transceiver module performs BCC transceiver duties, handles the BCC queues, formats transmit BCC messages, processes receive BCC data and moves RCC data in and out of the CCU via the BCC.
- the BBM control module controls the RFU, modem, VCU and CCU hardware via registers, reads and interprets status information from these devices (e.g., modem AGC, link quality and symbol ambiguity), decodes embedded code words in the receive voice channel, formats the code word for the transmit voice channel, maintains a real time software/hardware timer and performs online self tests.
- devices e.g., modem AGC, link quality and symbol ambiguity
- the utility module performs miscellaneous utility routines accessed by the other modules.
- the CCU software is divided into four separate processes which essentially operate concurrently. Three are the BCC data, TX DMA and RX DMA processes, which are interrupt driven and are invoked only when a specific event demands attention. All three of the event driven processes are located in the data transfer module. The remaining process, which is distributed among all of the modules, is a background process which initializes, controls and monitors the other three processes.
- BCC messages arrive from the RPU (or STU in the subscriber station), they are received and buffered by the BCC data process. Once a complete message is received, the BCC data process notifies the background process via a mailbox. The background process polls this mailbox during its main loop; hence detecting any new messages. Messages are interpreted by the background and relevant action is taken. Any reply is written into the transmit BCC message queue by the background process and the BCC data process is duly notified.
- BCC messages can initiate a reconfiguration of the CCU data channels.
- the necessary control information is written to the modem 19 , 30 a and the VCU 17 , 28 at the appropriate times.
- the modem acts upon a new control word on slot boundaries.
- the VCU expects mode changes to occur on the first VCU block transfer of a slot boundary.
- the background process is responsible for seeing that the correct control timing is maintained.
- Status gathering is performed by the background, TX DMA process and the RX DMA process, the latter two collect status words from the TX and RX sides of the VCU respectively. This is necessary because these status registers can only be accessed via the TX bus 107 and the RX bus 108 , which are idle only for limited periods of time.
- the background process gathers status information directly from the modem 19 , 30 a via the station registers 122 on the local bus 119 . Once collected, all status information is collated by the background process and stored in specific status variables. Status requests received from the RPU are handled by the background process, based on this status history.
- Some status information may necessitate CCU action. Apart from being stored as states history, such data is used to correct subscriber power and ranging problems.
- power and range information is forwarded directly to the RPU as part of the RCC.
- the background process performs this function by formatting a BCC message containing the RCC, AGC and ranging data. Once the packet is ready it is placed in the transmit BCC queue and the BCC data process is notified.
- this status information is used to format code words which are embedded in outbound voice packets.
- the background process performs this formatting function and controls the transmission of the code word via the voice channel. All code words must be transmitted five frames in a row, providing 5:1 redundancy coding.
- the TX DMA process automatically transmits the code word selected by the background process.
- the background process also maintains a software/hardware real time clock. This is done by polling one of the 8031's timers and counting overflows.
- the real time clock function provides a time base for software timeouts and other time dependent events.
- the background process checks to see that system timing is being maintained by polling CCU hardware error indicators and checking that data transfer events are occurring when they should in the system frame.
- System framing information is provided via the start of system frame status line and a timer connected to the 16 KHz clock 130 . Data synchronization is performed by the background process.
- the BCC data process responds to RS-232 interrupts, which can occur for both the transmit and receive directions of the port.
- the process simply outputs another byte on the transmit side or inputs another byte on the input side.
- An end-of-message delimiters on the receive side causes the BCC data routine to notify the background process.
- the TX DMA process and the RX DMA process handle the transmit and receive DMA channels.
- FIG. 23 is a timing diagram for transferring RCC and 16 PSK voice data on the transmit bus of the CCU.
- FIG. 24 is a timing diagram for transferring RCC and 16 PSK data on the receive bus of the CCU. Tables 13 and 14 describe the characteristics of the time symbols shown in FIGS. 23 and 24 respectively.
- the supervisor module takes care of any hardware and software initialization before entering a main service loop.
- the supervisor module performs some basic self test functions after a hardware reset and upon request from the RPU.
- the main service loop access the other modules in sequence.
- the supervisor module design is such that tasks are subdivided into manageable time-slices, guaranteeing that the main service loop has a reasonable worst case periodicity. Tasks requiring a real time response are handled via interrupt service routines.
- Each interrupt service routine performs the minimum of processing to satisfy the service request. This is done to preserve the serial nature of program execution as much as possible and to keep interrupt queuing to a minimum.
- an interrupt service routine will transfer data to or from an interface and set a boolean to indicate that the action has been performed. Serially executed code, accessed from the main service loop, then proceeds to process that information as required.
- the CCU microcontroller 111 is a data flow machine in that software events are driven by the arrival and departure of data. Precise system timing provides the framework for this data flow; however, software events are derived directly from the flow of data and not from system frame markers. This approach allows the software to respond to “real” events (such as data I/O requests) rather than “artificial” events (such as system timing markers).
- the software relies upon the hardware to convert the former's asynchronous actions into events which are synchronous with the system frame timing. For this to work, it is necessary that the software guarantee to have things initialized and ready before the system frame event occurs.
- the relative timing for the data transfers on the transmit bus and receive bus are shown in FIGS. 23 and 24 .
- the diagrams are drawn approximately to scale and show a worst case timing scenario.
- the time multiplexed nature of the transmit and receive buses is clearly illustrated by the diagrams.
- the dark cross lines shown on the transmit and receive paths correspond to the microcontroller activity on the respective bus (t.sub.S, t.sub.RCC).
- the respective DMA controller 120 , 121 is idle.
- the short periods of time between DMA controller setups (t.sub.VCB) corresponds to VCU block transfers.
- the DMA controller is dedicated to the respective VCU.
- the DMA controller 120 , 121 is dedicated to serving the modem interface.
- the reclocking FIFO stacks 128 , 129 at the modem interface create the primary timing constraint implicit in the timing diagrams.
- the FIFO stacks hold 16 symbols, providing one millisecond of buffering time before underflowing (TX) or overflowing (RX). During this millisecond, the CCU can use the transmit or receive buses 107 , 108 to complete block transfers to and from the VCU or copy RCC data into local RAM.
- the CCU software Upon power-up, the CCU software performs an internal self test and places the VCU, modem and RFU into their default states.
- the microcontroller 111 monitors the system frame timing and begins to perform block transfers to allow the VCU to gain synchronization. Once data transfers are initiated, the microcontroller 111 uses the DMA end of block interrupt to retain system timing. This interrupt is directly tied to the data throughput of the CCU and hence the 16 KHz symbol clock 130 .
- the VCU retains system timing implicitly via DMA transfer requests generated by the microcontroller 111 as a result of the end of block interrupt.
- the microcontroller 111 continues to monitor frame timing to ensure that proper system operation is maintained.
- system startup also entails radio synchronization. This is performed by locating the RCC and deriving system timing from it. Once receive timing is established, the microcontroller 111 to establish transmit timing with the base station.
- the data transfer module supports the real time and background data transfer events in the CCU. Data transfers are serviced for the transmit data path, the receive data path, the transmit BCC and the receive BCC. All of these tasks are interrupt driven events requiring real time response.
- the module also performs synchronization acquisition and monitoring as a background task.
- the transmit data path handler is invoked when the transmit DMA controller 120 requires service. This typically occurs following a DMA block transfer, at which time the DMA peripheral invokes an end of block transfer interrupt.
- the interrupt is received on one of the two external interrupt lines of the Model 8031 microcontroller 111 .
- the service required by the interrupt depends on the type of data transfer, RCC or voice, and the time of occurrence within the slot.
- the transmit data path interrupt occurs at predictable times during each slot period. The interrupt times and durations are shown on FIGS. 23 and 24 .
- the microcontroller 111 is required to initialize the DMA peripheral for the next block transfer. This operation should be performed within 150 us from interrupt request to interrupt completion.
- the first service request requires the microcontroller 111 to format the RCC message in the transmit buffer 110 prior to the DMA transfer. This operation must be completed within 900 us. Since the operations on the transmit path are usually short and require fast response, the interrupt is given the highest priority.
- the only output from the transmit data path interrupt handler is the VCU status word collected after the VCU block transfer. This status word is analyzed by software in the BBM control module.
- the receive data path handler is invoked when the receive DMA controller 121 requires service. This typically occurs following a DMA block transfer, at which time the DMA peripheral invokes an end of block transfer interrupt.
- the interrupt is received on one of the two external interrupt lines of the 8031 microcontroller 111 .
- the service required by the interrupt depends on the type of data transfer, RCC or voice, and the time of occurrence within the slot.
- the receive data path interrupt occurs at predictable times during each slot period. The interrupt times and durations are shown in FIGS. 23 and 24 .
- the microcontroller 111 is required to initialize the DMA controller 121 for the next block transfer. This operation should be performed within 150 microseconds from interrupt request to interrupt completion, if DMA initialization is the only task to be performed.
- the last service request requires the microcontroller 111 to copy the RCC message from the receive buffer 115 to the local RAM after the DMA transfer. This operation must also be completed within 900 microseconds. Since transmit path servicing can occur during this time, receive path interrupts have a lower priority than those of the transmit path.
- the receive data path interrupt handler makes the VCU status word available after each VCU block transfer. This status word is analyzed by software in the BBM control module. The handler also reads new RCC messages from the channel, which are then interpreted in the BCC transceiver module.
- the BCC receive module is implemented via the on-chip RS 232 UART.
- the UART is capable of generating one internal interrupt, which is triggered whenever a byte is received or transmitted.
- the BCC handler polls a status bit to determine which of the two cases caused the interrupt and proceeds to service the port accordingly.
- the baud rate generator is programed for a nominal rate of 9600 baud, resulting in a maximum of 1920 interrupts per second. Each interrupt must be serviced within a 1 ms period to avoid data loss. Since the typical interrupt frequency is low and the response time relatively long, BCC data transfer interrupts have a low priority.
- the BCC data transfer handler uses pointers to queue and de-queue data as it is received and transmitted respectively. Only link level processing occurs here, including byte stuffing and end of message insertion. These actions are described in the system interface specification.
- the data synchronization acquisition and monitoring comprise the major processing functions of the BCC transceiver module.
- Sync word detection implies a synchronization operation at the symbol level.
- the term “sync word” is a generic, applying to both the unique word in the RCC and the code word in voice channels.
- the unique word (UW) is a fixed 8-bit pattern placed at the beginning of an RCC message.
- a code word (CW) is currently any one of 8 possible 8-bit patterns placed at the beginning of a voice channel.
- code words are used to indicate connection status, power adjustments and ranging adjustments.
- the base CCU must exhaustively check for a valid RCC message in every slot. It performs this task by scanning for the unique word in a window .+ ⁇ 0.3 symbols about the nominal UW location, based upon master system timing.
- the search algorithm starts with the nominal UW positions and shifts one symbol right and left until it (1) finds the UW pattern and (2) verifies a correct RCC checksum. The search terminates as soon as (1) and (2) are satisfied or all possibilities have been exhausted.
- the shift information, RCC message and power information are sent to the RPU following a successful search.
- the base station CCU checks the received voice data for a valid code word. Only the nominal code word position is checked since no active symbol synchronization is performed during voice operation. If no code word is detected for five consecutive frames then the channel is declared out of sync and the RPU is informed of the condition. It is up to the RPU to take any appropriate action at this point. Sync is defined to be restored after three-out-of-five consecutive frames have successful code word detection.
- the subscriber CCU when receiving RCC data, can be in one of two modes: “frame search” or “monitor”.
- the frame search mode is used to acquire receive frame timing from the incoming RCC data and is invoked automatically when receive RCC sync is lost.
- the monitor mode is entered whenever receive frame synchronization has been acquired.
- the subscriber CCU When in the frame search mode, the subscriber CCU must exhaustively check for a valid RCC message after every RCC slot. Like the base CCU, it performs this task by scanning for the unique word in a window .+ ⁇ 0.3 symbols about the nominal UW location, based upon timing derived from modem AM hole detection.
- the search algorithm starts with the nominal UW position and shifts one symbol right and left until it (1) finds the UW pattern and (2) verifies a correct RCC checksum.
- the search terminates as soon as (1) and (2) are satisfied or all possibilities have been exhausted.
- the shift information from a successful search is used to adjust the CCU generated receive framing markers. Acquisition terminates when (1) and (2) above are satisfied for three consecutive frames with the UW in its nominal position.
- the STU is informed of framing acquisition when it occurs. RCC messages are not forwarded to the STU during frame search mode.
- the subscriber station CCU When framing acquisition is accomplished, the subscriber station CCU enters the monitor mode. Only the nominal UW position is checked to avoid the possibility of false UW acquisitions. If no UW is detected for five consecutive frames then the channel is declared out of sync and frame search mode is entered. The STU is informed of this out of sync condition. During the monitor mode, RCC messages that have a correct checksum and SIN number are passed on to the STU.
- the subscriber station CCU checks the received voice data for a correct code word. Only the nominal code word position is checked since no active symbol synchronization is performed during voice operation. All possible code words are searched for in this direction of the channel. Code words can cause incremental changes in the subscriber station's power and ranging values. Incremental range changes can actually result in the change of symbol as well as fractional ranging values. If no code word is detected for five consecutive frames then the channel is declared out of sync and the STU is informed of the condition. Sync is defined to be restored after three-out-of-five consecutive frames have successful code word detection.
- the transmit DMA transfer request between the transmit buffer 110 and the modem 19 , 30 a must be derived from the full bit of the FIFO stack 128 . This implies that the FIFO stack 128 will always be full when a DMA block transfer is complete.
- the receive DMA transfer request between the modem 19 , 30 a and the receive buffer 115 must be derived from the empty bit of the stack 129 . This implies that the FIFO stack 129 will always be empty when a DMA block transfer is complete.
- the CCU controller software provides the gate to enable DMA transfers, but external control must provide the handshaking to initiate and maintain the block transfer. This is particularly important for the modem interface where frame timing is critical.
- the microcontroller 111 should have the capability to put a DMA transfer on hold. The software will not attempt to use the DMA bus during a block transfer unless this control is exerted or the DMA peripheral is idle.
- the reclocking FIFO stacks 128 , 129 should be automatically cleared (reset) periodically.
- Frame timing information must be available to the microcontroller 111 . This could take the form of a symbol clock input to an internal timer of the microcontroller.
- the modem operates in one of three operation modes.
- the modem In the base station, the modem carries on a full-duplex transmit and receive function.
- the modem When operating in the subscriber station, the modem operates in a half-duplex mode, transmitting during part of the TDMA frame and receiving during another part of the TDMA frame.
- the third mode is a self-adapting training mode.
- One modem design accommodates all these functions.
- the modem performs the appropriate function in response to keying signals coming in from the controlling CCU.
- the subscriber station modem 30 a and the base station modem 19 are identical.
- a block diagram of the modem is shown in FIG. 25 .
- the modem transmitter sections include a TX symbol filter 132 , a digital-to-analog (D/A) converter 133 , a 200 KHz bandpass filter 134 , a mixer 135 and a TX (transmitter) timing control circuit 136 .
- the receiver section of the modern includes a mixer 138 , an analog-to-digital (A/D) converter 139 , a FIFO stack 140 and a Model TMS 320 microprocessor 141 .
- the modem transmitter section transmits the information fed to it by the CCU at 16-level PSK modulation. It is up to the CCU an the receive side to interpret the data as DPSK, QPSK or 16 PSK.
- the modem transmits without the knowledge of the modulation level.
- the modem transmitter section is fully implemented in hardware and requires no adjustments. Symbols received from the CCU are encoded and their corresponding waveforms are shaped to provide good interference properties and not suffer amplitude or group delay distortion. The justification of this concept is made on the assumption that in the near neighborhood frequency band (within 50-100 KHz) to the band utilized there are no strong interfering signals (power densities of 30-40 dB above the signal).
- the modem transmitter section utilizes relatively wide IF filtering (100 KHz) so that the transmitted signal will not suffer amplitude or group delay distortion, and also filters out any harmonics generated by the digital filtering done at baseband.
- the TX symbol filter 132 is a fixed-coefficient digital FIR (Finite-duration impulse-response) Filter. This filter 132 simulates a six pole filter with a sampling rate of 50 samples per symbol per 6 symbol stay in the FIR Filter.
- FIR Finite-duration impulse-response
- the modem receives symbols from its respective CCU at a rate of 16K symbols/second. These symbols are then converted to a DPSK code for input on line 143 to the FIR filter 132 .
- the FIR algorithm requires that every other symbol be inverted before entering into the FIR filter. Gray code is used for the DPSK coding. This insures that if a symbol was received in error, there is a good probability that the two symbols to the receiver codec will be in error by only one bit.
- the FIR filter oversamples the symbols at a rate of 800 KHz so that every symbol is sampled 50 times during its 5T stay in the filter. This is equivalent to a sampling rate of 3T/25 where the sampling period is T/25, so that samples are output each 3T/25 period.
- the outputs are skewed such that only the first and fourth, second and fifth, or third and sixth pairs of samples overlap at any one time.
- Each of these T/25 length samples is actually divided into two parts.
- the I portion of the output is computed and during the second half of the period, the Q portion of the output is computed.
- the I and O sampling is staggered by one-half a sample period, but this is corrected by the FIR filter 132 .
- Signals representing the multiplication of symbols and impulse responses in the FIR 132 filter and the addition of two of these multiplications are provided by an 8K.times.8 ROM on line 144 in response to the symbols that are received on line 143 .
- the FIR filter 132 outputs 10 bit digital samples on line 144 at the rate of 800 KHz. These values are the fed into the D/A converter 133 to create an analog waveform on line 145 . This waveform is the time-shared I and Q waveforms of the symbol to be transmitted. This shared waveform on line 145 is filtered by the 200 KHz bandpass filter 134 then fed over line 146 into the mixer 135 .
- the mixer's local oscillator input is an IF frequency signal of 20 MHz on line 147 .
- the I and Q components are thereby upconverted to 20.2 MHz IF output signal on line 148 .
- the output signal on line 148 is fed through a 20.2 MHz bandpass filter (not shown) and provided to the RFU 21 , 31 a.
- the desired signal out of the D/A converter 134 is centered at 200 KHz with a bandwidth of about 32 KHz.
- the output waveform mixes the I and Q samples with the SIN and COS components of the IF frequency.
- the 20 MHz signal can directly multiply the output waveform and the exact component multiplications will be handled automatically. Therefore, there is no need for a discrete SIN(IF)/COS(IF) generation circuit to multiply the I/Q samples from the D/A as is in the receiver. This also removes isolation feed through in the mixer from the baseband to the output of the mixer.
- the output data stored in the transmitter FIR filter 132 is computed to correct for any errors that may occur due to the ⁇ fraction (1/50) ⁇ T difference in the I and Q time values. Also the IF filter in the RFU ( FIGS. 28 and 29 ) adds the two values together to form the correct transmitted waveform since its bandwidth is relatively small compared to the IF frequency.
- the mixer 138 mixes an analog waveform received from the RFU on line 150 via a 20 MHz bandpass filter (not shown) with a 20 MHz IF signal on line 151 to down convert the analog signal to baseband on line 152 .
- the analog signal is then converted by the A/O converter 139 to a digital signal on line 153 which is buffered in the FIFO stack 140 for processing by the microprocessor 141 .
- the microprocessor 141 performs frequency and bit tracking of the received digital signal and also performs the FIR filtering and demodulation of the signal into a binary symbol stream that is provided on line 154 to the CCU.
- control and status signals are sent to and from the modem. These signals generally are sent to the modem from the CCU.
- the modem also sends control signals to the RFU to control such functions as the transmit power level, frequency, AGC, and antenna switching for diversity.
- the modem interfaces are shown in FIGS. 26 and 27 .
- the modem receives most of its inputs from the CCU. Other inputs are from the RFU and the timing units.
- the modem inputs are as follows:
- the following lines carry the signals described to the is modem 19 , 30 a from the CCU 18 , 29 :
- the TX DATA lines 156 carry a 4 bit symbol to be transmitted by the modem (2 bits for QPSK, 1 bit for BPSK).
- the MOD BUS 157 is a bidirectional microprocessor bus that provides control/status information to/from the modem.
- the MOD WR line 158 carries a control signal to the latch MOD BUS into the modem.
- the MOD RD line 159 carries a control signal to put modem status and other information onto the MOD BUS for transmission to the CCU 18 , 29 .
- the MOD RESET line 160 carries a control signal to reset the modem.
- the MOD ADD lines 161 carry address signals to different locations to latch values inside the modem.
- the TX SOS line 162 carries a signal to begin transmitting a TX slot.
- the RX SOS line 163 carries a signal to begin receiving an RX slot.
- the IF RECEIVE line 165 carries an IF receive frequency input signal to the modem 19 , 30 a from the RFU 21 , 31 a.
- the following lines carry the signals described to the modem 19 from the STIMU 35 .
- the 80 MHZ line 167 carries an 80 MHz ECL clock signal.
- a like signal is provided to the modem 30 a by a timing unit (not shown) in the subscriber station.
- the 16 KHz line 168 carries a master TX CLK signal used in base station.
- the SOMF line carries a master start of frame signal in the base station from STIMU. This signal is not used in the modem, but forwarded to the CCU 18 , 29 .
- the following lines carry the signals described from the modem 19 , 30 a to the CCU 18 , 29 .
- the TX CLK line 171 carries a 16 KHz clock signal that provides the CCU with the symbol transmit timing. Symbols are clocked into the modem with the rising edge of this clock. In the base station, all slots have the same master TX CLK. Thus all signals from the base station are sent at the same time. In the subscriber station, the TX CLK is offset by the fractional range delay by the modem on information supplied by the CCU.
- the RX CLK line 172 carries the 16 KHz clock signal that is derived from the received signal.
- This signal is always provided in the subscriber station, but is provided only during control slot acquisition in the base station.)
- This clock signal clocks out the received symbol to the CCU and provide symbol timing to the CCU.
- the RX DATA lines 173 carry the four bit received symbol, clocked by RX CLK signal.
- the MOD BUS 157 carries status and data information from the modem.
- the MOD SOMF line 175 forwards the SOMF signal from the STIMU to the CCU in the base station.
- the AM STROBE line 176 carries a high to low transition to give the CCU a rough frame marker during RCC acquisition in the subscriber station. This is a one shot line that is pulsed when the microprocessor 141 determines the approximate location of the AM hole.
- the following lines carry the signals described from the modem 19 , 30 a to each RFU 21 , 31 a .
- the RF RX BUS 178 is an 8-bit bus between the modem and RFU section. This bus conveys AGC and frequency select information to the RF RX section.
- the modem controls AGC values to be sent, and forwards CCU frequency selection information.
- the frequency select information is fed to the modem by the CCU over the MOD BUS 157 .
- the modem will control the RF RX frequency selection.
- the RF TX BUS 179 is an 8-bit bus between the modem and the RFU TX section. This bus conveys TX power level and frequency select information to the RFU TX section.
- the modem has nothing to do with these, thus the information is only forwarded to the RF TX section.
- the RX 80 MHZ REF line 180 carries an ECL 80 MHz reference clock signal to the RFU RX section.
- the TX EN line 182 to the RFU TX section carries a signal to enable RF transmission.
- the RX EN line 183 to RFU RX section carries a signal to enable RF reception.
- the AGC WR line 184 carries a write strobe to latch AGC data into RFU RX section.
- the RXFREQ WR line 185 carries a write strobe for frequency writes to the RFU TX section.
- the PWR WR line 186 carries a write strobe to latch power information into RFU TX section.
- the PWR RD line 187 carries a read strobe to read back power information from the RFU TX section.
- the TXFREQ RD line 188 carries a read strobe to read back transmit frequency from the RFU TX section.
- the TXFREQ WR line 189 carries write strobe frequency writes to the RFU TX section.
- the IF TRANSMIT line 190 carries the transmitted signal at IF frequency to the RFU.
- the following lines carry the signals described from the modem 19 to the STIMU 35 .
- the VCXO BUS 192 is a 20-bit data bus to a VCXO in the STIMU 35 with control information for frequency tracking.
- the VCXO WR line carries a write pulse to the VCXO circuit for latching the VCXO BUS 192 into the VCXO.
- Like signals are carried from the modem 30 a to a timing unit (not shown) in the subscriber station.
- the base station modem operation is assigned to a fixed RF frequency. Communication at the base station is full duplex, therefore the modem receiver and transmitter will be operating simultaneously.
- a modem also is assigned to be the control frequency channel modem, thus only transmitting and receiving information with the radio control channel (RCC) format during the allocated control slot period. All transmissions from the base station modems are clocked to the master TX CLK signal at 16 KHz on line 171 .
- the base station modems 19 output to the CCU 18 the fractional part of the symbol time between the master TX CLK signal on line 171 and the derived RX CLK signal on line 172 in the modem 19 . This information is then sent to the subscriber station in the RCC so that the subscriber station will delay its transmission in order that is signal is received at the base station synchronous with all other slots.
- the base station modem 19 also transmits a null energy signal in the control slot to provide the RCC AM hole (which establishes a frame reference) when the RFU transmits a null energy signal. This no-carrier portion of the RCC transmission is used for initial RX acquisition at the subscriber station.
- the modem 19 is unaware of the fact that there are four voice codecs in the base station, multiplexed by the CCU 18 , for four 16 PSK subscriber slot assignments.
- the modem 19 accepts the bit stream from the CCU 18 and treats the transmission just as a single codec subscriber.
- All operations in the subscriber station modem 30 a are derived from the received RX CLK signal on line 172 which is recovered from the received transmission. This serves as the master clock of the subscriber station.
- the TX CLK signal on line 171 to the CCU 29 is not a master clock as in the base station. It is derived from the RX CLK signal on line 172 and delayed by the fractional time as selected by the CCU 29 .
- the CCU 29 determines the delay from the RCC. The delay is determined by the distance between base and subscriber stations.
- the subscriber station CCU 29 feeds this fractional time information to the modem 30 a through MOD BUS 157 .
- the modem 30 a itself accounts for the fractional delay.
- the CCU 29 accounts for the integer symbol delay be insertion of the TX SOS signal an line 162 delayed by the correct number of symbols. This process aligns the signals arriving at the base station from variations in the range of all subscriber stations.
- the subscriber station modem 30 a does not transmit an AM guard band for the RCC slot. None is required since the base station defines the frame. Unlike the fixed frequency base station modems 19 , subscriber station modems 30 a also can transmit or receive data over any one of the 26 frequencies selected in the RFU by the CCU 29 .
- the delay between the TX SOS signal on line 162 in the base station and the first received analog symbol “peak” at the base station is +7.4 symbols. Therefore, there is a skew between TX and RX slots.
- the modem To correctly decode the incoming phase, the modem must begin sampling about 3.5 symbols before the “peak” arrives. Therefore, the skew between TX SOS signal and the beginning of RX sampling is about 4 symbols in length.
- the start of the RX slot occurs about 4 T after the start of the TX slot.
- the RX slot start is defined as the time the first analog sample is taken in order to detect the first “peak” that is received.
- the subscriber station clocks are derived completely from a master 80 MHz VCXO in the subscriber station timing unit (not shown).
- the VCXO is controlled by an analog line from the modem 30 a . From this, all receive and transmit clocks are calculated.
- the modem 30 a then provides the CCU 29 with the 16 KHz RX CLK signal on line 172 derived from the incoming data stream.
- the CCU 29 itself detects the unique word in the control channel and can determine frame and slot markers from the unique word and the RX CLK signal on line 172 .
- the AM hole signal from the signal demodulated by the modem informs the CCU 29 where to look for the unique word.
- the modem 19 , 30 a performs frequency synchronization by acquisition and then continues tracking.
- the VCXO is under direct control of the microprocessor 141 through a D/A converter.
- the microprocessor frequency acquisition and tracking algorithms compute the changes in the VCXO necessary to maintain synchronization.
- the modem 19 , 30 a also performs bit synchronization on the bit sync scramble of the received data stream.
- An algorithm performs a bit tracking loop inside the receiver.
- the microprocessor 141 has control over a variable frequency divider of the 80 MHz VCXO or OCXO (only during control slot demodulation). Inside of the bit tracking loop, the microprocessor 141 modifies the frequency division in order to obtain bit synchronization.
- the division values have step sizes of 0.1% of 16 KHz, but during a control slot the values may change more drastically, as much as .+ ⁇ 0.50%.
- the master SOMF start of modem frame
- the CCU 18 can derive all slot and frame timing.
- frame synchronization is done by the CCU 29 with the detection of the unique word in the received RCC data stream.
- the modem 30 a Upon initial acquisition, the modem 30 a provides a one shot, approximate frame marker (AM STROBE) on line 176 .
- AM STROBE approximate frame marker
- the modem 30 a searches for the AM HOLE in the RCC. IF the AM HOLE is detected, the modem 30 a counts it for a few frames and then provide the AM STROBE marker on line 176 to the CCU 29 at the frame location of the AM HOLE.
- the CCU 29 uses this strobe marker to set un initial frame marker counters (windowing) that can he modified by CCU software for exact frame sync. This also signifies that the AM HOLE was detected and the RCC is acquired.
- the self adapting mode is a looped-back state that the modem enters to train the receiver's digital FIR filter coefficients to correct for any receive analog filter degradations that may occur in time or with temperature.
- the analysis is done by looping back the transmitter data through the RF unit and receiving a known pattern in the receiver.
- the coefficients are optimized over a 5 constraint LaGrangian system. These constraints are (1) the received data stream; (2) the data stream delayed by 0.05 T; (3) the data stream advanced by 0.05 T; (4) the data stream from the adjacent upper channel; and (5) the data steam from the adjacent lower channel.
- the microprocessor 141 provides to the TX FIR filter 131 on line 143 a series of 32 symbol long training patterns. This is done via a FIFO stack (not shown) that is enabled during the training mode. Advances/delays are done by the receive bit track circuitry that will skew the two streams by 0.05 T.
- the CCU 18 , 29 places the modem 19 , 30 a into the training mode to allow the modem transmitter section to read special training data from the FIFO stack on board the modem.
- the receiver section will be advanced/delayed for some of the tests.
- the modem sends a status message to the CCU 18 , 29 that the coefficients are computed.
- the CCU 18 , 29 tests the modem by placing it in normal operation and writing out a set pattern, commanding the RFU 21 , 31 a to loopback, and read the returned data and test for validity.
- the RFU subsystem provides the communications channel link between the modem and the antenna in both the base station and the subscriber station.
- the RFU functions as a linear amplitude and frequency translator and is essentially transparent to the channel data and modulation characteristics.
- the antenna interface circuit for the subscriber station is shown in FIG. 28 .
- a RFU control logic circuit 192 is coupled to the transmitter antenna 32 , and the three receiver antennas 32 a , 32 b and 32 c by the antenna interface circuit.
- the RFU control logic circuit 192 is also interfaced with the transmit section of the modem 30 a , and the receive sections of the modems 30 a , 30 b and 30 c .
- 32 and 32 a are the same antenna.
- the transmitter section of the antenna interface includes an up converter and amplifier circuit 193 , a TX synthesizer 194 , a power amplifier 196 and a TX/RX mode switch 197 .
- a fist receiver section RX 1 of the antenna interface includes a down converter and amplifier 198 , a RX synthesizer 199 and a preamplifier 200 which is connected to switch 197 .
- the RFU control logic circuit 192 provides the following signals to the transmitter section of the antenna interface circuit in response to the signals received from the transmit section of the modem 30 a : (1) a TX enable signal on line 206 for causing the TX/RX switch 197 to enable transmission by the transmitter antenna 32 ; (2) an IF input signal on line 207 to the up converter and amplifier 193 ; (3) a power control signal on line 208 , also up to the up converter and amplifier 193 ; (4) a clock reference signal on line 209 to the TX synthesizer 194 ; and (5) a channel select signal on line 210 , also to the TX synthesizer 194 .
- the TX synthesizer 194 responds to the channel select signal on line 210 by providing a TX frequency select signal on line 211 to the up converter and amplifier 193 that is equal to the difference between the desired transmit frequency and the modem IF frequency.
- the RFU control logic circuit 192 provides the following signals to each of the receiver sections of the antenna interface circuit in response to the signals received from the respective receive sections of the modems 30 a , 30 b and 30 c : (1) a TX enable signal on lines 213 to cause the down converter and amplifier circuits 198 , 202 to operate in the receive modes; (2) an automatic gain control (AGC) signal on lines 214 to the down converter and amplifier circuits 198 , 202 ; (3) a clock reference signal on lines 215 to the RX synthesizers 199 , 203 ; and (4) a channel select signal on lines 216 also to the RX synthesizers 199 , 203 respond to the channel select signal on lines 216 by providing a RX frequency select signal on lines 217 to the down converter and amplifier circuits 198 , 202 that is equal to the difference between the desired receive frequency and the modem IF frequency.
- the down converter and amplifier circuits 198 , 202 provide IF output signals on line 218 to the R
- the up converter and amplifier circuit 193 in the transmitter section receives the modulated IF signal on line 207 , amplifies it and translates it to the selected RF channel frequency.
- a combination of filters (not shown), amplifiers 196 , 197 and level control circuits (not shown) is then used to provide the proper output level and suppress undesired signals at the image and harmonic frequencies.
- the transmitter output frequency is the sum of the modem IF frequency and a conversion frequency synthesized in 25 KHz stops from the reference frequency supplied by the modem.
- the subscriber station RFU functions as a half-duplex transceiver with the receivers inactive during the transmit intervals.
- the transmit burst rate is sufficiently high to simulate full-duplex operation to the user.
- the frequency channel assigned is that selected by the base station RPU.
- the transmitter section of the antenna interface includes an up converter and amplifier circuit 220 , a TX synthesizer 221 , a power amplifier 222 , a high power amplifier 223 , in a power detector 224 and a bandpass filter 225 .
- a first receiver section RX 1 of the antenna interface includes a down converter and amplifier 230 , a RX synthesizer 231 , a preamplifier 232 and a bandpass filter 233 .
- Each additional diversity receiver section, RXn includes a down converter and amplifier 234 , a RX synthesizer 235 , a preamplifier 236 , and a bandpass filter 237 .
- the RFU control logic circuit 219 provides the following signals to the transmitter section of the antenna interface circuit in response to the signals received from the transmit section of the modem 19 : (1) a TX ON signal on line 235 to the up converter and amplifier 220 for turning on the transmission section to enable transmission by the transmitter antenna 23 ; (2) an IF input signal on line 240 , also to the up converter and amplifier 220 ; (3) a clock reference signal on line 24 to the TX synthesizer 221 ; and (4) a channel select signal on line 242 , also to the TX synthesizer 221 .
- the TX synthesizer 221 responds to the channel select signal on line 242 by providing a RX frequency select signal on line 243 to the up converter and amplifier 220 that is equal to the difference between the desired transmit frequency and the modem IF frequency.
- a level control signal is provided on line 244 from the power detector 224 to the up converter and amplifier 220 .
- the RFU control logic circuit 219 provides the following signals to each of the receiver sections of the antenna interface circuit in response to the signals received from the respective receive sections of the modems 19 , 19 b , 19 c : (1) an automatic gain control (AGC) signal on lines 245 to the down converter and amplifier circuits 230 , 234 ; (2) a clock reference signal on lines 246 to the RX synthesizers 231 , 225 ; and (3) a channel select signal an lines 247 also to the RX synthesizers 231 , 235 .
- AGC automatic gain control
- the RX synthesizers 231 , 235 respond to the channel select signal on lines 247 by providing a RX frequency select signal on lines 248 to the down converter and amplifier circuits 230 , 234 that is equal to the difference between the desired receive frequency and the modem IF frequency.
- the down converter and amplifier circuit 230 , 231 provide IF output signals on line 249 to the RFU control logic circuit 219 for delivery to the receive sections of the respective modems 19 , 19 b , 19 c.
- the RFU's in the base station and the subscriber stations are similar with the exception of the additional high power amplifier 223 used to increase the transmit power of the base station RF outputs.
- the basic function of the RFU's in either station is to convert the modulated IF (20.2 MHz) signal from the modem transmitter section to the desired RF transmission frequency in the 450 MHz UHF range.
- the receive side of the RF unit performs the opposite action of downconverting the receive 450 MHz UHF signals to an IF signal at 20 MHz.
- the transmit and receive frequencies are offset from each other by 5 MHz.
- the RF units are programmed by the CCU control function to operate on different frequencies used in the overall system.
- each base station RFU will be set to operate on a given frequency assignment upon system initialization and will not change.
- the number of RFU's in the base station corresponds to the number of transmit and receive frequency channel pairs supported in the base station.
- the subscriber station RFUs will typically chance frequency of operation with each new phone connection.
- the RFUs include variable AGC and transmit power level adjustments.
- the AGC gain coefficient is provided by the modem based on a computation in the receive section processor 141 in the modem.
- the subscriber station transmit power level is computed by the CCU based on messages received from the base station on the RCC channel and other control parameters.
- the switching time for the diversity switches shall be less than 50 microseconds.
- the base station RFUs and antenna interface circuits operate on a full duplex basis. All transmitters and receivers normally operate at 100 percent duty cycle. In addition, it is economically attractive for the base station to operate at higher transmit power and to use lower noise figure receivers with diversity.
- the transmitter is intended for operation at the highest permitted power level without dynamic control. Receive diversity is provided by multiple receive antennas and multiple modems.
- the base station ordinarily does not change operating frequency or transmit power level during normal operation.
- the transmitter and receiver sections are fully tunable to each of the 26 channels.
- the base station receive section of the antenna interface is similar to that discussed for the subscriber station except that the front end is preceded by cavity preselector bandpass filters 233 , 237 , which help to eliminate the desensitization caused by co-located or nearby transmitters.
- Low noise preamplifiers are also used to reduce the usable threshold signal level. All antennas 23 , 34 a , 34 b , 34 c have 30 dB isolation from any other antenna. Additional isolation is provided in the transmit and receive sections to ensure approximately 80 dB of isolation between transmitted signals and received signals.
- the bandpass filter, preamplifiers and amplifiers are located adjacent to the appropriate transmit or receive antenna.
- Diversity reception is used to reduce the probability of experiencing a channel fade below an accepted threshold.
- the diversity system is capable of adding three branch diversity over the subscriber to base and the base to subscriber paths.
- the diversity hardware at both the base station and the subscriber stations includes a special diversity combiner circuit, three modems and their associated RF units and antennas. Only one modem-RFU-antenna combination has transmit capability.
- the diversity combiner circuit 33 is shown only in the subscriber system diagram of FIG. 2 , it is present and connected to the modems and CCU in the base station in the same manner as in the subscriber station.
- the diversity processor reads from the three modems their data symbols, AGC values, signal+noise, magnitude and phase error (deviation of the detected phase from the ideal 22.5 degree reference vectors).
- the algorithm used to determine the demodulated symbol involves using a majority vote and calculations of signal-to-noise ratios for each modem to identify the modem with the most likely right answer.
- the diversity processor-CCU interface registers are almost identical to the resisters found in the modems, with the exception that the extra registers used to pass information used in the diversity processing function are not needed and therefore only three address bits are needed.
- the I/O capabilities of the TMS320 microprocessor are small, and most of the processing works with one type of I/O register at a time, a special register which will hold the register address needed at the time is used. For example, the AGC value from each modem must be read, the highest value chosen, and the result written to the diversity processor's I/O registers where it can be read by the CCU. The addressing of these registers is most efficiently done if the address of the AGC register is first written to a part where it is placed on the modem address lines. Thereafter, the processor need only address the correct modem or the microprocessor register bank, thereby speeding I/O operations.
- each modem has its own timing unit, and the timing signals used by the three modems in the diversity system are not necessarily in phase. Because the modem clock signals of the three modems are not synchronized to each other, latches are needed to hold the data symbol output from each modem until the diversity processor reads it.
- the diversity processor An important function of the diversity processor is to maintain communications between the CCU and the three modems. This communication must be done quickly enough so as to meet all of the CCU's requirements but not so fast as to overload the diversity processor.
Landscapes
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Signal Processing (AREA)
- Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
- Quality & Reliability (AREA)
- Mobile Radio Communication Systems (AREA)
- Time-Division Multiplex Systems (AREA)
- Telephonic Communication Services (AREA)
- Sub-Exchange Stations And Push- Button Telephones (AREA)
- Use Of Switch Circuits For Exchanges And Methods Of Control Of Multiplex Exchanges (AREA)
- Interface Circuits In Exchanges (AREA)
- Radio Transmission System (AREA)
Abstract
A system and method for wireless communication between a plurality of subscriber units and a base station, the base station communicating information signals from an originating source to a destination subscriber unit over a channel at an assigned one of a plurality of frequencies using repetitive time frames, each said time frame comprising a sequence of time slots. The channel is defined as having the same one or more time slots from the sequence of time slots in one or more of the time frames. The base station includes a central processing unit capable of assigning a duration of time for the information signals being sent to the destination subscriber unit. The duration equals the duration of one or more time slots in the same frame. The central processing unit maintains a memory of which time slots of each time frame have been assigned and provides the time slot assignment, and therefore channel assignment, by consulting said memory. The system includes a multiplexer for multiplexing the information signals onto the assigned channel; and a transmitter for transmitting the information signals to the destination subscriber unit using the assigned channel.
Description
- This application is a continuation of application Ser. No. 10/132,670, filed on Apr. 25, 2002; which is a continuation of application Ser. No. 09/923,171, filed on Aug. 6, 2001, which issued on May 21, 2002 as U.S. Pat. No. 6,393,002; which is a continuation of application Ser. No. 09/433,430, filed on Nov. 4, 1999, which issued on Aug. 28, 2001 as U.S. Pat. No. 6,282,180; which is a continuation of application Ser. No. 08/926,405, filed on Sep. 9, 1997, which issued on Jan. 11, 2000 as U.S. Pat. No. 6,014,374; which is a continuation of application Ser. No. 08/724,930, filed on Oct. 2, 1996, which issued on Mar. 31, 1998 as U.S. Pat. No. 5,734,678; which is a continuation of application Ser. No. 07/831,198, filed on Jan. 31, 1992, which is now abandoned; which is a divisional of application Ser. No. 07/634,770, filed on Dec. 27, 1990, which issued on Jun. 2, 1992 as U.S. Pat. No. 5,119,375; which is a continuation of application Ser. No. 07/349,301, filed on May 8, 1989, which issued on Jun. 4, 1991 as U.S. Pat. No. 5,022,024; which is a continuation of application Ser. No. 07/324,651, filed on Mar. 16, 1989, which issued on Mar. 27, 1990 as U.S. Pat. No. 4,912,705; which is a continuation of application Ser. No. 07/031,045, filed on Mar. 27, 1987, which issued on Mar. 28, 1989 as U.S. Pat. No. 4,817,089; which is a continuation of Application No. 06/713,925, filed on Mar. 20, 1985, which issued on Jun. 23, 1987 as U.S. Pat. No. 4,675,863 which application(s) are incorporated herein by reference.
- A system for the wireless transmission of multiple information signals utilizing digital time division circuits between a base station and a plurality of subscriber stations. The subscriber stations may be fixed or movable. The movable subscriber stations may be relatively fast and relatively slow moving. The number of time division circuits is determined by the transmission quality of the signals. The base station is interconnected with an external information network, which may be analog and/or digital. The information signals are selected from the group consisting of voice, data, facsimile, video, computer and instrumentation signals. The modulation level of the signals and the power applied to the system are adjusted in accordance with signal error detection in the system. The system is provided with spatial diversity by using a plurality of antennas selectively spaced from each other to provide relatively high signal reception despite signal fading. The base station operates over a plurality of RF channel pairs. Each channel pair operation is implemented by the combination of a transmit channel circuit for processing a given plural number of information signals received simultaneously over telephone company trunk lines for simultaneous transmission to different subscriber stations over a given radio frequency (RF) channel, and a receive channel circuit for processing a plurality of signals received simultaneously over a given RF channel from different subscriber stations to provide information signals for transmission over the trunk lines.
- Separate conversion devices are respectively connected to each of the trunk lines for converting the information signals received over the trunk lines into digital signal samples.
- The transmit channel circuit includes a given plural number of separate signal compression devices for simultaneously compressing the digital signal samples respectively derived from separate ones of the conversion devices to provide the given number of separate compressed signals; a channel control unit connected to the compression devices for sequentially combining the compressed signals into a single transmit channel bit stream, with each of the respective compressed signals occupying a repetitive sequential slot position in the transmit channel bit stream associated with a predetermined one of the separate compression devices and a unit for providing a transmit channel signal for transmission over the predetermined RF channel in response to the transmit channel bit stream.
- An exchange couples the respective separate conversion devices to indicated ones of the separate compression devices.
- A remote-connection processor unit is coupled to the trunk lines and responds to an incoming call request signal received over one of the trunk lines by providing a slot assignment signal indicating which one of the separate compression devices the exchange is to connect to the one of the separate conversion devices connected to the one trunk line, and thereby assigns to the one trunk line the slot in the transmit channel bit stream associated with the one of the separate compression devices that is so connected by the exchange. The remote-connection processor maintains a memory of which slots are so assigned and consults such memory upon receipt of an incoming call request and then provides the slot assignment signal that effects the connection to a compression device associated with one of the slots that is not assigned to another trunk line.
- A call processor is connected to the remote-connection processor and responds to the slot assignment signal by causing the exchange to complete the connection indicated by the slot assignment signal.
- The receive channel circuit includes a receiver unit for receiving a receive channel signal and for processing the receive channel signal to provide a receive channel bit stream containing separate compressed signals in different respective repetitive sequential slot positions; a given plural number of separate signal synthesis devices each associated with a different slot position in the receive channel bit stream for reconstructing digital signal samples from separate compressed signals contained in the associated respective slot positions of the receive channel bit stream; and a control unit for segregating the separate compressed signals from the receive channel bit stream and distributing the segregated signals to the separate synthesis devices associated with the respective time slots from which the signals are segregated.
- Separate reconversion devices are respectively connected to each of the trunk lines for reconverting digital signal samples to information signals for transmission over the respective trunk lines. Each of the separate reconversion means is associated with one of the separate conversion means and is connected to a common one of the trunk lines with the associated separate conversion means.
- The exchange couples the respective separate reconversion devices to indicated ones of the separate synthesis devices.
- The remote-connection processor responds to the incoming call request signal received over the one trunk line by providing a slot assignment signal for indicating which one of the separate synthesis devices the exchange is to connect to the one of the separate reconversion devices connected to the one trunk line and thereby assigns to the one trunk line the slot in the receive channel bit stream associated with the one of the separate synthesis devices that is so connected by the exchange means. The remote-connection processor maintains a memory of which slots in the receive channel bit stream are so assigned and consults such memory upon receipt of the incoming call request and then provides to the call processor the slot assignment signal for effecting the connection to a synthesis device associated with one of the slots that is not assigned to another trunk line.
- The system of the present invention makes use of advanced digital and large-scale-integration electronics techniques to bring low-cost, reliable, high-quality communications to various market segments. One preferred embodiment uses a fixed base station installation centrally located to communicate with a large number of subscriber stations placed in the nearby geographic area. The central base station may be connected to a central office of a public switched telephone company (Telco) network through a private branch exchange switch (PBX) connected to incoming telephone trunks. The subscriber stations in the system may be either fixed-base portable or mobile in nature, and may be operational in either relatively slow or fast motion. The subscriber stations communicate with the base station via UHF radio channels and with the user via standard two-wire DTMF touchtone telephone equipment or via RS-232C or via non-standard phone stations (e.g., 4-wire). The system may be used to replace existing hard-wired local subscriber loops or to provide quality telephone service to areas where wired connections are not feasible or economical.
- One feature of the system of the present invention is the ability to use time division multiple access (TDMA) and digital speech encoding to allow simultaneous multiple use of frequencies within a given network. Any feasible number of high-quality voice circuits may be operating on a given frequency channel (with 25 KHz channel spacing) at a time. Four such circuits are used for illustrative purposes. This provides both a spectral and an economic advantage over existing analog radio-phone systems which can provide for only one conversation at a time on a given frequency channel.
- Features which bring about the lower-cost fixed, mobile and portable service are the use of low-rate digital voice coding (less than 16 Kbps) combined with spectral-efficient digital modulation techniques. For example, the combined use of a 14.6 Kbps voice coding technique and 16-level DPSK modulation allows four simultaneous full-duplex conversations to be supported on a single pair of 20 KHz Bw channels that are spaced 25 KHz apart in the entire spectrum, and particularly in the 400-500 MHz and 800-950 MHz segments. This combination provides good quality speech over a distance of at least 20 Km.
- To be competitive with wireline service, a much larger population of subscribers must be accommodated than can be supported simultaneously on a given pair of 25 KHz channels. For example, a 12-channel-pair system which supported 47 simultaneous calls might have a total off-hook plus on-hook population of 500 subscribers (with the maximum constrained by the desired peak-hour blocking probability). Thus, a subscriber call-request control scheme which provides reasonable call-connection delays is also an important feature of the present invention.
- Additional features of the present invention are described in relation to the description of the preferred embodiments.
-
FIG. 1 is block diagram generally showing the RF subscriber telephone system of the present invention. -
FIG. 2 is a block diagram of a representative preferred embodiment of the base station in the system ofFIG. 1 ; -
FIG. 3 is a block diagram of a preferred embodiment of a subscriber station in the system ofFIG. 1 . -
FIG. 4 illustrates the sequence of messages generated by the subscriber stations and the base station to establish a connection between two subscriber stations. -
FIG. 5 illustrates various data processing modules implemented in the remote-control processor unit (RPU) in the base station ofFIG. 2 . -
FIG. 6 illustrates the processing of incoming and outgoing BCC messages by the RPU in the base station ofFIG. 2 . -
FIG. 7 illustrates the processing of incoming and outgoing PBX messages by the RPU in the base station ofFIG. 2 . -
FIG. 8 illustrates the processing of logger messages by the RPU in the base station ofFIG. 2 . -
FIG. 9 illustrates a memory map of the RPU in the base station ofFIG. 2 . -
FIG. 10 illustrates the processing of messages relating to the RCC state by the message processing module (MPM) shown inFIG. 5 . -
FIG. 11 illustrates the processing of messages relating to the channel state by the message processing MPM shown inFIG. 5 . -
FIG. 12 is a block diagram of the subscriber terminal interface unit (STU) in the subscriber station ofFIG. 3 . -
FIG. 13 shows the signal interface between the PBX and the VCU in the base station ofFIG. 2 . -
FIG. 14 (on sheet 1) shows the signal interface between the STU and the VCU in the subscriber station ofFIG. 2 . -
FIG. 15 shows the timing relationships for the PBX-VCU interface signals shown inFIG. 13 and for the STU-VCU interface signals shown inFIG. 14 . -
FIG. 16 (on sheet 11) shows the signal interface between the VCU and the CCU in both the base station ofFIG. 2 and the subscriber station ofFIG. 3 . -
FIG. 17 shows the timing relationship for the transmit channel signals of the VCU-CCU signal interface shown inFIG. 16 . -
FIG. 18 shows the timing relationship for the receive channel signals of the VCU-CCU signal interface shown inFIG. 16 . -
FIGS. 19A and 19B respectively show the timing relationships for the transmit and receive speech blocks that are transferred between the VCU and CCU for 16-level PSK modulation. -
FIG. 20A shows the input and output data timing and content for the receive channel between the VCU and the PBX (or STU) for 16-level PSK modulation. -
FIG. 20B shows the input and output data timing and content for the transmit channel between the VCU and the PBX (or STU) for 16-level PSK modulation. -
FIG. 21 (on Sheet 5) is a block diagram of the CCU of both the base station ofFIG. 2 and the subscriber station ofFIG. 3 . -
FIG. 22 shows the software-implemented functional architecture of the CCU ofFIG. 21 . -
FIG. 23 is a timing diagram for transferring RCC and 16-level PSK voice data on the transmit bus of the CCU ofFIG. 22 . -
FIG. 24 is a timing diagram for transferring RCC and 16-level PSK voice data on the receive bus of the CCU ofFIG. 23 . -
FIG. 25 (on sheet 3) is a block diagram of the modem of the base station ofFIG. 2 and the subscriber station ofFIG. 3 . -
FIG. 26 shows the signal interface between the CCU, the modem and the STIMU in the base station ofFIG. 2 . -
FIG. 27 shows the signal interface between the modem and the RFU in the base station ofFIG. 2 and in the subscriber station ofFIG. 3 . -
FIG. 28 is a block diagram of the antenna interface circuit for the subscriber station ofFIG. 3 . -
FIG. 29 is a block diagram of the antenna interface circuit for the base station ofFIG. 2 . - Glossary of Acronyms Used in the Specification
ACRONYM DEFINITION A/D Analog-to-Digital Converter ADPCM Adaptive Differential Pulse Code Modulation AGC Automatic Gain Control AM Amplitude Mcduiation BCC Baseband Control Channel BPSX Binary Phase Shift Keying Modulation BW Bandwidth CCU Channel Control Unit CODEC Combined Coder and Decoder DEMOD Demodulator (Receive Portion of Modem) D/A Digital-to-Analog Converter dB Decibels DID Direct Inward Dial DMA Direct Memory Access DPSK Differential Phase Shift Keying Modulation DTMF Dual Tone Multi-Frequency signalling scheme ECL Emitter-coupled Logic FCC United States Federal Communications Commission FIFO First-in First-out Memory FIR Finite-Duration Impulse-Response filter Hz Hertz (cycles per second) I In-phase IF Intermediate Frequency Kbps Kilobits per second KHz KiloHertz Km Kilometer LSB Least Significant Bit MDPSK Multi-phase Differential Phase Shift Keying modulation MHz MegaHertz MODFM Combined Modulator and Demodulator MPM Message Processing Module ms milliseconds OCXO Oven Controlled Crystal Oscillator PBX Private Branch Exchange or Automatic Switch PCM Pulsed Coded Modulation PSN Public Switched Network PSTN Public Switched Telephone Network or other interconnecting carrier (typically Telco) Q Quadrature QPSK Quadrature Phase Shift Keying Modulation RBTG Ringback Tone Generator RAM Random Access Memory RCC Radio Control Channel RELP Residual Excited Linear Prediction RF Radio Frequency RFU Radio Frequency Unit RPU Remote-Connection Processor Unit ROM Read-only Memory RX Receive SBC Subband Coding SHF Super High Frequency (3,000-30,000 MHz) SIN Subscriber Identification Number SLIC Subscriber Loop Interface Circuit STIMU System Timing Unit STU Subscriber Station Telephone Interface Unit SUBTU Subscriber Timing Unit TDM Time Division Multiplexing TDMA Time Division Multiple Access Telco Telephone Company TX Transmit UHP Ultra-High Frequency UTX-250 Switch that includes processing and interfacing and which may be but is not necessarily a PBX UW Unique Word VCU Voice Codec Unit VCXO Voltage Controller Crystal Oscillator VHF Very High Frequencies (30-350 MHz) - In this description, it is to be noted that where a particular band (e.g., 454 to 460 MHz) is used in the described embodiment, the invention is equally applicable to at least the entire VHF, UHF and SHF bands.
- Referring to
FIG. 1 , the system of the present invention provides local-loop telephone service using UHF radio between subscriber stations (S) 10 and abase station 11. Thebase station 11 provides call connections directly between the radio-basedsubscriber stations 10 and is connected to a telephone company (Telco)central office 12 for calls to or from points outside the system. - For example, the illustrated system operates on common carrier frequency channel pairs within the 454 MHz to 460 MHz band. This particular set of frequencies contains 26 specified channels. The channels are spaced 25 KHz apart with an authorized bandwidth of 20 KHz. Spacing between transmit and receive channels is 5 MHz with the center frequency of the lower of the two frequencies being assigned to the base station transmissions. As indicated previously, the system may also operate on other UHF channel pairs.
- The mode of transmission from the base station to the subscriber station (the transmit channel) is time division multiplexed (TDM). The transmission from the subscriber station to base station (the receive channel) is time division multiple access (TDMA).
- All systems are designed to be compatible with 47
CFR FCC Parts - Communication between the
base station 11 and thesubscriber stations 10 is accomplished digitally by filtered multiphase differential phase shift keying (MDPSK) modulation on 25 KHz spaced full duplex channels in the 454 to 460 MHz band, thereby satisfying the requirements of 20 KHz bandwidth such as designated inFCC rule Parts - The symbol rate on each 25 KHz FCC channel is 16 kilosymbols/second in each direction. Voice transmission is accomplished using 16 level PSK modulation and voice digitization with a coding rate of 14.6 Kbps. Alternatively, the modulation may be two-level (BPSK) or four-level (QPSK). A mixture of different modulations levels may be used on the same channel simultaneously. With time division multiplexing, the system provides one conversation for each multiple-of-two phases at the 14.6 Kbps rate (4 phases provides two conversations, 16 phases provides four conversations, etc.) or more as appropriate for lower rates. This is, of course, only one example since, as shown by the following chart, many different combinations of modem bits/symbols or phases and Codec rates may be used:
CHART I 2-way Conversations or Duplex Circuits Using Codec Rates of: Phases 14.4 6.4 2.4 Modulation Kbps Kbps Kbps 4 2 4 8 8 3 6 12 16 4 8 16 32 5 10 20 64 6 12 24 128 7 14 28 - The base station is capable of transmitting and receiving on any or all of the
available FCC 25 KHz spaced frequency channels in the 454 to 460 MHz band wherein the channels are selectable. Channel frequency selection for each voice channel is accomplished automatically by the base station, one at a time, but may be overridden at an operator console interface provided at the base station. - The base station may have a transmitter power output of, typically, 100 watts for each frequency channel.
- The base station provides modulation control, and time slot and frequency channel assignments to the subscriber stations. In addition, adaptive power control over the subscriber stations is exercised by the base station to minimize sequential time slot differences and adjacent channel interference.
- Switching among Telco (telephone company) trunk lines and the TDM slots on the selected channel is accomplished by the base station using preferably a digital switch, although it is possible to substitute an analog switch.
- The base station provides triple spatial diversity capability on the receive channels.
- The subscriber station is capable of operating with three branch diversity. The transmitter power is typically adjustable between 0.1 and 25 watts, but it can be adjusted over other ranges of power. While voice communications through the subscriber station are perceived as being real time full-duplex, the RF system operates at half-duplex by utilizing appropriate time division multiplex timing methods.
- The subscriber station interfaces with any telephone instrument for voice communications, or the telephone may be built into the system. In addition, a data connection such as an RS-232C standard 25-pin connection is provided for 9600 band rate data transmission between subscribers. The base station and the subscriber station may obtain operating power from any feasible source, either internal or external.
-
FIG. 2 is a block diagram of an embodiment of the base station that supports the simultaneous operation of two pairs of transmit and receive frequency channels. Each channel can process up to four phone connections simultaneously. In the preferred embodiment, there are many transmit and receive channel pairs. There are several time slots in each channel. - One of the several available time slots is required for a radio control channel (RCC).
- Connections between the PSTN and the subscriber stations are established and maintained in the private branch exchange (PBX) 15 which is resident in the base station. The
PBX 15 is a model UTX-250 system, an off-the-shelf product developed by the United Technologies Building Systems Group. Many of the existing features of the generic PBX system are utilized in the control of Telco interfaces required in the system of the present invention. ThePBX 15 also converts voice information to/from the PSTN to 64 Kbps .mu.-law companded pulse coded modulation (PCM) digital samples. From this point on, the voice information is processed in a digital format throughout the base station and the subscriber stations, right up to the interface circuitry connecting to the subscriber telephone, or as far as the subscriber transmitter and receiver permits. - Digital voice information from the
PBX 15 is next processed by a voice compression system known as acodec 16, which reduces the voice information rate from 64 Kbps to approximately 14.6 Kbps or less. Thecodec 16 uses either a Residual Excited Linear Predictive (RELP) algorithm or an SBC encoder-decoder to perform this voice rate compression. Typically, fourcodecs 16 reside in a single voice codec unit (VCU) 17 for performing voice compression for the four or more time slots in each frequency channel. Eachbase station VCU 17 can process four or more full-duplex voice connections for both the transmit channel and the receive channel of each channel pair. Connections by thePBX 15 determine which voice call is processed by whichVCU 17 and by whichcodec 16 in the selectedVCU 17. The circuits of eachVCU 17 are hardware-mapped such that a voice call an a specific frequency and slot assignment in the base station is always processed by thesame VCU codec 16. - Each
VCU 17 is connected to a channel control unit (CCU) 18. TheCCU 18 controls the TDMA function and also functions as a link-level protocol processor. EachCCU 18 takes the transmit channel outputs of thecodecs 16 in thecorresponding VCU 17 and transmits the data in the proper time slot and in the proper format to amodem unit 19. EachCCU 18 determines the modulation levels, as directed by a remote-controlprocessor unit RPU 20, to be used for the broadcast (such as 2, 4 or 16 level PSK modulation). EachCCU 18 also processes control information for communication to the subscriber stations through the radio control channel (RCC) time slot and during overhead control bits in the voice channels. Each channel pair contains a series-connected combination of aVCU 17, aCCU 18 and amodem 19. - Properly formatted transmit data from each
CCU 18 is transferred at a 16K symbol/second rate to the modem corresponding 19. Eachmodem 19 takes these synchronous symbols and converts them to a Gray-coded multi-level phase shift keyed (PSK) format. The transmit channel output of themodem 19 is a modulated IF signal. This signal is fed into the RF/IF processing unit (RFU) 21 which then converts the IF signal to the RF UHF signal in the 450 MHz range. Control signals for themodem 19 and theRFU 21 are provided by the correspondingCCU 18, working under the overall control of theRPU 20. The UHF signal is amplified by power amplifiers in theRFU 21 and transferred through anantenna interface unit 22 to a transmitantenna 23 for open-air broadcast. - The receive function of the base station is essentially the reverse of the transmit function. Each
RFU 21,modem 19,CCU 18,VCU 17 and thePBX 15 are full-duplex in nature. - The remote-control processor unit (RPU) 20 is the central control processor which conveys connection data and control messages to the CCU. The
RPU 20 includes a general-purpose computer based on a Model 6800 microprocessor which performs the sophisticated system management functions and control mechanisms for call setup, teardown, and maintenance. TheRPU 20 also communicates with acall processor 24 in thePBX 15 to control the interconnections between thecodecs 16 and the Telco trunks accomplished by aswitch matrix 25 of thePBX 15. - Each subscriber station is a relatively small unit which is located at each user site in the system. The subscriber station connects the user's standard telephone set and/or data terminal or integrated acoustical transmitter/receiver to the base station through the UHF radio channel. The subscriber station's function is very similar to that of the base station. However, whereas the base station can operate on one or more frequency channels simultaneously, each offering the capacity to support several voice circuits, the subscriber station normally operates on only one frequency at a time.
-
FIG. 3 is a block diagram of a subscriber station. The functional partitioning is very similar to that of the base station (FIG. 2 ). The user interface function is performed by the subscriber telephone interlace unit (STU) in the subscriber station. The associated function in the base station is performed by the PBX module. The STU in the subscriber station also performs all control functions of the subscriber station just as the RPU functions in the base station. The subscriber stations act as slaves to the master base station in the overall system control architecture. The STU may interface with an external instrument or may transmit and receive acoustically. - Following the data flow through the subscriber station, the user voice or data information is first processed by a subscriber terminal unit (STU) 27. The voice signal inputs from the user telephone are received and digitized in the
VCU 28. The format for the digitized voice signals is identical to the format used by thePBX 15 in the base station. The subscriber station includes aVCU 28,CCU 29,modem 30 a and aRFU 31 a that perform similar functions as the like units described above in the base station architecture description related toFIG. 2 . One difference in the subscriber station operation is that usually it is limited to only one voice channel at a time. The subscriber station essentially operates in the half-duplex mode, transmitting in a portion of the TDMA frame and receiving in a different portion of the TDM frame. With a frame size of 45 msec the half-duplex characteristic of the subscriber station is transparent to the user, who hears continuous voice input from the party at the other end of the call connection. TheSTU 27 andVCU 28, as well as themodem 30 a, may be duplicated to permit more than one subscriber conversation. - The half-duplex operation of the subscriber station offers opportunity to make more efficient use of the available subscriber station hardware. The subscriber station VCU and CCU function in essentially identical manner as in the base station, at least as far as voice data handling is concerned. However, the
modem 30 a is set up to operate in a half-duplex mode so that either the receive or transmit portion of the modem are used, but not at the same time. The primary savings here is that theRFU 31 a need only operate in half-duplex mode. This saves power in that the RF power amplifier is active for no more than half the time. Also, the RF transmitantenna 32 a can be switched to operate as a second receive antenna during the receive portions of the frame using an RF antenna switch function. Furthermore, no duplexer is required. - Each subscriber station also includes a diversity network including three modems and a
diversity combiner circuit 33. Thediversity combiner circuit 33 gathers demodulated receive information from each of the demods of the threemodems CCU 29 to process. The demodulation circuits or demods in the threemodems RX RFUs antennas - In the base station, three
receiver antennas - The base station also includes a spatial diversity network for each transmit and receive channel pair. Although the diversity network is not shown, the base station diagram of
FIG. 2 is the same as that shown in the subscriber station diagram ofFIG. 3 , which shows the connection of the diversity network for a single transmit and receive channel pair. Thus, each transmit and receive channel pair in the base station actually contains three demods and one modem connected to a diversity combiner circuit as shown inFIG. 3 . - Accurate timing synchronization between base station and the subscriber stations is critical in the overall system. The master timing base for the entire system is provided by the base station. All subscriber units in a given system must synchronize to this time base, in terms of frequency, symbol timing and frame timing.
- The base station includes a system timing unit (STIMU) 35 which provides a high accuracy timing reference clock signal at 80.000 MHz. This 80 MHz reference clock signal is divided down to produce a 16 KHz clock signal and a 22.222 Hz (45 msec duration) frame strobe marker signal. All base station transmit timing is generated from these three synchronous master references. The 80 MHz clock signal is used by the
modems 19 and theRFUs 21 for accurate IF and RF frequency bases. The 16 KHz clock signal provides the symbol rate timing for transmissions on all base station frequencies. The 45 msec marker signal is used to denote the first symbol in a new frame. This marker is active for a period of one symbol time (62.5 microseconds, equal to {fraction (1/16000)} Hz). All frequency channels in the base station use the same time reference for transmission. The three timing signals (80 MHz, 16 KHz and start of frame {SOF} marker) are provided to eachmodem 19 in the base station. Themodem 19 distributes the appropriate clock signals to theCCU 18 andRFU 21 in the same series-connected transmit and receive channel pair. The 16 KHz and SOF marker are used by theCCU 18 to time the transmission of voice and control symbols according to the current frame structure on that frequency. - The receive timing in the base station is ideally identical to the base station transmit timing. That is, the SOF marker and symbol clock signals should be exactly lined up between the transmit and receive signals. However, since perfect timing synchronization cannot be expected from the subscriber station transmission, the base station modem's 19 receive timing must match the incoming symbols from the subscriber station. This is required so that the sampling period in the
base station modem 19 receive function provides the best estimate of the symbol being received from the subscriber station. A small elastic buffer in theCCU 18 interfaced with themodem 19 receive function compensates for this slight timing skew. - The subscriber stations in the overall system synchronize their time references to the master time base in the base station. This synchronization is achieved through a multiple step procedure whereby the subscriber station initially acquires the base station time reference through the use of the RCC messages from the base station. This procedure is described below.
- Once the subscriber station has initially acquired the time reference from the base station, a tracking algorithm in the demods of the subscriber station modems 30 a, 30 b, 30 c keeps the subscriber station receive timing accurate. The subscriber station advances its own transmissions back to the base station by a small amount of time to offset the transmission round-trip delay due to the subscriber station ranging. This method results in the transmission from all subscriber stations being received by the base station in proper phase in relation to each other.
- The system timing unit (STIMU) 35 provides the time base for all transmissions in the base station. The
STIMU 35 includes a high-accuracy (3.times.10-9) ovenized crystal oscillator operating at a fixed frequency of 80 MHz. This basic clock frequency is divided by 5000 in theSTIMU 35 to form the 16 KHz symbol clock signal and again by 720 to form a start of frame (SOF) marker signal. These three time references are buffered and provided to each of the base station modems. - The subscriber timing unit (SUBTU) (not shown in
FIG. 3 ) provides a 80 MHz clock signal, a 16 KHz symbol timing signal and a 45 msec duration frame marker signal for the subscriber stations. These signals are identical to those in the base station STIMU, except that the 16 KHz clock signal is used as the receive symbol timing in the subscriber station. The 16 KHz clock signal is used for transmit timing in the base station. Transmit timing in the subscriber station is provided by a delayed version of the subscriber station receive timing. The delay is a variable amount determined by the ranging computation performed between the base station and the subscriber station. - The timing reference signal for the subscriber station is provided by a voltage controlled crystal oscillator (VCXO) operating at a nominal 80 MHz frequency. The actual frequency is adjusted by the subscriber station modem to be frequency locked to the base station timing reference as received at the subscriber RF unit input.
- Protocols
- The following protocols specify the procedures for system control, collision avoidance and call signaling in the system, as well as the transmitted frame structure. In referring to the components of the system, reference is made to the components of the base station described above in relation to
FIG. 2 , unless otherwise indicated. - The system uses 20 KHz BW full duplex channels in the 450 MHz spectral region on 25 KHz centers and accommodates several simultaneous conversations per channel. Each full duplex channel consists of a receive and a transmit frequency separated by 5 MHz. The lower frequency of each channel is assigned to the base station for transmission and is called the forward frequency. The higher frequency of each channel, called the reverse frequency, is assigned to the subscriber stations for transmission. Thus, the base station transmits on the forward frequency and receives on the reverse frequency. The opposite is true for the subscriber stations.
- The capability of the system to provide a spectrally efficient method of transmitting up several voice channels on a single frequency is primarily dependent on the modem operation. The
modem 19 must operate in such a manner as to provide 3.2 bits/Hz efficiency when operating in a 16-phase DPSK mode at a 16K symbol/second rate. - The
modem 19 is strictly a mechanism to convert the 1, 2, 4 or more bit symbols from theCCU 18 to a phase-modulated IF carrier for transmission, and to reverse the process on the receive side. All control for frame timing and mode selection is performed by theCCU 18. An interface between theCCU 18 andmodem 19 may consist of two four-bit unidirectional synchronous (16K symbols/second) data busses (Tx and Rx). In addition, an 8-bit status/control bus provides control information to the modem and reports status from the modem to theCCU 18. Themodem 19 also provides theCCU 18 with themaster 16 KHz symbol clock signal. In the base station this clock signal is received from the master oscillator in thesystem timing unit 35, to which the entire base station (and therefore the entire system) is synchronized. In the subscriber station this clock is derived from the incoming symbols received from the base station. Therefore, all transmissions are referenced to the time base in the base station. A major function of the subscriber modem operation is to synchronize the local subscriber clock signal to the base station time reference by decoding the timing from the received symbols. - The modem transmitter modulator section uses an FIR digital filter to create a digital representation of the waveform which is used to modulate the RF carrier. The resultant digital stream is converted to analog format and mixed to an IF transmit frequency of 20.2 MHz. The signal is then sent on to the RFU for filtering, further conversion to RF and amplification prior to transmission.
- The modem receiver demodulator section takes in the IF receive signal from the
RFU 21 at the receive IF frequency of 20 MHz. This signal is down-converted to baseband, then digitized with an A/D converter function. The resultant digital samples are processed by a microprocessor-based signal processing unit. This function performs filter equalization and synchronization algorithms on the input samples and then demodulates the PSK signal to yield the symbol stream at 16K symbols/second. The signal processing unit also functions in a self-training mode, which is used to teach the processing unit the imperfections of the analog filters used in the receive stream. Once the signal processing unit is trained, the demodulator digital equalization process compensates the input samples for these imperfections in the analog filter components. This technique allows the use of less expensive lower-tolerance analog components and adds to the overall system ability to demodulate weak or noisy signals. - The modem demodulated symbols are output at the symbol rate to the
CCU 18 during the receive function. Themodem 19 provides the timing associated with this symbol stream. Both the base station and the subscriber stations derive receive function timing from the incoming receive signal. - A more detailed description and specification of the modem functions and performance characteristics is set forth below in relation to
FIG. 25 . - The basic TDM/TDMA channel per subscriber offers a total of 16 Kbps in each direction dedicated to each conversation. Of this channel capacity, 1.43 Kbps in each direction are required for control overhead and demodulation preambles. The VCU therefore operates at a fixed data rate of 14.57 Kbps. This is equivalent to 328 bits per codec frame period, defined as being one-half of the modem frame period or 22.5 msec.
- To accommodate multiple conversations per channel, each channel is divided into “slots” via a time division multiplexing (TDM) scheme. These slots specify the system frame format. The length of the system frame consists of a predetermined constant number of symbols. The system frame duration has been optimized considering the voice coding rate and the number of acquisition symbols required by the
modem 19 at the start of each burst. The number of slots within the system frame is dependent on the modulation-level of the channel. For instance, if the modulation-level of the channel is QPSK, then the system frame consists of two slots per frame. By increasing the modulation-level of the channel, the number of bits of information encoded per symbol increases and, therefore, the data rate of the channel increases. At 16-level DPSK the system frame divides into four slots, each handling the voice data rate for one conversation. It is important to note that even at the higher modulation levels, the number of symbol times required for modem synchronization remains constant. - The format of the system frame ensures that the
modem 19 in the subscriber stations never needs to operate in a full-duplex manner (i.e., transmitting and receiving at the same time). Hence, the slots on the reverse and forward frequencies are offset in time by at least one slot time. - The system frame for the system is fixed at 45 msec in duration. The symbol transmission rate is fixed at 16K symbols/second. Each symbol is transmitted for an equal amount of time, equal to {fraction (1/16000)}th of a second (62.5 microseconds). This results in a fixed 720 symbols per frame, numbered 0 to 719 from the start of the system frame. These 720 symbols may consist of 1, 2 or 4 bits of information each, corresponding to modulation rates of 2, 4 or 16 phases.
- The system frame time (45 msec) is further divided in 2 or 4 time division slots, depending on the modulation format for the slots which compose the frame. Each slot can be one of three slot types: (1) radio control channel (RCC), (2) 4-ary voice channel, and (3) 16-ary voice channel. The RCC is always transmitted in a binary (2-phase) modulation mode. The RCC and 16-ary voice channel slots each require 180 symbols to transmit, that is, one-fourth of a system frame period. Singe the 16-ary voice channel transmits 4 bits of information per symbol (that is 2.sup.4=16 phases), the 16-ary voice channel transmits 720 bits of information per frame. This equates to a bit rate of 16 Kbps. Some of these bits are used for modem overhead and control purposes, resulting in a voice bit rate of 14.57 Kbps. The 4-ary voice channel slot requires 360 symbols to transmit, equal to one-half of the system frame period. Each symbol in this slot type consists of one of four differential phases, so that 2 bits are transmitted per symbol (2=4 phases). The resulting bit rate is 16 Kbps, the same as for the 16-ary voice channel. The same number of bits (not symbols) are reserved for modem overhead and control purposes, so that the voice information rate is 14.57 Kbps, as it is in the 16-ary voice channel slot type.
- The system frame on any given frequency channel may be composed of any combination of these three slot types within the following five constraints:
-
- 1. A maximum number (720) of symbols are transmitted each system frame. Combinations of the three slot types may be combined on a given frequency to accomplish this. In the event that not all channel capacity is filled in base station frame transmission (i.e., fewer than 720 symbols are transmitted in a frame) null symbols are inserted to fill the 720-symbol frame capacity. A null symbol is a symbol which has no transmitted energy.
- 2. Only one frequency in a multi-frequency base station includes a RCC slot type. Only one RCC is operable at any given time in the entire system. The frequency on which the RCC operates is set by a system initialization parameter and is changed only when that frequency channel becomes unavailable for any reason. The RCC slot is always assigned to the first 180 symbols of the system frame (denoted as Slot 0).
- 3. A base station frequency may operate in a constant transmission mode. The subscriber station transmits during no more than one-half of the total frame time. The subscriber station, when carrying one conversation, transmits only during 25% of the frame when operating in the RCC or 16-ary voice channel mode. The subscriber station will transmit during 50% of the frame when operating in the 4-ary voice channel mode. A subscriber station can only transmit in one slot during any given frame when carrying one conversation.
- 4. All 4-ary voice channels must begin transmission on
symbol number 0 or 360. That is, either the first half or the second half of a frame may contain a 4-ary voice channel. - 5. Transmissions between the forward and reverse frequencies are assigned so that the reverse message of given slot begins transmission 180 symbols after the transmission of the forward frequency message. This precludes the subscriber station from the requirement to transmit on the reverse frequency while simultaneously receiving on the forward frequency.
- Given these restrictions up to four voice calls can be processed an a single frequency, if all four calls consist of the 16-ary voice channel format when operating within 14.4 Kbps codecs.
- The slots within the system frame are numbered by position in the frame structure. The numbering system need not be contiguous. When one or more of the slots in the frame consist of a 4-ary voice channel slot type, the numbering system will “skip” over the second slot period that is included in the longer 4-ary slot. The slot numbering system for the reverse frequency (i.e., subscriber) transmissions is staggered from the numbering of the base station (forward frequency) transmission. Therefore, a subscriber that receives information on
slot 2 of the forward frequency transmits onslot 2 on the reverse frequency, which is half a frame offset in time. Tables 1 through 5 illustrate possible frame formats and the numbering associated with each slot.TABLE 1 Radio Control Channel Structure: BPSK Forward Channel: System frame = 45 ms .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. ms 0 1 2 3 Slot no. 180 180 No. of symbols BPSK 16-PSK Modulation type FILTER BIT SYNC AM HOLE STARTUP PATTERN RCP Function 8 8 46 112 No. of Symbols Reverse Channel: .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. ms 2 3 0 1 Slot No. 180 180 No. of symbols BPSK 16-PSK Modulation type FILTER START- BIT SYNC Func- UP PATTERN RANGE 1 UW RCP RANGE 2 tion XX 8 49 8 112 3-XX No. of symbols
= 0/1/2/3
-
TABLE 2 4-ary Voice Channel Frame Structure Forward Channel: System frame = 45 ms .rarw.22.5 ms.fwdarw. .rarw.22.5 ms.fwdarw. 0 2 Slot no. 360 360 No. of symbols FILTER BIT SYNC CODE VCF VCF STARTUP PATTERN WORDS 0 1 Function 8 18 6 164 164 No. of symbols Reverse Channel: .rarw.22.5 ms.fwdarw. .rarw.22.5 ms.fwdarw. 0 2 Slot no. 360 260 No. of symbols FILTER BIT SYNC CODE VCF VCF STARTUP AGC WORDS 0 1 Functions 8 18 6 164 164 No. of symbols -
TABLE 3 16-ary Voice Channel Frame Structure Forward Channel: System frame = 45 ms .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. ms 0 1 2 3 Slot no. 180 180 180 180 No. of symbols FILTER BIT SYNC CODE VCF VCF STARTUP PATTERN WORDS 0 1 Function 8 5 3 82 82 No. of symbols Reverse Channel: .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. ms 2 3 0 1 Slot no. 180 180 180 180 No. of symbols FILTER BIT SYNC CODE VCF VCF STARTUP AGC WORDS 0 1 Function 8 5 3 82 82 No. of symbols -
TABLE 4 Mixed Modulation Frame Structure: 2/16-PSK and 4-PSK Forward Channel: System frame = 45 ms .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.22.5.fwdarw. ms 0 1 2 Slot no. 2/16-PSK 16-PSK 4-PSK Modulation type 180 180 360 No. of symbols .rarw.22.5.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. 2 0 1 Slot no. 4- PSK 2/16-PSK 16-PSK Modulation type 360 180 180 No. of symbols - For each slot symbol description refer to
FIG. 21 throughFIG. 63 .TABLE 5 Mixed Modulation: 4-PSK and 16-PSK Forward Channel: .rarw.22.5.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. ms 0 2 3 Slot no. 4-PSK 16-PSK 16-PSK Modulation type 360 180 180 No. of symbols .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.11.25.fwdarw. .rarw.22.5.fwdarw. ms 2 3 0 Slot no. 16-PSK 16-PSK 4-PSK Modulation type 180 180 360 No. of symbols - Referring to Table 3, the structure of the 180 symbol 16-ary voice channel slot type is described. The first 8 symbols of this slot type are referred to as filter startup bits. The filter startup period, which is included at the beginning of every slot type, is a time in which no energy is transmitted, giving the receive section of the
modem 19 time to purge its filters in preparation for the new slot. - Following the filter startup is a bit sync period. During this time, a degenerated 16-ary pattern is transmitted which simulates an alternating BPSK signal. The receive section of the
modem 19 uses this field to establish the phase reference of the transmitter section of themodem 19. - Next, a twelve bit code word is used to determine synchronization between the subscriber and base station and to exchange control and status information. Code words are used to exchange the current state of the connection, link quality and power and timing adjustments. Each control word is encoded into ten bits using a Hamming code, which allows single error correction and double error detection. The
CCU 18 determines the gain and loss of synchronization by tracking the number of consecutive code words received correctly or incorrectly; and theCCU 18 passes synchronization changes to theRPU 20 in the base station. In the subscriber station, theCCU 29 passes synchronization changes to theSTU 27. - The Hamming code adds five parity bits to five bits of information to produce a ten bit code. Each parity bit is calculated by doing a modulo-two addition of all bits in positions within the code word which contain the bit represented by the parity bit. Though the code word is sent with all data bits contiguous, followed by all parity bits, by arranging the parity bits in positions within the word with just one bit on (the position represented by the bit) and placing the data bits in the other positions, the code can be visualized as follows:
bit position 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 info: P1 P1 D1 P3 D2 D3 D4 P4 D5 P5
P = parity bit
D = data bit
P1 = D1 + D2 + D4 + D5
P2 = D1 + D3 + D4
P3 = D2 + D3 + D4
P4 = D5
P5 = overall
- When a code word is received, parity bits are calculated from the received data bits and compared with the received parity bits. If the calculated overall parity bit is different from the received overall bit, then the calculated parity bit is exclusive-or'd with the received bits to indicate the address of the bit in error. If the calculated and received overall bits are the same and the other four bits are not, two errors have been detected. If all parity bits are the same, the data has been received correctly.
- The remainder of the slot contains two voice codec packets containing 328 bits of information each.
- Table 2 shows the symbol structure for the 4-ary voice channel. The structure is very similar to that of the 16-ary voice channel. Differences exist because certain allocations of symbols are dependent on a fixed number of symbols required per slot for overhead purposes, where other bit allocations are made on a fixed number of bits.
- The radio control channel (RCC) serves a dual purpose of providing a basis for the subscriber stations to initially acquire the system timing from the base station and to provide out-of-band signaling between the base station and the subscriber stations.
- The format of the radio control channel slot is the same for the forward and reverse channels except for the following fields. The first eight symbols of a control slot transmitted by the base station (the forward channel) contains an amplitude modulation gap (“AM Hole”) which is a period in which no energy is transmitted. This gap is used by the subscriber stations to uniquely identify the control channel. At the beginning and end of the reverse channel control slot, there are a few symbols extra in order to allow for the fact that the subscriber stations could be off in its timing by a few symbols.
- All slots contain eight symbols of “null” transmission, the filter startup field, which enables the modem to purge its receive filters in order to prepare for the new slot. The next field of the slot is a fixed-bit sync pattern. The pattern transmitted is an alternating BPSK signal. The receive modem uses this field to establish a phase reference and frequency lock to the transmitting modem.
- The
CCU 18 constantly searches for a unique word (UW), which is an eight-symbol sequence, in order to identify an incoming RCC message. Thebase station CCU 18 must exhaustively check for a valid RCC message in every RCC slot. It performs this task by scanning for the unique word in a window of .+−0.3 symbols about the nominal UW location, based upon master system timing. The search algorithm starts with the nominal UW position and shifts one symbol right and left until it (1) finds the UW pattern and (2) verifies a correct RCC checksum. The search terminates as soon as (1) and (2) are satisfied or all possibilities have been exhausted. The shift information, RCC message and power information are sent to theRPU 20 following a successful search. - The
subscriber station CCU 29, when receiving RCC data, can be in one of two modes: frame search or monitor. The frame search mode is used to acquire receive frame timing from the incoming RCC data and is invoked automatically when RCC sync is lost. The monitor mode is entered whenever receive frame synchronization has been acquired. - When in the frame search mode, the
subscriber station CCU 29 must exhaustively check for a valid RCC message immediately after an RCC slot is received at the subscriber station. Like thebase station CCU 18, it 29 performs this task by scanning for the unique word in a window of .+−0.3 symbols about the nominal UW location, based upon timing derived from modem AM hole detection. The search algorithm starts with the nominal UW position and shifts one symbol right and left until it (1) finds the UW pattern and (2) verifies a correct RCC checksum. The search terminates as soon as (1) and (2) are satisfied or all possibilities have been exhausted. The shift information from a successful search is used to adjust the CCU generated receive framing markers. Acquisition terminates when (1) and (2) above are satisfied for three consecutive frames with the UW in its nominal position. TheSTU 27 is informed of framing acquisition when it occurs. RCC messages are not forwarded to theSTU 27 during the frame search mode. - When framing acquisition is accomplished, the
subscriber station CCU 29 enters the monitor mode. Only the nominal UW position is checked to avoid the possibility of false UW acquisitions. If no UW is detected for five consecutive frames then the channel is declared out of sync and frame search mode is entered (this transition should be very unlikely or system performance is unacceptable). TheSTU 27 is informed of this out-of-sync condition. During the monitor mode, RCC messages that have a correct checksum and subscriber ID number (SIN) are passed on to theSTU 27. - The rest of the slot is used to exchange information between the base station and the subscriber stations. The data section consists of twelve bytes. The first eight bits of data contain a link field which passes information regarding the status of the system, collision, detection and reservation information.
- The purpose of the link level protocol is to detect erroneous messages on the radio control channel. The link protocol also resolves contentions on the RCC slot.
- The link field includes “idle transmission”, “system busy”, “collision”, “transmission detected”, and “slot reservation” bits. These bits are set by the
base station CCU 18 and read by thesubscriber station CCU 29. - The idle transmission bit is set by the base station to indicate that an idle message has been transmitted. When a subscriber unit receives a slot with this bit set, it performs the usual synchronization and error checks, but does not pass the message on to the
respective RPU 20 orSTU 27 if the message was received without error. - The system busy bit indicates that all the voice channels are allocated and no new call requests should be attempted (for some fixed time).
- The collision bit resolves contentions involving two or more subscriber stations attempting to transmit in the same control slot.
- The transmission detected bit indicates that the base station has detected a transmission on the reverse control channel.
- The slot reservation bit reserves the next slot on the reverse control channel.
- The remainder of the data section is used for addressing and exchanging information during call set up and teardown procedures. Following the data section is a 16 bit cyclic redundancy check (CRC) over the unique word and data sections of the slot. The CRC is used to detect errors that occur during the transmission of the RCC messages. The CRC algorithm involves the division of a block of data by a predefined bit sequence and the transmission of the remainder of that division as a part of the data block. The polynomial to generate the CRC is the form of:
P(x)=1+x.sup.5+x.sup.12+x.sup.16 (Eq. 1) - If the CRC does verify check on a message received, the message is not passed from the
CCU 18 to theRPU 21 in the base station, or by theCCU 29 to theSTU 27 in the subscriber station. - When a subscriber station first powers up and comes on-line, the subscriber station must acquire system timing and synchronization referenced from the base station. This acquisition is achieved via transmission exchanges on the radio control channel (RCC) and a refinement on the voice channel. The events that lead to system acquisition are as follows:
-
- 1. When power is first applied at the subscriber station, the system initializes and the
subscriber station CCU 29 gives a series of commands to the demods of the subscriber station modems 30 a, 30 b, 30 c which lead to the RCC acquisition. - 2. The demod of each
modem CCU 29 receives the status from the demods ofmodems - 3. The first action of the demods of
modems - 4. After AM hole detection the demods of
modems - 5. The
subscriber station CCU 29 has received a coarse symbol timing adjustment via the AM strobe from the modem. After frequency acquisition and bit sync the CCU examines data received by the modem and searches for the RCC unique word. This unique word gives the absolute symbol count reference for the frame. The CCU then adjusts its symbol counters to align the counters to this reference. The subscriber station is now aligned and locked on the base station transmission system timing (both frequency and symbol timing). - 6. The remaining portion of system timing acquisition determines the range delay between the base and subscriber stations. This delay can range from 0 to 1.2 symbol times (one way) in the system. During a call set up, the subscriber station sends a message to the base station over the RCC.
- 7. The
base station modem 19 is always searching for new subscribers bursting in. These bursts can be delayed from 0 to 3 symbols times from the base station master reference start of frame. During each slot, the demods of the base station modems 30 a, 30 b, 30 c search for a transmission on the reverse RCC slot. All timing and phase information must be derived during the first part of the slot (preamble) else the slot and its information is lost. There are no second chances when receiving inbound control slots. The inbound control slots are received pursuant to Aloha queuing scheme on the RCC, which is described below, follow this itemization of the events that lead to system acquisition. - 8. During each slot the
base station modem 19 performs a fast AGC adjustment and bit timing estimation during the first 60 symbols of the slot. The receive section clock signals are adjusted to compensate for the subscriber station 's ranging delay. The received data is then delivered to thebase station CCU 18. TheCCU 18 detects the location of the unique word in the stream and determines the integer range delay between base station and the subscriber station. Themodem 19 delivers AGC information to theCCU 18 for the determination of the subscriber station TX power adjustments. Themodem 19 also provides link quality and fractional time information to theCCU 18. Link quality is used to determine if a collision has occurred. A bad measurement of link quality indicates that the signal was not of good quality, most probably due to a simultaneous transmission by more than one subscriber on the RCC slot. The fractional time estimate is the value computed by themodem 19 of the fractional range delay between the base and subscriber stations. - 9. This power and range delay information is processed by the
CCU 18 and forwarded to theRPU 20. TheRPU 20 formats this information into the RCC format and conveys this information to the subscriber station via the RCC control slot. Thesubscriber station CCU 18 decodes this information and make the required adjustments to the transmit power and range delay counters in both themodem 19 and theCCU 18. TheCCU 18 updates its own integer TX symbol frame counter and updates the modem's TX clock fractional delay counters. - 10. During the call connection for a subscriber station, the
base station RPU 20 allocates the frequency and slot assignment for the voice call. This information is conveyed over the RCC and thesubscriber station CCU 29 adjusts the RX frequency and commands the modem to begin detection of the voice slot. AGC, timing and frequency information are carried forward from the RCC operation to the voice channel operation. This is possible because all frequencies in the system are synchronized to the same frame timing reference in the base station. - 11. In order to accurately set the subscriber station timing, a refinement procedure is implemented at the beginning of each voice connection. During the refinement phase, the communication over the voice channel is similar to the control channel, the modulation level is BPSK and the messages are in the RCC format, but no “AM” hole is generated at the base station; these new RCC messages are exchanged between the
CCUs modem 19 is placed in the refinement mode at the base station and outbound control mode at the subscriber station. During refinement thesubscriber station CCU 29 generates a message containing, for the most part, a fixed bit pattern along with a variable portion which indicates the acceptance or rejection of the previous message received from the base station. Thebase station modem 19 passes timing and power adjustments to theCCU 18 from each slot received. Power adjustments are sent to the subscriber station continually. Timing adjustments and control information, indicating the continuation or completion of the refinement mode, are sent out after a period of calculations. Thebase station CCU 18 collects the timing adjustments from themodem 19 for 30 frames, calculates a mean and then sends the adjustment to thesubscriber station CCU 29. Then another 30 frame refinement operation is performed by thebase station CCU 18, with the results again being sent to thesubscriber station CCU 29. The refinement phase is terminated by thebase station CCU 18, and the voice connection started, when the variance of the adjustments received from themodem 19 are within an acceptable range, such as 1%, or the refinement periods has taken a maximum amount of time.
- 1. When power is first applied at the subscriber station, the system initializes and the
- During call set up and teardown, the subscriber stations communicate with the base station by sending messages over the reverse RCC slot. The traffic attributes of the subscriber stations trying to access the RCC can be characterized as stochastic in nature. When a subscriber station wishes to transmit a message to the base station, some form of control mechanism must arbitrate which subscriber station is allowed to transmit, singe multiple subscriber stations could be trying to transmit in the same slot. The slotted Aloha scheme is well-suited to the context of a large population of subscribers requiring relatively infrequent random accesses on the RCC channel.
- The slotted Aloha scheme allows subscriber stations to transmit messages in the designated RCC slot completely independent of whether other subscriber stations are also attempting to transmit in the same control slot. The natural consequence of this independence of action is that messages from different subscriber stations may be transmitted at the same time and therefore collide. To deal with collisions, this scheme requires that a positive acknowledgment (ACK) be sent by the base station following the correct receipt of the subscriber station's message. If the ACK is not received within the maximum allotted time require transmission and processing delays in each direction (approximately 1-2 frame times), the subscriber station must retransmit the message. Retransmission may be caused by an error in reception of the ACK at the subscriber station. In general, the subscriber stations cannot determine the cause of the problem. Thus, a random delay is selected by the subscriber stations prior to the retransmission of the message to avoid repeated collisions with other senders that may be involved in a previous collision.
- A complication that arises in an Aloha scheme is the fact that the channel may become unstable if random retransmission delays are not long enough. When this happens, the channel becomes clogged with retransmission and throughput falls to zero. A backoff technique minimizes this problem by increasing each subscriber station's average randomized retransmission delay with successive retransmission.
- The implications of collision retransmission and stability control for access delay are that the delays are typically geometrically distributed. To avoid large variance in delay, it is thus necessary to operate the channel at a utilization considerably less than 36%.
- In particular, a utilization of 20% or less makes it unlikely that more than one retransmission will be necessary due to collisions. Using a random delay of, say, eight frame times for 45 msec frames, the total average delay with one retransmission is then 450 msec (i.e., on average the delay includes: one frame delay the original transmission, plus one frame delay for the acknowledgment, plus the eight frame random delay).
- To ensure that utilization is not greater than 20%, we must consider the average time T between call requests per subscriber, the total number N of subscribers, and the frame time F for values less than 36%, the utilization is given by NF/T. For F=45 msec, N=1000 subscribers, and T=30 minutes, the utilization is 1.5%.
- Thus for the 20% maximum utilization value, a population of 1000 subscribers each making a call on the average every half minute can be supported by a 45 ms frame time with access delays of about 45 ms when one retransmission is required, and an average access time of approximately 70-80 ms. The price paid for the much lower average delay is an increased delay variance, which for the 20% or less utilization should rarely exceed two retransmission times, i.e., one second.
- The Aloha scheme approach appears well-suited to a system having a large population of subscribers requiring relatively infrequent random accesses on the control channel, and should allow the design goal of setup delays of less than one second to be achieved for the expected population parameters. In contrast, polling and fixed-TDMA techniques give unacceptable delays.
- All phases of call processing including call establishment, call disconnection, and slot connection, require information exchange over the control channel and/or the control portion of the voice slot. The following describes the different phases of call processing in regards to both subscriber station processing and base station processing.
- The subscriber station's subscriber identification number (SIN) and the dialed digits are two call control items that must be supplied in a CALL REQUEST message to the base station on every call made by a subscriber station. In the case of subscriber-station-to-subscriber-station calls, the user dials the number into a register in the subscriber station's memory. The user initiates the communication with the base station by pushing the send key or allowing a time-out. Only when the number is completely assembled and stored in the subscriber station is the radio channel used. Thus, the customer can dial at a slow rate without tying up valuable radio control channel (RCC) bandwidth or time.
- The sequence of messages generated by the subscriber stations and the base station to establish a connection between two subscriber stations are shown in
FIG. 4 . The control channel link level protocol is used to check the various error conditions that arise due to channel errors. Further, messages that are received by the base station on the reverse control frequency are automatically acknowledged in the next control slot on the forward control frequency. The following paragraphs provide a brief description of a message exchange for call establishment between two subscriber stations. - When the base station receives a CALL REQUEST message on the control channel from a subscriber station A, it first checks the received SIN for errors. If the SIN is in error, the message is dropped. Without a valid SIN, the base station does not know who sent the message. If the dialed digits are incorrect or incomplete, the base station sends a CLEAR INDICATION message on the forward control channel frequency to the requesting subscriber station A with status information specifying the problem.
- If the origination attempt is correct and allowed (i.e., the destination unit is not busy), the voice channel is allocated for the originating subscriber station A and the base station sends a PAGE in the form of an incoming-call message on the forward control frequency to destination subscriber station B. If the destination subscriber station B does not answer the PAGE with a CALL ACCEPTED message after two attempts or returns a busy condition indication via a CLEAR-REQUEST message, then the base station transmits a CLEAR-INDICATION message to the originating subscriber station A with status information of busy (i.e., destination unit off-hook) or that the destination subscriber station is not answering the page.
- If the destination subscriber station B accepts the incoming call, then a CALL-ACCEPTED message is transmitted back to the base station and the voice channel is allocated. When voice channel synchronization is achieved, the destination subscriber station B generates an audible ring heard at the destination subscriber station B and also generates the RINGBACK tone over the voice channel to the originating subscriber station A.
- When the destination subscriber station B goes off hook, the control portion of the voice slot changes from a sync-ring indication to a sync-offhook indication and CALL PROGRESS messages are provided over the voice channel via the base station between the two subscriber stations. The destination subscriber station B terminates the audible ring and disconnects the RINGBACK tone from the voice channel at this point. The circuit is now complete, and voice/data exchange can begin.
- Placing a call to an external telephone is a performed in the same manner as calling another subscriber station. The subscriber station merely dials the desired digits and presses the send button or waits for time-out. This generates a radio request message to the base station. The base station decides whether to page another subscriber station or to seize an external trunk line. In this case, an external trunk line is seized, and the dialed digits are out-pulsed on the trunk line. While the digits are being out-pulsed, the voice frequency for the originating subscriber station is allocated. When a subscriber station receives the CALL-CONNECT message, it changes frequency and synchronizes itself to the assigned voice channel. Once the voice channel is ready, the subscriber station handset is disconnected from local silence and connected to the external trunk line. From this point on, the destination Telco central office generates all the call progress tones.
- An incoming external call seizes a trunk line into the base station. The originating central office sends in from 2 to 5 digits, identifying the unique digits of the destination subscriber station SIN, to the base station over the direct inward dialing (DID) trunk line. If the dialed subscriber station is not busy, the base station sends a PAGE MESSAGE over the RCC to the appropriate subscriber station. Three possible situations can occur. First, the subscriber station accepts the incoming call and processing proceeds as described below. Second, no response is received. In this case, the base station retries the paging process two times. If the base station exhausts the retry count without an answer from the subscriber unit, then a RINGBACK tone is generated in the originating unit. The third condition is a result of the subscriber station being busy dialing (i.e., off-hook) and returning a CLEAR-REQUEST message on the control channel. In this case, a busy tone is returned to the originating subscriber station.
- In the case of a successful PAGE request, the voice channel is allocated, external ring is generated at the destination subscriber station's handset while an audible RINGBACK tone is generated back to the originating party, from the subscriber station. When the destination subscriber station answers the call (i.e., the base station detects an onhook to offhook transition), the external ring and the channel RINGBACK message are both removed. At this point, the voice channel is ready for a conversation.
- A normal call termination is initiated by the subscriber going on-hook. The base station detects the offhook to onhook transition via the control portion of the voice channel. Upon detecting the transition, the base station deallocates the voice channel. The channel is not allowed to be used again until the base station sees the subscriber station lose synchronization on that channel. If the call being disconnected is to another subscriber station, an onhook indication is sent to the second subscriber station in the control portion of the voice channel. The subscriber stations resynchronize themselves to the RCC's transmissions and send CLEAR-REQUEST messages to the base station.
- Termination of a call also takes place five seconds after the base station loses radio contact with a subscriber station.
- A voice connection can be “lost” due to fading or channel interference at the destination receiver. The following conditions are checked at the subscriber stations and the base station to determine if the connection is experiencing problems: The link quality value returned from the subscriber or base station receiver is below a predetermined threshold for successive receptions; a loss of word synchronization has been detected for several successive transmissions.
- Base station originated messages are broadcast to all active subscriber stations. These messages are transmitted by the base station over the radio control channel. The purpose of the broadcast message is to notify all active subscriber stations of changes in operation of the system (i.e., change in frequency of the RCC, or a command to the modems to go into self-test mode, etc.). These messages are not acknowledged by the subscriber stations.
- Remote-Control Processor Unit (RPU)
- The RPU functions as the control computer within the base station architecture; it interfaces with the
CCUs 18, which communicate with the radio equipment, and thePBX 15, as shown inFIG. 2 . - The
RPU 20 coordinates the necessary actions for radio call processing. TheRPU 20 exchanges messages with the subscriber stations, thePBX 15 and theCCUs 15 in order to make connections and disconnections. Included in the call processing functions is the allocation and deallocation of the radio channels. TheRPU 20 also maintains a database that reflects the current state of the system; the database contains information on the status of the equipment, subscriber stations, connections and the radio channels within the system. - Call establishment begins when the RPU receives a message either from the
PBX call processor 24 for a call received from an external line, or from a subscriber, for a call destined for an external phone or another subscriber. Communication from a subscriber comes in over the radio control channel (RCC) via abase station CCU 18. The RPU allocates a voice channel and exchanges messages with the subscriber station, thePBX 15 and theCCU 18 in order to establish the connection. - A disconnection begins by a message being a received from the
PBX 15 or a subscriber indicating that a phone was hung up or from theCCU 18 indicating that synchronization was lost over the radio channel. The RPU informs theCCU 18 and thePBX 15 of the disconnect and the RCC is deallocated. - The RPU software performs the following functions:
-
- 1. Processes subscriber, CCU and PBX messages which control call setup, call teardown and channel allocation;
- 2. Initializes and maintains a read/write system database;
- 3. Supports a system console which allows system queries and manual system control;
- 4. Handles the BCC interfaces by supporting the baseband control channel (BCC) communications protocol over a 9600 baud asynchronous serial interface;
- 5. Handles the PBX interface by supporting the PBX message protocol; and
- 6. Keeps a transaction log which supplies diagnostic and raw billing data.
- The RPU software supports one serial interface to the
PBX call processor 24. It also supports serial interfaces to each of theCCUs 18 in the base station configuration. - The RPU hardware includes a Motorola Model 68000 based general-purpose computer. This machine is configured with one Mbyte of random access memory (RAM) and 10 Mbytes of non-volatile hard disk storage. I/O consists of a system console and a unit which supports eight asynchronous serial data interfaces.
- As shown in
FIG. 5 , the RPU software package simulates a system that includes ascheduler module 40, a BCC interface module(s) 41 a, 41 b. . . 41 n, aPBX interface module 42, aconsole module 43, alogger module 44, a message processing module (MPM) 45, and adatabase module 46. - All modules, except the
database module 46, are called to run from thescheduler module 40. The modules communicate with each other through a system of mailboxes. Thedatabase module 46 is based upon a collection of subroutines for accessing information in the database. - The
scheduler module 40 provides mainline code for the RPU software. It is responsible for scheduling and activating all other modules. It also is responsible for maintaining event timers and mailboxes which allow intra- and inter-process communication. - The
BCC interface modules 41 a, . . . 41 n support a serial asynchronous interface and a link level protocol. They also monitor the state of communication with theCCUs 18. - The
PBX interface module 42 supports a serial asynchronous interface to thePBX call processor 24. - The
console module 43 provides a system operator interface which allows system status queries and modifications and message exchange between theRPU 20 and the rest of the system. - The
logger module 44 provides raw transaction information for diagnostic and system analysis purposes. - The
message processing module 46 processes all received RCC, BCC and PBX messages. It performs all subscriber call set up and tear down not performed by thePBX 15 and allocates the radio channels. It also includes a background task which monitors the state of theCCUs 18. - The
database module 46 provides a consistent interface to all of the data structures required for call processing. It includes a frequency allocation task which assigns the radio channels. - The RPU database contains structure describing the system configuration including information on all subscribers and the state of all radio channels. These structures are described as follows:
- The RPU database contains a baseband control channel (BCC) data structure for each
CCU 18 in the system. - A subscriber identification table (SIN table) contains a sorted list of all valid subscribers. The list is sorted to facilitate subscriber validation. The SIN table has one entry for every subscriber in the system.
- The RPU software performs a portion of the subscriber unit call processing. This processing is done in the message processing module. Call processing is accomplished by means of message exchanges between the
MPM 45, thePBX module 42 and all of theBCC modules 41. - Initiating a Phone Call from a Subscriber Station
- This section briefly describes the normal call setup procedure for a subscriber initiated phone call. A subscriber (the “originating subscriber”) goes off-hook, dials a valid phone number (the phone number of the “destination”) and presses the send button or waits for a time-out. The originating subscriber station sends a CALL REQUEST message over control channel to the base station. The
RPU BCC modules 41 receives the RADIO REQUEST message and forward it to theMPM 45. TheMPM 45 performs some simple dialed digit validation and sends a RADIO REQUEST message to thePBX module 42 which forwards the message to thePBX control processor 24. ThePBX call processor 24 validates the dialed digits and returns a PLACE CALL message to theRPU 20. TheMPM 45 assigns a voice slot to the originating subscriber station. TheMPM 45 generates a CHANGE CHANNEL command to theCCU 18 that contains the voice slot that the originating subscriber station is assigned to. TheMPM 45 generates a CALL CONNECT command to the originating subscriber station, which command assigns the voice frequency and slot to the originating subscriber station. TheMPM 45 generates an ALLOCATE message to thePBX call processor 24 which tells thePBX call processor 24 to allocate a message channel. At this point, the originating subscriber station is completely set up. It is now awaiting a connection through thePBX switch matrix 25 to the “destination”. The “destination” can be either another subscriber station or a telephone that must be accessed over aTelco trunk line 14, it makes no difference. - Receiving a Call on a Subscriber Station
- This section briefly discusses how an incoming call to a subscriber station is handled. The
PBX call processor 24 determines that a phone call is destined for a subscriber station. ThePBX call processor 24 generates an INCOMING CALL message. This message contains information about the nature of the incoming call, specifically whether the call is coming from anexternal trunk line 14 or from another subscriber station. TheRPU PBX module 42 receives the PBX message from thePBX call processor 24 and forwards it to theMPM 45. If the call is coming from another subscriber station, theMPM 45 sets the subscriber-to-subscriber index of both the “originating” and “destination” subscriber stations and commands the CCUs involved 18 to go into internal mode. TheMPM 45 generates a PAGE message to the subscriber station specified in the INCOMING CALL message. The proper subscriber station responds with a CALL ACCEPT message. TheMPM 45 responds to the CALL ACCEPT message by generating a CHANGE CHANNEL message to theappropriate CCU 18 and a CALL CONNECT message to the appropriate subscriber station. TheMPM 45 then generates an ALLOCATE message to thePBX call processor 24 which causes thePBX switch matrix 25 to make the final connection for the incoming call. - Drop Out Recovery
- This section briefly describes the
RPU 20 response to a channel fade while a conversation is in progress. TheCCU 18 handling the voice channel which fades sees the channel lose synchronization. TheCCU 18 generates a NO-SYNC event message. TheBCC module 41 receives the event message and forwards it to theMPM 45. TheMPM 45 sends an ONHOOK message to thePBX call processor 24 and sets the subscriber to the idle state and the channel to the on-hook state. - Processing an Incoming BCC Message
- A BCC message is passed via a 9600 baud asynchronous interface from the
CCU 18 to theRPU 20. TheBCC module 41 which handles that particular CCU interface reads in the message and checks the link-level information bits to verify the integrity of the incoming message. If theBCC module 41 determines that the message is acceptable, an appropriate acknowledgment is returned to the sendingCCU 18. Otherwise a retry or negative-acknowledgment is returned. TheBCC module 41 now sends the message to theMPM 45. This message is placed in themessage processing mailbox 48 utilizing the mailboxes provided by thescheduler module 40. (SeeFIG. 6 .) - If there is no more input from the
CCU 18, and theBCC mailbox 49 containing output messages to the CCU is empty, theBCC module 41 “blocks”, and control passes to thescheduler module 40. - The
scheduler module 40 activates the next module in the round-robin schedule, and this module runs until it blocks. The scheduler module then activates another, and so on. At some later point, the scheduler module activates theMPM 45. - The
MPM 45 then reads in the BCC message, along with any other messages that have been queued up for it in itsmailbox 48. The BCC message is identified and processed. Such processing may include changes to the database and the generation of new messages.FIG. 6 illustrates the data path of an incoming message. - Generating an Outgoing BCC Message
-
FIG. 6 also illustrates the data path of an outgoing BCC message. An outgoing BCC message is generated by theMPM 45 in response to some particular event. The message is constructed within theMPM 45 and is mailed to theBCC module 41 which handles thedestination CCU 18. After this message, and any other necessary messages are sent, and if there are not more messages in the MPM'smailbox 48, the MPM “blocks”, and control is returned to the scheduler module. - The BCC module reads the message from its
mailbox 49 and adds the appropriate link level bits to the outgoing message. It then transmits the message out the serial data port to theCCU 18. - Processing RCC Messages
- An incoming RCC message is handled exactly like an incoming BCC message since an RCC message is a type of BCC message. Also, an outgoing RCC message is created and transmitted in the same way as an outgoing BCC message.
- Processing an Incoming PBX Message
- A PBX message is received from the
PBX call processor 24. This message is passes via a 9600 baud asynchronous interface to theRPU 20. Referring toFIG. 7 , theRPU PBX module 42 reads in the PBX message and sends it to theMPM mailbox 48. When there are no more incoming characters and thePBX mailbox 50 containing outgoing PBX messages is empty, theRPU PBX module 42 “blocks”, and control is passed back to thescheduler module 40. - The
MPM 45 reads in the PBX message, along with any other messages that have been queued up for it in itsmailbox 48. The PBX message is processed based on the type of the message and the current state of the subscriber specified in the message. Processing may include changes to the database, changes in the subscriber state and the generation of new messages.FIG. 7 illustrates the data path of the incoming PBX message. - Generating an Outgoing PBX Message
- Referring again to
FIG. 7 , an outgoing PBX message is generated by theMPM 45 in response to an event. The message is constructed within theMPM 45 and is mailed to thePBX module 42. After this message, and any other necessary messages are sent, and if there are no more messages in theMPM mailbox 48, theMPM 45 “blocks”, and control is returned to thescheduler module 40. - The
scheduler module 40 continues to activate other modules in the round-robin schedule until theRPU PBX module 42 is activated. - The
RPU PBX module 42 reads the PBX message from itsmailbox 50 and then transmits the message out the serial data port to thePBX call processor 24. - Generating Logger Messages
- At relevant points in each of the modules in the RPU software package, a message containing pertinent information is mailed to the
logger module 44. This information is time stamped and output to a file.FIG. 8 illustrates the logger data paths. - Console Input/Output Module
- The
console module 43 input section provides command prompting and recognition along with command validation. Valid console commands have the capability to query and update the RPU database and send messages to RPU modules. The output resulting from console display commands will be output directly to the console port. - Scheduler Module
- The
scheduler module 40 is considered to be a special system module and is responsible for scheduling all the other RPU modules. The main responsibilities of thescheduler module 40 are to select the next module to be executed and to provide inter- and intra-module communication. - Although all the various RPU modules can be thought of as separate modules, in reality, all the modules are one application process of a Regulus operating system. It is the
scheduler module 40 which performs the round-robin dispatching of the other RPU modules. Thescheduler module 40 manages the stack for each of the pseudo RPU modules by allocating a fixed part of stack space to each of the pseudo modules at startup time. Then just before each module is scheduled to run, the stack pointer is changed by thescheduler module 40 to point to the appropriate stack address for the proper module. A memory map of theRPU 20 is shown inFIG. 9 . - Each RPU module runs until it blocks. When a module blocks, it returns control back to the scheduler which allows another module to be scheduled and run. A module can block in several ways: by call GETEVENT( ) which forces the module to block until an event is pending, or by calling WAIT( ) which blocks for a certain number of seconds, or by calling BLOCK( ) which blocks for one tour of the round-robin scheduling loop.
- Another major function that the
scheduler module 40 performs is inter-module communication between modules. Mailboxes are used as the means form sending or receiving messages to or from other modules. Each module can check for mail in its mailbox by using the MAILREAD( ) call. Likewise, a module can send mail to another module by using the MAILSEND( ) call. The scheduler module maintains a separate mailbox for each of the modules that are in the scheduling loop. When one module sends a message to another module, the message is copied into the destination's mailbox. Later, when it is the destination's turn to run, the scheduler module checks its mailbox to determine whether there is a message in the mailbox. If so, thescheduler module 40 generates an event of type MAIL which forces the module to be unblocked, if blocked by a GETEVENT( ), and thus scheduled to run. - An event list is also maintained by the scheduler module for each module in the scheduling loop. Events can consist of mail or timer events. Mail events are generated whenever the scheduler module determines that messages are pending for the currently running module. A module can put a timer event on the event list by calling PUTEVENT( ) with the number of seconds to wait before an event is to be generated. The
scheduler module 40 checks the module's event list each tour through the round-robin scheduling loop searching for timer expirations. When a timer expiration is detected, the appropriate module is scheduled to run and the event is returned to the module through the GETEVENT( ) call. - The
scheduler module 40 contains routines that are used to initialize RS-232 interfaces between theCCU 18 and theRPU 20 and between thePBX 15 and theRPU 20. These routines, which take exclusive software control over the RS-232 interfaces, turn off the usual processing of control sequences by the Regulus operating system. Other routines are used to flush the I/O buffers and to read and write terminal input and output. Thescheduler module 40 also keeps track of the system times for all the RPU modules. - BCC Interface Module
- Each
BCC module 41 provides an interface between aCCU 18 and the other software modules in theRPU 20. The messages exchanged between theCCU 18 and theRPU 20 consists of variable length binary data which are transmitted over an asynchronous communication link. TheBCC module 41 is responsible for providing message integrity over the communications link which includes error detection, message sequencing and message acknowledgments. - The hardware interface between the
CCU 18 and theRPU 20 consists of a 9600 baud RS-232 asynchronous interface. - Inputs to this
module 41 include messages received from the CCU or from other RPU software modules. Messages are output from this module to either the CCU via the RS-232 interface or to other RPU software modules via the proper mailbox. - The purpose of this
module 41 is to process message traffic between theRPU 20 and theCCU 18. Thismodule 41 continually checks for messages received from theCCU 18 and routes them to the proper RPU software module. Likewise, this module is continually checking for messages from other RPU software modules that are destined for aCCU 18. An alternating bit protocol is utilized to limit outstanding messages (i.e., unacknowledged) to one in each direction. Sequence and acknowledgment bits serve as the necessary flow control to accomplish this function. The protocol is described in greater detail in the following paragraphs. - In the following discussion, one entity that can process messages is labeled “we” or “us”, and the other is labeled “they” or “them”. The protocol can be explained by indicating the actions to be taken when a message is received. There are only four basic actions, which depend on two conditions. These conditions are determined by comparing the sequence and acknowledgment bits of the received message with those expected.
- On an arriving message, the ACK bit is as expected if it is the same as the SEQ bit of our last transmitted message. Similarly, the SEQ bit is as expected if it differs from the SEQ bit of the last received message. In other words, the expected conditions are that an incoming message acknowledges our last message and we also expect each new arrival to be a new message.
- The actions taken upon receiving a message are now summarized under four combinations generated by the above conditions:
-
- 1. ACK as expected; SEQ as expected. Mark our last transmitted message as being acknowledged (enabling us to transmit a new message). Process the newly arrived message (acknowledge it in the next message we send).
- 2. ACK as expected; SEQ not as expected. Mark our last transmitted message as being acknowledged (enabling us to transmit a new message). Discard the newly arrived message (do not acknowledge it).
- 3. ACK not as expected; SEQ as expected. If we have transmitted a message that has not been acked yet, resend it. If we do not have such a message then something has gone wrong at the destination and we should Reset as described below. Process the newly arrived message.
- 4. ACK not as expected; SEQ not as expected. Our last message has not been received at the destination. Retransmit it. Discard the newly arrived message.
- The Reset bit is used to reset the SEQ and ACK bits. When we receive a message with the Reset bit on, it should be accepted as a new message regardless of its SEQ bit, and it should be acknowledged. Furthermore, the ACK bit on the received message reflects the SEQ bit of the last message that they received from us. We should toggle this bit before sending the next message. As an example, if we receive a message whose ACK/SEQ digit is “4” (Reset=1, ACK=0, SEQ=0), then the ACK/SEQ digit on the response should be “1” (Reset=0, ACK=0, SEQ=1). Either side may reset when it thinks that the protocol has gotten out of step.
- When we receive a message from them, and have no new message pending or a standard reply is not soon forthcoming, we will acknowledge the message by sending a special ACK message. The ACK bit will acknowledge the received message, but the SEQ bit will not change from the last message we sent. Tis will cause them to process the acknowledgment and to discard the newly arrived message. The content of this message is a null message. However, as this message is discarded anyway, the content of this message should be irrelevant.
- PBX Interface Module
- The
PBX module 42 provides the interface between the UTX-250PBX call processor 24 and the other software modules of theRPU 20. The messages exchanged between the two machines are to consist of an ASCII character oriented message exchange. The ASCII character is defined here to be 7 or 8-bit ASCII. Both thePBX call processor 24 and theRPU 20 must be capable of accepting characters with odd, even or no parity. The text of the messages consist of variable length strings or printable characters. - The hardware interface between the
PBX call processor 24 and theRPU 20 consists of a 9600 baud RS-232 asynchronous interface. - Inputs to the
PBX module 42 include messages received from thePBX call processor 24 or from other RPU software modules. Messages are output from this module to either thePBX call processor 24 or to other RPU software modules via the proper mailbox. - The purpose of the
PBX module 42 is to process message traffic between theRPU 20 and thePBX call processor 24. This module continually checks for messages received from thePBX call processor 24 and routes them to the proper RPU software module. Likewise, this module is continually checking for messages from other RPU software modules that are destined for thePBX call processor 24. - Every character that is received from the
PBX call processor 24 is checked for equality with the greater-than character>which indicates the beginning of a message or a carriage return character which indicates the end of a message. This module is capable of handling full-duplex message traffic. - Console Module
- The
console module 43 is the operator's window into the current state of theRPU 20. The console provides capability to display information regarding the current state of the subscribers and the radio channels, modify connection and channel states and send messages to thePBX 15 and theCCUs 18. The console processes the input stream from the terminal and executes the desired command. - The
console module 43 provides the interface to the base station operator's terminal. Theconsole module 43 processes the input from the terminal and executes the command. Data is retrieved from and written into the database, displays are output to the terminal screen and messages are sent to other modules. The interfaces for this module include: -
- (1) Characters are input from the operator's keyboard.
- (2) Characters are output to the operator's screen.
- (3) Data is retrieved from and written into the database.
- (4) Messages are sent to the PBX, BCC and message processing modules.
- A set of parser routines input characters from the operator's keyboard. A data entry prompt is displayed at the beginning of each command line, the data is buffered, the editing characters processed, the input echoed to the display and the data delimited into tokens. By providing the parser with a set of data structures describing all possible commands and valid tokens within each command, the parser performs recognition on the data entered, responds to question marks and displays guide words for data entry. Each token is checked that it is the type of data expected; keywords are matched with the list of acceptable entries and numbers are converted to integers. Once the command line entry is complete further verification takes place; numbers are checked to be within range and with some commands the state of the system is checked before the command is executed.
- Commands break into three categories: (1) commands that display information from the database, (2) commands that modify the database and (3) commands that send messages. Information can be displayed on subscriber, connection, CCU and channel status. All display commands require information to be retrieved from the database and formatted data output to the operator's display. The modification commands include the ability to force a subscriber's connection on a particular channel and the ability to enable and disable channels. The modification commands are used in testing the frequency allocation algorithm. All modification commands write into the database.
- PBX, BCC and RCC messages can be sent from the
console module 43 to various other modules in the system. A SENDMSG commands prompt the operator for all information needed for the message, the message is formatted and forwarded to the indicated module. PBX messages are sent to theRPU PBX module 42 which sends the message out to thePBX call processor 42. BCC and RCC messages can be sent from theRPU 20 to theCCUs 18 via theBCC modules 41, which add the link level protocol bits to the outgoing messages. Input from theCCUs 18 is stimulated and messages, including both BCC and RCC messages, are forwarded to theMPM 46. - Logger Module
- The
logger module 44 is responsible for logging RPU events or messages. Thelogger module 44 maintains the following three disk files: a transaction log with information similar to billing information, an error log consisting of error messages, and a message log which consists of system warning messages. - The
logger module 44 consists of a set of subroutines which are called from the other RPU modules. Each subroutine is responsible for time stamping the message and writing the message to the proper disk file. Each subroutine has a global flag which determines whether messages are to be logged or not. The global flags are set and reset by using console commands. - Message Processing Module (MPM)
- The
MPM 45 performs the high-level call processing functions between thePBX 15 and the subscriber stations. It is responsible for call processing functions such as initiating pages, allocating voice channels and controlling call progress tones form both subscriber an external telephones. TheMPM 45 also processes status messages that it receives from theCCUs 18. For example, channel status information consisting of link quality or subscriber hook status is processed by theMPM 45. - The
MPM 45 is organized as a state machine where PBX and BCC messages are tokens to the messages processing state machine. TheMPM 45 processes the tokens by updating the database, outputting the necessary responses and then transitioning to the next state. - The
MPM 45 uses the system mailboxes, which are maintained by thescheduling module 40, to receive and transmit messages to and from the other RPU modules. Also, theMPM 45 utilizes subroutines in the database module to retrieve or update state information in the database. - As previously described, the
MPM 45 is organized as a state machine. Tokens, which force some processing to be performed, consists of messages, or timeouts. TheMPM 45 determines the type of token (i.e., timer, RCC message, PBX message, etc.) and the subscriber station or channel that is affected by the token. TheMPM 45 processes the token by generating the proper message responses and transitioning to the next state. - The
MPM 45 actually consists of two states tables. The RCC state machine, which is shown inFIG. 10 , is used to process messages from thePBX call processor 24 or RCC messages from a subscriber station. The channel state machine, which is shown inFIG. 11 , is used to process messages received from aCCU 18. - Initially, all subscribers are in the RCC idle state and all channels are in the channel idle state which indicates that no connections are set up or in progress.
- The changes of state for a typical external to subscriber call are as follows. An external call message is received from the
PBX call processor 24, which message includes the phone number of the destination subscriber station of the call. A PAGE message is sent out to the subscriber station and the state of the subscriber station is set to PAGE. When a CALL ACCEPT message is received from the subscriber station, the state of the subscriber station is set to ACTIVE. At this point, a channel is assigned, and thePBX call processor 24,CCU 18 and the subscriber station are informed of the channel assignment. The channel is placed into the RING SYNC-WAIT state (FIG. 11 ). When theCCU 18 indicates the synchronization has been acquired, the channel state is set to SYNC RING. Finally, whenCCU 18 indicates that the subscriber has gone offhook, the channel is set to the SYNC OFFHOOK state. The SYNC OFFHOOK state indicates that a voice connection is established. - A subscriber-to-subscriber call begins with a CALL REQUEST message being received from the originating subscriber station. The originating subscriber station is placed into the DIAL state and a RADIO REQUEST message is sent to the
PBX call processor 24. ThePBX call processor 24 then returns a PLACE CALL message for the originating subscriber station and an INCOMING CALL message for the destination subscriber station. In response to the PLACE CALL message, a channel is allocated, thePBX call processor 24, theCCU 18 and originating subscriber station are informed of the assignment. The channel state of the originating subscriber is set to OFFHOOK SYNC WAIT until the channel goes into synchronization. When thebase station CCU 18 detects the transmission from the originating subscriber, it generates a SYNC OFFHOOK channel event message. TheRPU 20 processes the channel event message by changing the state of the channel to the SYNC OFFHOOK state. An incoming call message for the destination subscriber station is processed in the same manner as the external call message as described above. In addition, the channels involved in the connection are set to internal mode once both subscribers are in synchronization. - A disconnection begins when one of the parties involved in a connection goes ONHOOK. When a phone that is external to the system is hung up, an ONHOOK message is received by the
MPM 45 from thePBX call processor 24. When a subscriber goes ONHOOK, theCCU 18 sends a message which indicates that the subscriber station is ONHOOK. In either case, the other party is informed of the disconnect, the channel is placed into the DISCONNECT state and the subscriber station is placed into the TEARDOWN state. When theCCU 18 indicates that synchronization has been lost, the channel and the subscriber station are placed back into the idle states. - Background Tasks
- A background task routine is implemented by the
MPM 45. The background task initially communicates with theCCUs 18 after a cold or warm restart. Also, once the system is operation, the background task monitors theCCUs 18 in order to keep the database current and a RCC assigned. - BCC messages, generated by both the
CCUs 18 and by theBCC modules 41, are received from theBCC modules 41. Messages are sent to theCCUs 18 via theBCC modules 41. - Data is written into and retrieved from the database.
- Initially, all
CCUs 18 are sent BASEBAND QUERY messages in order for theRPU 20 to determine the current state of the system. All information received from baseband event or response messages is stored in the RPU database. When theRPU 20 receives a baseband event message, which indicates that aCCU 18 is ready and not reset (i.e., theCCU 18 has not just powered up), the frequency assigned to theCCU 20 is marked as allocated. TheCCU 18 is then sent CHANNEL QUERY messages in order to update the database to the current state of the system. CCU initialization is complete once eachCCU 18 has either responded to all outstanding query messages or it is determined that theCCU 18 is down. At this time, eachCCU 18 that indicated it was ready and reset (i.e., the CCU had just powered up) is assigned a frequency. If no control channel has been assigned to aCCU 18, then theRPU 20 attempts to assign the control channel. The first choice is to assign the control channel to theCCU 18 on the first frequency, since this is where the subscriber first looks for the RCC. The next choice is anyCCU 18 withslot 0 not in use and the last choice is aCCU 18 with a connection onslot 0. If all theoperational CCUs 18 already have a connection onslot 0, then one of the connections onslot 0 is terminated and the control channel is assigned to that slot. - Once the
RPU 20 has communicated with all theCCUs 18, the state of theCCUs 18 is monitored via status messages received from theCCUs 18 or theBCC modules 41. TheBCC modules 41 are continually monitoring the communication path to eachCCU 18. ACCU 18 is considered out of operation when a baseband event message is received indicating that theCCU 18 is not ready. At this time, theCCU 18 is marked as not ready in the database. Further, all connections are torn down, all channels are returned to the default state and the frequency assigned to theCCU 18 is deallocated. If theCCU 18 contained the control channel, then a new control channel is assigned. - When a baseband event message is received, which indicates that a
CCU 18 is ready and reset, theCCU 18 is assigned a frequency. If no control channel is currently assigned to aCCU 18, then slot 0 of the reset CCU is assigned the control channel. - If a baseband event message is received, which indicates that a
CCU 18 had lost communication with theRPU 20, then CHANNEL QUERY messages (i.e., one for each of the four channels) are sent to theCCU 18 to update the RPU database with the current state of each of the CCU's channels. As a response to each CHANNEL QUERY message is received, the current channel state and connection information is updated in the database. If a channel is in the SYNC WAIT state, then it is assumed that the subscriber is no longer involved in the connection and the connection is torn down. - Initially, the
CCUs 18 are queried from theRPU 20 for their initial states. TheCCUs 18 also send in event messages whenever they power up or change state. The exchange of messages keeps the RPU database up to date with the current state of the system. - Database Module
- The
database module 46 contains the database interface routines necessary for database access. They provide a concise single-thread interface into the database for any module requiring access to the information within. The bulk of the access routines are concerned with the SIN table and the BCC Table. Access to all fields within these tables is provided by the access routines. - The database module is also responsible for database initialization at start-up. All significant fields are initialized to appropriate values by the initialization portion of the database module.
- The database module also provides the following:
-
- (1) Routines to support TTY initialization;
- (2) A binary search routine for subscriber searches in the SIN table;
- (3) Routines and tables to support frequency-to-CCU mapping;
- (4) Control of diagnostic display information; and
- (5) Frequency Allocation.
- The
database module 46 is a collection of routines which allow controlled access to the database by other modules. By channeling all accesses through the database routines, the database is essentially hidden from outside modules. This allows the database to change without requiring modifications to any of the other modules. When the database changes, only the interface routine to the changed portion of the database needs to be changed. - Frequency Allocation Task
- The frequency allocation task performed by the
RPU 20 selects an appropriate frequency and slot for a subscriber station that requires a voice channel. The selection algorithm takes into consideration call type (i.e., internal or external) and modulation level (i.e., 16-ary or 4-ary). Although the frequency allocation task is functionally independent from thedatabase module 46, it is closely tied to the data structures within the database. Because of this fact, this function is described separately from the database module, even though it is technically a routine within thedatabase module 46. - The frequency allocation task is used by the MPM during call setup. It makes extensive use of the data structures within the database module.
- All frequency allocation requests fall within one of two categories. The first is the external-source category and the second is the internal-destination category. The internal-destination category covers the incoming part (i.e., destination) of an internal call. The external-source category covers all other cases which includes external calls whether they are incoming or outgoing or the origination of an internal call.
- Input into the frequency allocation task consists of an index into the SIN table of the subscriber station requesting a channel and the index into the SIN table of the originating subscriber station. The index of the originating subscriber station is only valid when the channel is being set up for an internal-destination call. At all other times, the originating subscriber index is a predefined illegal index defines as DB NULL. These indexes provide access to all the information required to allocate an appropriate channel (i.e., frequency and slot).
- The frequency allocation routine returns a value of TRUE if a frequency-slot combination is successfully allocated. It returns FALSE otherwise. If allocated, the frequency and slot selected are put into the SIN table for the subscriber station requesting the frequency assignment.
- Each frequency is divided into four TDM slots. The RPU database maintains a count of how may slots are available in each position. When an allocation request falls within the external-source category, a slot is selected from the slot position with the greatest vacancy count. Once a slot position is selected, the first frequency with that slot available is selected. Actually, it doesn't matter which slot is selected when a request falls within this category. However, this technique tends to distribute the system load evenly across all slots and, more importantly, it increases the probability of optimal slot assignments for both parties of an internal call. This is true because system timing calculations have shown that the optimal slot assignment for a subscriber-to-subscriber call is to have the base station's transmit slot for each subscriber in the same slot on different frequencies. By assigning the originator of a subscriber-to-subscriber call to the most available slot position, the probability is greater than when the time comes, the destination subscriber station will be able to allocate that same slot position on another frequency. For example, if position No. 2 is the most available position then it is selected. When the destination subscriber station's allocation request is processed, it is more probable that another slot in position No. 2 is available to be selected, thus allowing the optimal slot-to-slot assignment to occur.
- When an allocation request falls within the internal-destination category, the slot to be assigned is chosen from a selection table. A selection table contains lists, ordered from the most to the least desirable slot position assignments for the destination subscriber. This ordering is based on the slot assignment of the originating subscriber. Up to this point, modulation type has not been mentioned. This is because the basic allocation rules do not change for 4-ary and 16-ary slot selections, except for one important exception. That is,
only slot 0 orslot 2 may be allocated for a 4-ary type connection. Because of this exception, and due to the fact that the two subscribers could be set to different modulation types, a total of four unique selection tables are required in order to cover all possible call combinations. They are as follows:TABLE 6 Originating 1st 2nd 3rd 4th slot choice choice choice choice slot 0 0 1 3 2 slot 11 0 2 3 slot 22 1 3 0 slot 33 0 2 1 rating.fwdarw. (1) (2a) (2b) (3)
16-ary (destination) from 16ary (originator) internal call preferred slot selection table
- Note that each column of every table has a rating associated with it. This rating indicates the desirability of a particular slot. The most desirable slot will have a rating of 1, and less desirable slots will have ratings of 2, 3, etc. If two or more columns of a selection table have equal desirability, they will have the same rating number followed by an alphabetical character. For example, if three columns are rated 2 a, 2 b and 2 c respectively, all three of these columns have an equal desirability, and their ordering (a, b, c) is arbitrary.
TABLE 7 Originating 1st 2nd 3rd 4th slot choice choice choice choice slot 0 0 1 2 3 slot 22 3 0 1 rating.fwdarw. (1a) (1b) (2a) (2b)
16-ary (destination) from 4ary (originator) internal call preferred slot selection table
-
TABLE 8 Originating 1st 2nd slot choice choice slot 0 0 2 slot 10 2 slot 22 0 slot 32 0 rating.fwdarw. (1) (2)
4-ary (destination) from 16ary (originator) internal call preferred slot table
-
TABLE 9 Originating 1st 2nd slot choice choice slot 0 0 2 slot 22 0 rating.fwdarw. (1) (2)
4-ary (destination) from 4ary (originator) internal call preferred slot selection table
- The frequency allocation task has two inputs. These inputs provide access to crucial information required for proper frequency and slot selection.
- The first input is the index into the SIN table for the subscriber station requesting a channel. With this index, frequency allocation can determine the default modulation type of the requesting subscriber. It also tells the routine where to put the results of its selection algorithms (i.e., the frequency and slot numbers).
- The second input to the frequency allocation task indicates the category of the frequency-slot request. The value of the second input is either an index into the SIN table, or it is the previously defined illegal value DB NULL. If a valid index is received, the frequency allocation request is identified as the destination side of a subscriber-to-subscriber call and the selection tables should be utilized. If DB NULL is received, the request is considered to fall into the external-source category and the “most available slot position” algorithm is utilized.
- The frequency allocation task returns TRUE if a frequency-slot combination is successfully allocated, otherwise it returns FALSE. It also causes one desirable side effect. If allocation is successful, the baseband index and slot fields of the SIN table are filled in for the requesting subscriber.
- The frequency allocation algorithm can be broken down into two stages. The first stage, called the classification stage, determines the category of the allocation request. The second stage, called the selection stage, finds and allocates a frequency-slot combination using the appropriate algorithm as determined by the allocation request category.
- The classification stage first determines if an automatic frequency selection is to occur. If the requesting subscriber has been put into manual mode, the specified manual-modulation-level, manual-frequency and manual-slot values specify the frequency-slot-modulation to be allocated. If the frequency-slot specified is available, they are assigned to the requesting subscriber. If the frequency-slot specified is not available, the routine exits returning a FALSE value. If the requesting subscriber has been put into automatic mode, further classification is required.
- After determining that an automatic selection is to occur, the frequency allocation algorithm determines the request category. These request categories are as follows: “External-In” applies when a destination subscriber station is called from an external phone; “External-out” applies when an originating subscriber station calls an external phone; “Internal-out” applies when an originating subscriber station calls another subscriber station; “Internal-in” applies when a destination subscriber station is called from another subscriber station. If the request is an external-in, external-out or an internal-out, a slot position is selected by searching for the most available position. Once the position is selected, all frequencies are sequentially searched until a vacant slot (or adjacent slot pair in the case of 4ary request) of the desired position is found. At this point, the routine puts the appropriate values into the SIN table and exits, returning a value of TRUE. If the request falls into the final category (internal-in), further information is required.
- When an internal-in type request is made, two further bits of information are required. The slot assignment and the modulation type (4-ary or 16-ary) of the originating subscriber must be extracted. Once this is accomplished, the appropriate selection table is determined based on the modulation type of the originating subscriber and the destination subscriber. After the has been selected, the slot assignment of the originating subscriber is used to determine the appropriate row of the selection table use. Each sequential element of the selected row contains an equally or less desirable slot assignment. This list is traversed until an available slot is found, beginning with the most desirable position and continuing until all slot positions have been exhausted. For each slot position (or slot pair for 4-ary connections), each frequency is sequentially searched until the actual slot (or slot pair) is found. The derived frequency and slot values are not entered into the appropriate SIN table entries, and the routine exists, returning a value of TRUE.
- A “slot count” array keeps track of the number of available slots for each slot position. These counts are maintained by the database module and are referenced by the frequency allocation task.
- The SIN table contains pertinent information on each of the subscribers recognized by the system. The following accesses are made to the SIN Table.
-
- modulation-level (read): The modulation level of the subscriber requesting a frequency is extracted from this table along with the modulation level of the originating subscriber during internal-call setup.
- slot-number (read): The slot assignment of the originating subscriber in an internal-call setup must be retrieved.
- slot-number (write): The slot assignment of the subscriber requesting a channel is put here.
- baseband-index (write): The frequency assignment of the subscriber requesting a channel is put here.
- The BCC table is used by the frequency allocation routines search for an available frequency-slot combination. The following accesses are made to the BCC table:
-
- channel-state (read): The state of a channel is checked to determine availability.
- channel-status (read): The channel status is checked to verify that the specified channel is a voice channel.
- channel-state (write): The channel state is changed when the specified channel is selected for allocation.
- channel-control (write): The modulation type of the requesting subscriber is written into the channel control byte.
- SIN-index (write): Establishes a link from the selected channel to the requesting subscriber.
- The frequency allocation routines directly access the database. This is necessary due to speed and efficiency considerations. Whenever possible, the database interface routines are used to access the database from the frequency allocation routines.
- Subscriber Telephone Interface Unit (STU)
- In its basic mode of operation the STU acts as an interface unit to convert the 2-wire analog signal interfaced from a standard telephone set to 64 Kbps PCM encoded digital samples. Referring to
FIG. 12 , the STU includes a subscriber line interface circuit (SLIC) 53 which connects directly to a type-500 touch-tone phone set vialines 37. TheSLIC 53 provides proper voltage and impedance characteristics for phone operation. In addition, theSLIC 53 allows a “ring” current to be applied to the phone set and also performs “on-hook/off-hook” detection. The signal outputs of theSLIC 53 on line 54 are analog voice-frequency (VF) transmit and receive signals. These are subsequently converted to PCM samples by aPCM codec 55. ThePCM codec 55 uses the .mu.−255 companding algorithm to digitize the voice signals into 8-bit samples at an 8 KHz rate. ThePCM codec 55 is full-duplex in nature. The digitized voice samples are then fed over line 56 to a “mode select” multiplexer (MUX) 57. The mode of operation the MUX is determined by the subscribercontroller unit SCU 58 which interfaces with theMUX 57 by a transmit and receiveFIFO 59. TheSCU 58 essentially includes a Model 803 microcontroller. The SCU is coupled to theCCU 29. Through an RS-232interface circuit 60 and further controls the operation of theSLIC 53. - The STU can essentially operate in one of three distinct modes. The first, the most basic, mode is the voice mode. In this mode, voice samples from the
PCM codec 55 are transferred through the modeselect MUX 57 and a VCU driver/receiver circuit 61 to theVCU 28, where they are further processed to reduce the bit rate from 64 Kbps to 14.6 Kbps and then sent on for transmission to the base station. - The second mode of operation is the data mode. In this mode the 64 Kbps stream to/from the
VCU 28 does not involve voice information; rather, the information conveyed to the base station is a reformatted data stream from an external data source at a rate of up to the 14.6 Kbps channel data transmission rate. The STU also includes a RS-232data port 62 to allow the connection of a data device (e.g., terminal) via aline 63 using a standard asynchronous RS-232 interface operating up to 9600 baud. The STU includes an UART andtimer circuit 64 to synchronize the data from the RS-232data port 62. TheVCU 28 packetizes the synchronized data so that it will pass through the 14.6 Kbps limitation of the channel. Full-duplex data transmission is supported in this mode. - The third STU mode is the call setup mode. In this mode, no data is conveyed from the
STU 27 to theVCU 28 through the modeselect MUX 57. However, a ringbacktone generator circuit 65 is connected to the modeselect MUX 57. This circuit digitally synthesizes the tones used in call placement procedures, such as busy and error tones. During call placement, DTMF digits dialed by the user are detected by aDTMF detector circuit 66 and processed by theSCU 58 to place the call. The ringbacktone generator circuit 65 returns appropriate tones to the user's head set. Aring generator 67 is connected to theSLIC 53. Atiming generator 68 provides timing signals to thePCM codec 55, the VCUdriver receiver circuit 61 and theringback tone generator 65. Once the call placement is complete, the STU will switch to either the voice mode or the data mode for communications with the base station. - An additional requirement of the STU is to provide for cancellation of undesired echo signals from the remote connections. The delay of the round trip for the voice signals between base station and the subscriber station will be well over 100 msec. Any reflected signal due to impedance mismatch at either end will result in an obnoxious echo return. This problem is handled in the base station by an echo cancellation system in the PBX function. The STU must provide the echo cancellation in the subscriber station. At least 40 dB of echo attenuation is expected to be required from this cancellation. The delay of the echo to be cancelled is very small, however, since the reflection-of-interest is between the
SLIC 53 in the STU and the local phone set itself. The distance will typically be only a few tens of feet and the delay is essentially zero. - The 8031 micropro controller in the
SCU 58 performs the functions of theRPU 20 and PBX callprocessor 24 in the base station. It communicates to thebase station RPU 20 via messages sent on the radio control channel (RCC) and controls all the individual functions of theSTU 27. The SCTU also communicates to thesubscriber station CCU 29 via the baseband control channel (BCC). The RS-232 interface to theCCU 29 operates at 9600 baud and is used to convey control information between theCCU 20 andSTU 27 in the subscriber station. - Voice Codec Unit (VCU)
- The voice codec unit (VCU) implements four full-duplex RELP voice compression systems. The VCU design is identical for the base station and the subscriber stations. In the subscriber station only one-fourth of the overall functionality is used (that is, only one of the four channels). The interface to the
STU 27 in the subscriber station is identical to the interface used by each of the four PBX channels in thebase station VCU 17 interface. TheVCU CCU CCU VCU VCU VCU - The interfaces between the
PBX 15 and theVCU 17 are shown inFIG. 13 . The interfaces between theSTU 27 and theVCU 28 are shown inFIG. 14 . TheSTU 27 interfaces are a subset of thePBX 15 interfaces in that theSTU 27 provides only one full duplex voice channel operation. The timing relationships for the PBX and STU interfaces are identical and are shown inFIG. 15 . Table 10 describes the characteristics represented by the symbols used inFIG. 15 .TABLE 10 Symbol Parameter Min Typ Max Unit tw0 PBX frame width — 125 — .mu.s tw1 clock pulse width 1.8 2.0 2.2 .mu.s tw2 gate 0 inactive width— 93.75 — .mu.s tw3 gate 0 inactive - gate1 width5.9 7.8 9.7 .mu.s tw4 gate 1 inactive -gate 0 width52.8 54.7 56.6 .mu.s td0 start pulse - clock 0delay 0 250 −800 ns td1 start pulse - clock 1delay 0 250 −800 ns td2 clock 0 - gate 0 edge delay100 1000 2000 ns td3 clock 1 - gate 1 edge delay100 1000 2000 ns ts0 input data setup time 20 1500 — ns ts1 output data setup time 500 1800 — ns th0 output data hold time 500 2200 — ns - Referring to
FIG. 13 , the PBX SDAT0, 1, 2 and 3lines 70, 71, 72, 73 carry data signals from thePBX 15 to theVCU 17 in the base station. In the subscriber station the data signal is carried on theSTU SDAT0 line 74 from theSTU 27 to the VCU 28 (FIG. 14 ). 8-bit .mu.−255 companded serial data is sent to the voice codec during the active portion of the PBX/STU GATEO or PBX GATE1 . . . 3 at a clock rate of 256 KHz. Data is clocked into theVCU - The
VCU SDAT0 PBX 15 in the base station. TheVCU SDATO line 29 carries data from theVCU 28 to theSTU 27 in the subscriber station. 8-bit .mu.−255 companded serial data is sent to thePBX 15 orSTU 27 from the voice codec during the active high portion of PBX/STU GATEO or PBX GATE1 . . . 3 at a 256 KHz clock rate. Data is clocked out of theVCU - The PBX GATE0, 1, 2 and 3
lines PBX 15 to theVCU 17 in the base station. TheSTU GATE0 line 84 carries a gate signal from theSTU 27 to theVCU 28 in the subscriber station. The gate signal is an active high signal used to enable transfer of PBX/STU SDAT0, PBX SDAT1 . . . 3 and VCU SDAT0 . . . 3. This gate signal is active for eight consecutive clock periods every 125 microsecond. - The PBX CLKO, 1, 2 and 3
lines PBX 15 to theVCU 17 in the base station. TheSTU CLKO line 89 carries a 256 KHz clock signal from theSTU 27 to theVCU 28 in the subscriber station. A 256 KHz clock signal is used to clock the PBX/STU SDAT0 and PBX SDAT1 . . . 3 signals into theVCU PBX 15 orSTU 27. However, the clocks are not synchronized with any clocks generated within theVCU CCU modem 19, 30. - In the base station, the PBX-VCU interface converts four channels of synchronous 64 Kbps serial data into 8-bit parallel data, which is then made available to the four transmit
voice codecs 16 at an 8 KHz sampling rate. In the subscriber station, only one channel (channel 0) is converted by the STU-VCU interface. The necessary clocks and gates are provided by thePBX 15 and theSTU 27. - The PBX-VCU and STU-VCU interfaces also perform the complementary function for the receive voice codecs. In the base station, 8-bit parallel data, received from the four codec channels, is converted into four 64 Kbps synchronous serial channels for transmission back to the
PBX 15. In the subscriber station, one voice channel is converted and sent back to theSTU 27. - The hardware interfaces between the
VCU CCU FIG. 16 . The timing relationships for the transmit and receive channels between the VCU and the CCU are shown inFIGS. 17 and 18 respectfully. Tables 11 and 12 describe the characteristics represented by the symbols used inFIGS. 17 and 18 respectively. - Note that
FIGS. 17 and 18 detail the events that occur during the VCBTP shown inFIGS. 19A and 19B . The individual interface signal definitions are given in the following paragraphs.TABLE 11 Symbol Characteristic Min Max Unit td1 voice codec block transfer period — 750 .mu.sec td2 TCVC response time 1.25 15 .mu.sec td3 CCU DMA response time 1.25 .mu.sec td4 handshake delay 15 nsec td5 VC block period delay 150 .mu.sec th1 control data hold nsec th2 status data hold nsec th3 TC data hole nsec ts1 control data setup nsec ts2 status data setup nsec ts3 TC data setup nsec tw1 write width nsec tw2 read width nsec tw3 block request width 1.5 .mu.sec -
TABLE 12 Symbol Characteristic Min Max Unit td6 block transfer period 750 .mu.sec td7 CCU data response time 1.25 .mu.sec td8 VC response time 1.25 15 .mu.sec td9 handshake delay 15 nsec td10 VC block period delay 150 .mu.sec th4 control data hold nsec th5 status data hold nsec th6 RC data hold nsec ts4 control data setup nsec ts5 status data setup nsec ts6 TC data setup nsec tw4 write width nsec tw4 read width nsec tw6 block request width 1.5 .mu.sec -
FIGS. 19A and 19B show the timing relationships between the various transmit and receive speech blocks that are transferred between theVCU CCU FIG. 19A is the system frame timing to which all transfers are referenced. This frame timing is also applicable toFIG. 19B . One modem frame is 45 msec in length and includes of four voice slots (or channels). Each voice slot consists of two system voice block periods (SVBP) of speech data each containing 82 symbols (requiring 5.125 msec) and an additional 16 overhead data symbols requiring 1.0 msec of frame time. - For the transmit channels, one block of 328 bits (41 bytes) of processed speech is transferred from the
VCU CCU channel 0 inFIG. 19A , unprocessed VC input data in VCBPs OA1 and OB1 is associated with processed data in VCBTPs OA1 and OB1. Also note that the VCBPs forchannels channels - For the receive channels (as shown in
FIG. 19B ), one block of 328 bits (41 bytes) of processed speech is transferred from theCCU VCU FIG. 19B . To understand the relationship of voice codec's input and output data, refer toFIGS. 19A and 19B . For receivechannel 0, compressed speech data transferred during VCBTPs OA10 and OB10 is associated with the processed expanded data stream in VCBPS OA10 and OB10. - The TCADDR lines 90 carry transmit channel address signals from the
CCU VCU - The TCDATA bus 91 carries transmit channel data signals between the
VCU CCU - The
TCDAV line 92 carries a transmit channel data available signal from theVCU CCU CCUI - The
TCDACK line 93 carries a transmit channel data acknowledgment signal from theCCU VCU - The
TCSCWR line 94 carries a transmit signal status/control write signal from theCCU VCU - The TCSCRD line 95 carries a transmit signal status/control read signal from the
CCU VCU - The BLOCKRQ line 96 carries a block request signal from the
CCU VCU CCU - The TCVCRST line 97 carries a transmit channel voice codec reset signal from the
CCU VCU - The RCADDR lines 98 carry receive channel address signals from the
CCU VCU - The RCDATA bus 98 carries receive channel data signals between the
CCU VCU - The RCDAV line 100 carries a receive channel data available signal from the
CCU VCU - The RCDACK line 101 carries a receive channel data acknowledge signal from the
VCU CCU CCU CCU - The RCSCWR line 102 carries a receive channel status/control write signal from the
CCU VCU - The RCSCRD line 103 carries a channel status/control read signal from the
VCU CCU - The BLOCKRDY line 104 carries a block ready signal from the
CCU VCU CCU CCU - The RCVCRST line 105 carries a receive channel voice codec reset signal from the
CCU VCU - The receive channel VCU hardware receives 41 byte blocks of input data from the
CCU FIG. 20A . After processing the data according to the current mode of operation, the 8-bit .mu.-law companded data is transferred at an 8 KHz rate to the PBX (STU) interface module. Data buffering is performed within theVCU CCU VCU CCU FIG. 18 . The following operating modes are supported by the receive codecs: - In the external mode, speech bandwidth expansion is performed with an input data rate of 14.6 Kbps (328 bits every 22.5 msec), and an output data rate of 64 Kbps. Speech data may also include DTMF tones.
- In the internal mode, previously compressed 14.6 Kbps speech is passed from the
CCU VCU PBX 15 or theSTU 27. Since thePBX 15 or theSTU 27 expects 64 Kbps data, padding of the data stream must occur. Output (64 Kbps) data consists of an idle byte (FF hex) pattern until speech data becomes available from theCCU FIG. 20A provides an example of the input and output data timing and content for 16 PSK modulation. - In the silence mode, input blocks of speech data from the
CCU PBX 15 or theSTU 27 is maintained to ensure line silence. - In the standby mode, continuous hardware diagnostic routines are executed and the resulting status stored in the status register. Block transfers to the
CCU CCU - The transmit channel VCU hardware receives 8-bit .mu.-law companded PCM (at 8 KHz sampling rate) from the PBX/STU interface. Mter processing the data according to the current mode of operation, the output data is transferred to the
CCU FIG. 19A . Data buffering is performed within theVCU CCU VCU CCU FIG. 17 . The following operating modes are supported by the transmit codecs: - In the external mode, speech bandwidth compression is performed with an output data rate of 14.6 Kbps. (328 bits every 22.5 msec.) Processed speech data is transferred in 41 byte blocks to the
CCU - In the internal mode, previously processed speech data is passed from the
PBX 15 or theSTU 27 through theVCU CCU CCU FIG. 20B provides an example of the input and output data timing and content for 16-PSK modulation.Segment 1 on the output channel is a sync byte; and 2 is a processed speech byte. The cross-hatched segment represents an idle byte pattern. Note that the sync and speech data bytes will not occur across VCBP boundaries. - In the silence mode, input speech data from the
PBX 15 or theSTU 27 is consumed but not used. The 41 bytes of output speech data to the CCU contains a silent voice pattern. - In the standby mode, continuous hardware diagnostic routines are executed and the resulting status stored in the status register. Block transfers to the
CCU VCU CCU - A codec frame is defined according to the implementation requirements of the RELP algorithm, but the frame must be an integer sub-multiple of the voice coded block period (VCBP), which is 22.5 msec.
- Due to the fact that the
PBX 15 andSTU 27 operate asynchronously from internal system timing, a means of detecting, reporting and compensating for data overruns and underarms must be incorporated into theVCU - After a reset of any one (or all) codecs, VCBTPA will be the first block transferred from the
CCU FIG. 19A , for example. - Control Channel Unit (CCU)
- The channel controller unit (CCU) performs similar functions in both the subscriber stations and the base station. The hardware used in the two station types for the CCU function is, in fact, identical. The software in the subscriber station differs slightly from that in the base station. The CCU performs many functions pertaining to the information formatting and timing associated with operation on the time-division transmission channels. Basic inputs to the CCU come from four sources. First, there is the actual digitized samples which are to be transmitted. These are transferred to the
CCU VCU FIGS. 2 and 3 .) This data may be encoded voice samples or data samples from the RS-232data port 10 in the STU. (FIG. 12 .) In any case, the digital channels operate at 16 Kbps. Four channels may be processed concurrently by theCCU 18 when operating in the base station with all four 16-level PSK transmission channels operating. Thesubscriber station CCU 29 operates on only one stream, but that stream may be located in any of the four slot positions associated with the TDMA framing scheme. The second input to the CCU comes via the baseband control channel (BCC) from the STU 27 (in the subscriber station) or the RPU 20 (in the base station). This second input provides control messages pertaining to modes of operation, status and control information. Many of the BCC messages from theCCU CCU CCU STU 27 or theRPU 20 and, in response, receives control messages from theRPU 20 or theSTU 27. This determines what theCCU VCU modem modem 19 provides the master clock signal used in the VCU-CCU-modem chain. In addition, themodem CCU CCU instantaneous modem RPU 20 or theSTU 27. The fourth input source is the actual modem data received as symbols of up to four bits each (depending on the modulation levels). These symbols are buffered, demultiplexed and output to theVCU -
FIG. 21 is a block diagram of the CCU. The architecture of the CCU is essentially that of two one-way direct memory access (DMA) data channels with an intelligent microprocessor controller. The function of the DMA channels is to transfer data from the VCU to the modem and vice versa. The CCU interface to the VCU includes two parallel DMA buses, aTX bus 107 for the transmit channel (VCU to CCU to modem) and aRX bus 108 for the receive channel (modem to CCU to VCU). Data processed by the transmit circuits in the VCU is buffered in the VCU memory until the CCU requests a DMA transfer. Forty-one bytes are transferred to the CCU during each block transfer period. Two of these blocks are transmitted per active voice channel (up to four voice channels in the base station) per TDMA frame. The CCU receives these transmit bytes via a transmit voice codec interface module (TVCIM) 109 and buffers them in a transmit memory module (TMM) 110. Depending on the specific mode of operation for the given channel, a CCU processor embodied in a microcontroller module (MCM) 111 appends a control/sync header to the coded voice bytes, thereby formatting a complete voice packet for transmission to the modem via a transmitmodem interface module 112. TheMCM 111 maintains frame timing information and transfers the data to the modem at the proper time. Before being transferred to the modem the transmit data is converted by theMCM 111 from the eight-bit byte format used by the CCU to a symbol format containing 1, 2 or 4 bits per symbol, depending on the modulation levels for that slot. - The reverse process is performed for the receive data from the modem. Data from the modem is received by a receive modem interface module (RMIM) 114 and buffered in a receive memory module (RMM) 115. This data is then converted from the 1, 2 or 4-bit-per-symbol format used by the modem to the eight-bit byte format used internally by the CCU and all other baseband processing. The overhead and control bits are stripped from the incoming data stream on the
RX bus 108 by theMCM 111 according to its knowledge of the frame timing, which is provided by the modem to a frame timing module (FTM) 116 and its own identification of various code words in the symbol stream. The converted data is provided to the VCU via a receive voice codec interface module (RVCIM) 117. - The CCU also provides the link-level control of the radio control channel (RCC) transmissions at both the base and subscriber stations. In the base station only one CCU is configured, by the RPU, as processing the RCC channel. The CCU controls the reception and formatting of messages from the RPU in the base station to the STU controller in the subscriber stations. This control function of the CCU involves detection and error control in the RCC messages as well as the formatting and packetizing of the RCC information for transmission across the radio link. The CCU also detects collisions on the incoming RCC at the base station. The CCU controls the power and ranging computations for subscriber stations performing initial acquisition efforts. The protocol for acquisition and other RCC functions have been described above.
-
FIG. 22 shows the software-implemented functional architecture of the CCU. The CCU has three separate data paths: the transmitbus TX 107, the receivebus RX 108 and the microcontrollerlocal bus 119. Themicrocontroller 111 shares theTX bus 107 with a memory access (DMA)controller 120 and shows theRX bus 108 with adirector DMA controller 121. Themicrocontroller 111 uses these remote buses to control the DMA controller peripherals, the control/status registers 122 and to access both the transmitbuffer memory 110 and the receivebuffer memory 115. The control and status registers 122 off of the microcontrollerlocal bus 119 provide interfaces to the RFU, the modem and the CCU hardware. An RS-232C link 123 between the RPU and the CCU is supported by a UART on themicrocontroller chip 111. In the subscriber station, the RPU is replaces by the STU, but the interface remains the same. - The
microcontroller 111 has access to three physically separate RAM areas: local RAM, the transmit buffer and the receive buffer. Local RAM can further be broken down into on-chip RAM and off-chip RAM. The transmit buffer and the receive buffer can only be accessed by the microcontroller when the respective DMA controller is idle. - The transmit
buffer 110 is divided into a number of distinct segments. Each segment contains the skeleton of a voice or RCC packet, ready for transmission over the channel. The preamble and unique word (RCC only) are constants initialized by themicrocontroller 111 after a CCU reset. The code word (voice only), voice data and RCC data are written into the transmitbuffer 110 by the microcontrollerjust prior to the DMA transfer to themodem transit buffer 110. - The receive
buffer 115 is divided into a number of distinct segments. One segment is for the storage of voice data, which is buffered and transferred on a VCU block basis. RCC data is buffered separately from voice data to allow its retention over a longer period of time. If necessary, themicrocontroller 111 can maintain a two frame RCC history in thereceiver buffer 115, making the RCC copy task (from buffer to local RAM) less of a time critical event. - The local RAM contains the working variables used by the
microcontroller 111. One important data structure stored there supports the baseband control channel (BCC) between the CCU and the RPU. One register bank of the local RAM is assigned to provide basic queue information to the RS232C interrupt handler. A pointer and length field in this bank defines the active transmit data block (TXDB), from which data is read and transmitted. The TXDB contains length and pointer information to the next TXDB in the queue; hence forming a linked list. On the receive side, a circular buffer is used to store incoming data bytes. When a complete message is received, the interrupt handler flags the serial code to interpret it. - The
microcontroller 111 uses itslocal bus 119 to access the modem, RFU and CCU control/status registers 122. The bus also provides access, through isolation logic circuits 124 and 125 to theTX bus 107 and theRX bus 108 respectively. To avoid contention, theremote buses microcontroller 111 when therespective DMA controller - The CCU and RPU communicate via
link 123 through a full duplex RS-232C interface, called the baseband control channel (BCC). Asynchronous characters are eight-bit binary and are transmitted at 9600 baud. One start bit and one stop bit are used for data byte framing. Messages are terminated by a unique byte with byte stuffing employed to avoid having the unique byte occur within a message. An alternating bit protocol and an eight bit checksum are used to ensure link integrity. - Two external interrupts are supported by the microcontroller. One is generated by the transmit
DMA controller 120 and the other is generated by the receiveDMA controller 121. These interrupts occur when therespective controller microcontroller 111. - The BCC interface is driven by an internal interrupt. The software is interrupted upon receipt or transmission of a byte.
- At the base station, the
CCU microcontroller 111 is responsible for controlling and monitoring the entire four channel data path assigned to it, which includes theVCU CCU modem RFU microcontroller 111 controls and monitors the same hardware, but supports only one data path. The CPU, in turn, is controlled by the RPU (in the base station) or the STU (in the subscriber station). - The CCU provides the VCU with mode of operation information. Mode changes occur only on system slot boundaries. During speech compression operation, the CCU also provides the VCU with information as to the position of the VCU block within the system slot (there are two VCU blocks per system slot). VCU addressing is established by the CCU prior to a data transfer, which accomplishes the MUX/DEMUX task. VCU status is read by the CCU after each block transfer and appropriate statistics are maintained by the CCU. The CCU can also initiate a VCU hard reset and/or a VCU.
- The
microcontroller 111 provides the current modulation level to a symbol-to-byte converter 126 on theRX bus 108 and a byte-to-symbol converter 127 on theTX bus 107. - The modem is provided with information concerning the type of data being received, RCC or voice, due to the different acquisition procedures used in their reception. The modem provides the CCU with a fractional clock offset, AGC level and link quality value every slot. The CCU frequency assignment is provided by the RPU or STU. The CCU controls the initiation of a modem hard reset, self test or receive side training mode.
- The CCU handles full duplex data flow via the transmit and receive
buses buffer 110 via the transmitDMA controller 121. Each block is one VCU block in length; hence, two such transfers are required for each voice channel. The CCU provides the VCU with the appropriate channel address prior to the transfer, thus effecting the multiplexing operation. - A preamble and code word, stored in the transmit
buffer 110, is sent out ahead of the VCU data at the beginning of each slot. The transmit DMA transfers data from the transmit buffer to the reclocking FIFO stock 129 while the modem receives data from theFIFO stock 128 as required. Byte to symbol conversion is accomplished by the byte-to-symbol converter 127 during the transfer. Control of the transmit DMA peripheral is handled by the microcontroller, along with the creation and insertion of the voice packet code word. - Receive data flow is verbs much a mirror image of the transmit side. Data is written into the reclocking FIFO stack 129 as it appears from the
modem DMA controller 121 empties the FIFO stack 129 into the receivebuffer 115 as required. Symbol-to-byte conversion is accomplished by the symbol-to-byte converter 126 and frame timing is accomplished by theclock circuit 130. Byte boundary alignment occurs automatically once the channel is in sync. Once a complete VCU block is received, it is DMA block transferred to the appropriate VCU. Control of the receive DMA controller is handled by themicrocontroller 111. - Code word detection is performed for every slot. The
microcontroller 111 performs this task by copying the code word byte into the local RAM and comparing it to a list of valid code words. During each slot themodem microcontroller 111 and interpreted appropriately. If power or ranging problems exist, the subscriber station is informed of this via the transmit code word. - Transmit RCC data is synthesized in the transmit
buffer 110 by the CCU according to the contents of the RCC message queue. If the RPU has sent an RCC message to the CCU, this message is formatted in the transmitbuffer 110. Otherwise the NULL KNOWLEDGE message, permanently stored in the transmitbuffer 110, is used. Once the RCC packet is ready, the RCC preamble, unique word and RCC data is DMA transferred to themodem - The receive RCC data handler has two modes: “frame search” and “monitor”. In the frame search mode, the RCC channel is considered to be out of sync. Every incoming RCC message must be synchronized using a unique word detection algorithm. In the monitor mode, the RCC channel is in sync and the unique word search algorithm is not invoked. The base station is always in the frame search mode since subscribers may burst in with bad timing at any time. At the subscriber station, the RCC data handler is in the monitor mode unless the station has not acquired RCC synchronization.
- In the frame search mode, unique word (UW) detection is performed after every RCC slot. The
microcontroller 111 performs this task by scanning for the unique word in a window about the “nominal” unique word location. Successful unique word detection provides the CCU with symbol timing information. - Receive RCC data is DMA transferred from the
modem buffer 115. Once the transfer is complete, the RCC data is copied into the local microcontroller RAM for processing. Receive RCC packets are filtered by the CCU. An RCC packet is passed to the RPU only if the unique word is detected and the CRC is correct. - During RCC operation, the corresponding VCU channel is placed in standby. No data transfers occur between the VCU and the CCU during this channel period, both on the transmit and receive
data paths - The software executes on an
Intel 8031microcontroller 111. Program storage is provided for by external EPROM on the microcontroller local bus. The software is required to respond to DMA service requests in real time, maintaining up to a 64 Kbps data flow in both directions without loss of data. FIFO buffering by thestacks 128 and 129 on the modem interface provides the required slack time for themicrocontroller 111 to perform the DMA block transfers and system control functions. - The software is divided into five separate modules: supervisor, data transfer, BCC transceiver, BMM control and utility. Each module is designed to have only one entry and exit point, with the exception of interrupts and error conditions. A further exception to this is the utility module, which contains an assortment of utility routines accessed directly from the other modules. In general, inter-module communication takes place through the use of global variables defined in a separate data segment.
- The supervisor module includes an initialization function, maintains overall program control and performs basic self test functions.
- The data transfer module supports the control of data transfer over the
TX bus 107 and theRX bus 108 for both voice and RCC, performs sync word detection for all modulation levels on both voice and RCC data, and supports the CCU-RPU RS-232communication link 122. - The BCC transceiver module performs BCC transceiver duties, handles the BCC queues, formats transmit BCC messages, processes receive BCC data and moves RCC data in and out of the CCU via the BCC.
- The BBM control module controls the RFU, modem, VCU and CCU hardware via registers, reads and interprets status information from these devices (e.g., modem AGC, link quality and symbol ambiguity), decodes embedded code words in the receive voice channel, formats the code word for the transmit voice channel, maintains a real time software/hardware timer and performs online self tests.
- The utility module performs miscellaneous utility routines accessed by the other modules.
- The CCU software is divided into four separate processes which essentially operate concurrently. Three are the BCC data, TX DMA and RX DMA processes, which are interrupt driven and are invoked only when a specific event demands attention. All three of the event driven processes are located in the data transfer module. The remaining process, which is distributed among all of the modules, is a background process which initializes, controls and monitors the other three processes.
- As BCC messages arrive from the RPU (or STU in the subscriber station), they are received and buffered by the BCC data process. Once a complete message is received, the BCC data process notifies the background process via a mailbox. The background process polls this mailbox during its main loop; hence detecting any new messages. Messages are interpreted by the background and relevant action is taken. Any reply is written into the transmit BCC message queue by the background process and the BCC data process is duly notified.
- BCC messages can initiate a reconfiguration of the CCU data channels. The necessary control information is written to the
modem VCU - Status gathering is performed by the background, TX DMA process and the RX DMA process, the latter two collect status words from the TX and RX sides of the VCU respectively. This is necessary because these status registers can only be accessed via the
TX bus 107 and theRX bus 108, which are idle only for limited periods of time. The background process gathers status information directly from themodem local bus 119. Once collected, all status information is collated by the background process and stored in specific status variables. Status requests received from the RPU are handled by the background process, based on this status history. - Some status information, like the AGC value and fractional bit offset, may necessitate CCU action. Apart from being stored as states history, such data is used to correct subscriber power and ranging problems. In the case of RCC messages, power and range information is forwarded directly to the RPU as part of the RCC. The background process performs this function by formatting a BCC message containing the RCC, AGC and ranging data. Once the packet is ready it is placed in the transmit BCC queue and the BCC data process is notified. For voice channels, this status information is used to format code words which are embedded in outbound voice packets. The background process performs this formatting function and controls the transmission of the code word via the voice channel. All code words must be transmitted five frames in a row, providing 5:1 redundancy coding. The TX DMA process automatically transmits the code word selected by the background process.
- The background process also maintains a software/hardware real time clock. This is done by polling one of the 8031's timers and counting overflows. The real time clock function provides a time base for software timeouts and other time dependent events. The background process checks to see that system timing is being maintained by polling CCU hardware error indicators and checking that data transfer events are occurring when they should in the system frame. System framing information is provided via the start of system frame status line and a timer connected to the 16
KHz clock 130. Data synchronization is performed by the background process. - The BCC data process responds to RS-232 interrupts, which can occur for both the transmit and receive directions of the port. The process simply outputs another byte on the transmit side or inputs another byte on the input side. An end-of-message delimiters on the receive side causes the BCC data routine to notify the background process.
- The TX DMA process and the RX DMA process handle the transmit and receive DMA channels.
- A step-by-step description of the data transfer function controlled by the software is provided below. Events in the data transfer process are marked by DMA controller interrupts. The interrupt occurs after the DMA controller has completed the assigned block transfer. Each walk-through starts at the beginning of a slot data transfer. It may help to look at
FIGS. 23 and 24 while proceeding through this section.FIG. 23 is a timing diagram for transferring RCC and 16 PSK voice data on the transmit bus of the CCU.FIG. 24 is a timing diagram for transferring RCC and 16 PSK data on the receive bus of the CCU. Tables 13 and 14 describe the characteristics of the time symbols shown inFIGS. 23 and 24 respectively.TABLE 13 Time Min Typ Max Symbol Operation (.mu.s) (.mu.s) (.mu.s) t.sub.S CCU DMA setup 150 — 100 t.sub.VCB VCU DMA transfer 600 — 100* t.sub.RCC RCC transfer from CCU — — 900 t.sub.M0 RCC tx modem block — 10350 10250 t.sub.M2 1st Rx modem block — 4300 4300* t.sub.M3 2nd Rx modem block — 4225 4825*
*Based on RELP VCU
-
TABLE 14 Time Min Typ Max Symbol Operation (.mu.s) (.mu.s) (.mu.s) t.sub.S CCU DMA setup 150 — 100 t.sub.VCB VCU DMA transfer 600 — 100* t.sub.M0 1st Tx modem block — 5225 5825* t.sub.M1 2nd Tx modem block — 4225 4825* t.sub.M2 RCC Rx modem block — 5600 5800* t.sub.RCC RCC transfer to CCU — — 900
*Based on RELP VCU
- Transmit Function—RCC
-
- 1. Receive “end of TX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals that processing of the previous slot is complete and that processing of the next slot can begin. The TX DMA process is invoked.
- a. Write out control channel and modulation switching information. This information is required by the
modem 19, 30 and the byte-to-symbol converter 127. - b. Format any pending RPU RCC message in the transmit
buffer 110. Otherwise prepare and send the null acknowledgment message. - c. Initialize and enable DMA transfer from the transmit
buffer 110 to themodem - d. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing.
- Transmit Function—Voice
-
- 1. Receive “end of TX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals that processing of the previous slot is complete and that processing of the next slot can begin. The TX DMA process is invoked.
- a. Write out voice channel and modulation switching information for next slot. This information is required by the
modem symbol converter 127. - b. Select VCU port address and enable DMA transfer from VCU to transmit
buffer 110. - c. Write VCU control word.
- d. Interrupt VCU to start transfer.
- e. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing.
- 2. Receive “end of TX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals that the VCU to transmit buffer transfer is complete. The TX DMA process is invoked.
- a. Read VCU status word.
- b. Write code word to the transmit
buffer 110. - c. Initialize and enable DMA transfer from the transmit
buffer 110 to themodem - d. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing.
- 3. Receive “end of TX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals that the first half slot transfer from the transmit
buffer 110 to themodem - a. Select VCU port address and enable DMA transfer from VCU to transmit buffer.
- b. Write VCU control word.
- c. Interrupt VCU to start transfer.
- d. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing.
- 4. Receive “end of TX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals that the VCU-to-transmit buffer transfer is complete. The TX DMA process is invoked.
- a. Read VCU status word.
- b. Initialize and enable the
DMA controller 120 for transmit buffer to modem transfer. - c. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing.
- Receive Function—RCC
-
- 1. Receive “end of RX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals that processing of the previous slot is complete and that processing of the next slot can begin. The RX DMA process is invoked.
- a. Setup for BPSK modulation. This information is required by the symbol to
byte converter 126. Themodem - b. Initialize and enable DMA transfer from the
modem buffer 115 for the RCC message. - c. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing. AGC calculation and bit sync ambiguity processing should take place at this time.
- 2. Receive “end of RX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals that the RCC transfer from the
modem buffer 115 is complete. The RX DMA process is invoked. -
- a. Copy RCC into local RAM.
- b. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing. Prepare to pass received RCC on to the RPU if unique word is detected and the checksum is correct.
- Receive Function—Voice
-
- 1. Receive “end of RX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals that processing of the previous slot is complete and that processing of the next slot can begin. The RX DMA process is invoked.
- a. Setup for voice data with correct modulation. This information is required by the symbol-to-
byte converter 126. The modem will have already received this information at this time. - b. Initialize and enable DMA transfer from the
modem - c. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing. AGC calculation, bit sync ambiguity and code word processing should take place at this time.
- 2. Receive “end of RX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals the first half slot transfer from the
modem buffer 115 is complete. The RX DMA process is invoked. - a. Select VCU port address and enable DMA transfer from the receive
buffer 115 to the VCU. Interrupt VCU to start transfer. - b. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing.
- 3. Receive “end of RX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals that the first half slot transfer from the receive
buffer 115 to the VCU is complete. The RX DMA process is invoked. - a. Initialize and enable the
DMA controller 121 for modem-to-receiver buffer transfer for second half slot. - b. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing.
- 4. Receive “end of RX DMA transfer” interrupt. This signals that the second half slot transfer from the
modem buffer 115 is complete. The TX DMA process is invoked. - a. Select VCU port address and enable DMA transfer from the receive
buffer 115 to the VCU. Interrupt VCU start transfer. - b. Return from interrupt and proceed with background processing.
- CCU Software Execution
- Software program execution begins as a result of a hardware reset and the flow starts in the supervisor module. The supervisor module takes care of any hardware and software initialization before entering a main service loop. The supervisor module performs some basic self test functions after a hardware reset and upon request from the RPU. The main service loop access the other modules in sequence. The supervisor module design is such that tasks are subdivided into manageable time-slices, guaranteeing that the main service loop has a reasonable worst case periodicity. Tasks requiring a real time response are handled via interrupt service routines.
- Each interrupt service routine performs the minimum of processing to satisfy the service request. This is done to preserve the serial nature of program execution as much as possible and to keep interrupt queuing to a minimum. Typically an interrupt service routine will transfer data to or from an interface and set a boolean to indicate that the action has been performed. Serially executed code, accessed from the main service loop, then proceeds to process that information as required.
- The
CCU microcontroller 111 is a data flow machine in that software events are driven by the arrival and departure of data. Precise system timing provides the framework for this data flow; however, software events are derived directly from the flow of data and not from system frame markers. This approach allows the software to respond to “real” events (such as data I/O requests) rather than “artificial” events (such as system timing markers). The software relies upon the hardware to convert the former's asynchronous actions into events which are synchronous with the system frame timing. For this to work, it is necessary that the software guarantee to have things initialized and ready before the system frame event occurs. - It is therefore apparent that, while the CCU software is not heavily loaded, it is called upon to respond to events and complete certain tasks within a limited amount of time. This real time processing is interrupt driven and hence requires considerable care in its design. There are four potentially conflicting real time events demanded on the microcontroller: transmit DMA servicing, receive DMA servicing, transmit RS-232 servicing and receive RS-232 servicing. The RS-232 interrupts have the lowest priority since they occur at a maximum rate of one per millisecond. The software is designed so that the one millisecond time constraint is not violated. Response times for voice and RCC data handling are more critical and a discussion of these follows.
- The relative timing for the data transfers on the transmit bus and receive bus are shown in
FIGS. 23 and 24 . The diagrams are drawn approximately to scale and show a worst case timing scenario. The time multiplexed nature of the transmit and receive buses is clearly illustrated by the diagrams. The dark cross lines shown on the transmit and receive paths correspond to the microcontroller activity on the respective bus (t.sub.S, t.sub.RCC). During this time, therespective DMA controller DMA controller - The reclocking FIFO stacks 128, 129 at the modem interface create the primary timing constraint implicit in the timing diagrams. The FIFO stacks hold 16 symbols, providing one millisecond of buffering time before underflowing (TX) or overflowing (RX). During this millisecond, the CCU can use the transmit or receive
buses - Upon power-up, the CCU software performs an internal self test and places the VCU, modem and RFU into their default states. The
microcontroller 111 monitors the system frame timing and begins to perform block transfers to allow the VCU to gain synchronization. Once data transfers are initiated, themicrocontroller 111 uses the DMA end of block interrupt to retain system timing. This interrupt is directly tied to the data throughput of the CCU and hence the 16KHz symbol clock 130. The VCU retains system timing implicitly via DMA transfer requests generated by themicrocontroller 111 as a result of the end of block interrupt. Themicrocontroller 111 continues to monitor frame timing to ensure that proper system operation is maintained. - At the subscriber station, system startup also entails radio synchronization. This is performed by locating the RCC and deriving system timing from it. Once receive timing is established, the
microcontroller 111 to establish transmit timing with the base station. - The data transfer module supports the real time and background data transfer events in the CCU. Data transfers are serviced for the transmit data path, the receive data path, the transmit BCC and the receive BCC. All of these tasks are interrupt driven events requiring real time response. The module also performs synchronization acquisition and monitoring as a background task.
- The transmit data path handler is invoked when the transmit
DMA controller 120 requires service. This typically occurs following a DMA block transfer, at which time the DMA peripheral invokes an end of block transfer interrupt. The interrupt is received on one of the two external interrupt lines of theModel 8031microcontroller 111. The service required by the interrupt depends on the type of data transfer, RCC or voice, and the time of occurrence within the slot. - The transmit data path interrupt occurs at predictable times during each slot period. The interrupt times and durations are shown on
FIGS. 23 and 24 . At each occurrence, themicrocontroller 111 is required to initialize the DMA peripheral for the next block transfer. This operation should be performed within 150 us from interrupt request to interrupt completion. In the case of RCC data, the first service request requires themicrocontroller 111 to format the RCC message in the transmitbuffer 110 prior to the DMA transfer. This operation must be completed within 900 us. Since the operations on the transmit path are usually short and require fast response, the interrupt is given the highest priority. - The only output from the transmit data path interrupt handler is the VCU status word collected after the VCU block transfer. This status word is analyzed by software in the BBM control module.
- The receive data path handler is invoked when the receive
DMA controller 121 requires service. This typically occurs following a DMA block transfer, at which time the DMA peripheral invokes an end of block transfer interrupt. The interrupt is received on one of the two external interrupt lines of the 8031microcontroller 111. The service required by the interrupt depends on the type of data transfer, RCC or voice, and the time of occurrence within the slot. - The receive data path interrupt occurs at predictable times during each slot period. The interrupt times and durations are shown in
FIGS. 23 and 24 . At each occurrence, themicrocontroller 111 is required to initialize theDMA controller 121 for the next block transfer. This operation should be performed within 150 microseconds from interrupt request to interrupt completion, if DMA initialization is the only task to be performed. In the case of RCC data, the last service request requires themicrocontroller 111 to copy the RCC message from the receivebuffer 115 to the local RAM after the DMA transfer. This operation must also be completed within 900 microseconds. Since transmit path servicing can occur during this time, receive path interrupts have a lower priority than those of the transmit path. The receive data path interrupt handler makes the VCU status word available after each VCU block transfer. This status word is analyzed by software in the BBM control module. The handler also reads new RCC messages from the channel, which are then interpreted in the BCC transceiver module. - The BCC receive module is implemented via the on-
chip RS 232 UART. The UART is capable of generating one internal interrupt, which is triggered whenever a byte is received or transmitted. The BCC handler polls a status bit to determine which of the two cases caused the interrupt and proceeds to service the port accordingly. The baud rate generator is programed for a nominal rate of 9600 baud, resulting in a maximum of 1920 interrupts per second. Each interrupt must be serviced within a 1 ms period to avoid data loss. Since the typical interrupt frequency is low and the response time relatively long, BCC data transfer interrupts have a low priority. - The BCC data transfer handler uses pointers to queue and de-queue data as it is received and transmitted respectively. Only link level processing occurs here, including byte stuffing and end of message insertion. These actions are described in the system interface specification.
- Very little data processing occurs in the BCC transceiver module. Its main task is to queue and de-queue data while handling the transmit, receive and BCC data paths. The data synchronization acquisition and monitoring, described below, comprise the major processing functions of the BCC transceiver module.
- Sync word detection implies a synchronization operation at the symbol level. The term “sync word” is a generic, applying to both the unique word in the RCC and the code word in voice channels. The unique word (UW) is a fixed 8-bit pattern placed at the beginning of an RCC message. A code word (CW) is currently any one of 8 possible 8-bit patterns placed at the beginning of a voice channel. In addition to their synchronization role, code words are used to indicate connection status, power adjustments and ranging adjustments.
- The base CCU must exhaustively check for a valid RCC message in every slot. It performs this task by scanning for the unique word in a window .+−0.3 symbols about the nominal UW location, based upon master system timing. The search algorithm starts with the nominal UW positions and shifts one symbol right and left until it (1) finds the UW pattern and (2) verifies a correct RCC checksum. The search terminates as soon as (1) and (2) are satisfied or all possibilities have been exhausted. The shift information, RCC message and power information are sent to the RPU following a successful search.
- During every voice slot, the base station CCU checks the received voice data for a valid code word. Only the nominal code word position is checked since no active symbol synchronization is performed during voice operation. If no code word is detected for five consecutive frames then the channel is declared out of sync and the RPU is informed of the condition. It is up to the RPU to take any appropriate action at this point. Sync is defined to be restored after three-out-of-five consecutive frames have successful code word detection.
- The subscriber CCU, when receiving RCC data, can be in one of two modes: “frame search” or “monitor”. The frame search mode is used to acquire receive frame timing from the incoming RCC data and is invoked automatically when receive RCC sync is lost. The monitor mode is entered whenever receive frame synchronization has been acquired.
- When in the frame search mode, the subscriber CCU must exhaustively check for a valid RCC message after every RCC slot. Like the base CCU, it performs this task by scanning for the unique word in a window .+−0.3 symbols about the nominal UW location, based upon timing derived from modem AM hole detection. The search algorithm starts with the nominal UW position and shifts one symbol right and left until it (1) finds the UW pattern and (2) verifies a correct RCC checksum. The search terminates as soon as (1) and (2) are satisfied or all possibilities have been exhausted. The shift information from a successful search is used to adjust the CCU generated receive framing markers. Acquisition terminates when (1) and (2) above are satisfied for three consecutive frames with the UW in its nominal position. The STU is informed of framing acquisition when it occurs. RCC messages are not forwarded to the STU during frame search mode.
- When framing acquisition is accomplished, the subscriber station CCU enters the monitor mode. Only the nominal UW position is checked to avoid the possibility of false UW acquisitions. If no UW is detected for five consecutive frames then the channel is declared out of sync and frame search mode is entered. The STU is informed of this out of sync condition. During the monitor mode, RCC messages that have a correct checksum and SIN number are passed on to the STU.
- During every voice slot, the subscriber station CCU checks the received voice data for a correct code word. Only the nominal code word position is checked since no active symbol synchronization is performed during voice operation. All possible code words are searched for in this direction of the channel. Code words can cause incremental changes in the subscriber station's power and ranging values. Incremental range changes can actually result in the change of symbol as well as fractional ranging values. If no code word is detected for five consecutive frames then the channel is declared out of sync and the STU is informed of the condition. Sync is defined to be restored after three-out-of-five consecutive frames have successful code word detection.
- Additional CCU Considerations
- The transmit DMA transfer request between the transmit
buffer 110 and themodem FIFO stack 128. This implies that theFIFO stack 128 will always be full when a DMA block transfer is complete. - The receive DMA transfer request between the
modem buffer 115 must be derived from the empty bit of the stack 129. This implies that the FIFO stack 129 will always be empty when a DMA block transfer is complete. - The CCU controller software provides the gate to enable DMA transfers, but external control must provide the handshaking to initiate and maintain the block transfer. This is particularly important for the modem interface where frame timing is critical.
- The
microcontroller 111 should have the capability to put a DMA transfer on hold. The software will not attempt to use the DMA bus during a block transfer unless this control is exerted or the DMA peripheral is idle. - The reclocking FIFO stacks 128, 129 should be automatically cleared (reset) periodically.
- Frame timing information must be available to the
microcontroller 111. This could take the form of a symbol clock input to an internal timer of the microcontroller. - When an RCC or voice packet is received by the CCU in sync, no symbol shifting should be required to bring the packet onto a byte boundary. This should apply regardless of modulation level.
- Modem
- The modem operates in one of three operation modes. In the base station, the modem carries on a full-duplex transmit and receive function. When operating in the subscriber station, the modem operates in a half-duplex mode, transmitting during part of the TDMA frame and receiving during another part of the TDMA frame. The third mode is a self-adapting training mode. One modem design accommodates all these functions. The modem performs the appropriate function in response to keying signals coming in from the controlling CCU.
- The
subscriber station modem 30 a and thebase station modem 19 are identical. A block diagram of the modem is shown inFIG. 25 . - The modem transmitter sections include a
TX symbol filter 132, a digital-to-analog (D/A)converter 133, a 200 KHzbandpass filter 134, amixer 135 and a TX (transmitter)timing control circuit 136. The receiver section of the modern includes amixer 138, an analog-to-digital (A/D)converter 139, aFIFO stack 140 and aModel TMS 320microprocessor 141. - The modem transmitter section transmits the information fed to it by the CCU at 16-level PSK modulation. It is up to the CCU an the receive side to interpret the data as DPSK, QPSK or 16 PSK. The modem transmits without the knowledge of the modulation level.
- The modem transmitter section is fully implemented in hardware and requires no adjustments. Symbols received from the CCU are encoded and their corresponding waveforms are shaped to provide good interference properties and not suffer amplitude or group delay distortion. The justification of this concept is made on the assumption that in the near neighborhood frequency band (within 50-100 KHz) to the band utilized there are no strong interfering signals (power densities of 30-40 dB above the signal). The modem transmitter section utilizes relatively wide IF filtering (100 KHz) so that the transmitted signal will not suffer amplitude or group delay distortion, and also filters out any harmonics generated by the digital filtering done at baseband.
- The
TX symbol filter 132 is a fixed-coefficient digital FIR (Finite-duration impulse-response) Filter. Thisfilter 132 simulates a six pole filter with a sampling rate of 50 samples per symbol per 6 symbol stay in the FIR Filter. - The modem receives symbols from its respective CCU at a rate of 16K symbols/second. These symbols are then converted to a DPSK code for input on
line 143 to theFIR filter 132. The FIR algorithm requires that every other symbol be inverted before entering into the FIR filter. Gray code is used for the DPSK coding. This insures that if a symbol was received in error, there is a good probability that the two symbols to the receiver codec will be in error by only one bit. - The impulse response of the
FIR filter 132 is truncated at 6T (T={fraction (1/16)} KHz). The FIR filter oversamples the symbols at a rate of 800 KHz so that every symbol is sampled 50 times during its 5T stay in the filter. This is equivalent to a sampling rate of 3T/25 where the sampling period is T/25, so that samples are output each 3T/25 period. The outputs are skewed such that only the first and fourth, second and fifth, or third and sixth pairs of samples overlap at any one time. Each of these T/25 length samples is actually divided into two parts. During the first half of the sample period, the I portion of the output is computed and during the second half of the period, the Q portion of the output is computed. Thus, the actual rate at which theFIR filter 132 outputs data is 50.times.16 KHz=800 KHz. The I and O sampling is staggered by one-half a sample period, but this is corrected by theFIR filter 132. - Signals representing the multiplication of symbols and impulse responses in the
FIR 132 filter and the addition of two of these multiplications are provided by an 8K.times.8 ROM online 144 in response to the symbols that are received online 143. - The
FIR filter 132outputs 10 bit digital samples online 144 at the rate of 800 KHz. These values are the fed into the D/A converter 133 to create an analog waveform online 145. This waveform is the time-shared I and Q waveforms of the symbol to be transmitted. This shared waveform online 145 is filtered by the 200 KHzbandpass filter 134 then fed overline 146 into themixer 135. The mixer's local oscillator input is an IF frequency signal of 20 MHz online 147. The I and Q components are thereby upconverted to 20.2 MHz IF output signal online 148. The output signal online 148 is fed through a 20.2 MHz bandpass filter (not shown) and provided to theRFU - The desired signal out of the D/
A converter 134 is centered at 200 KHz with a bandwidth of about 32 KHz. By multiplying the 200 KHz waveform by 20 MHz, the output waveform mixes the I and Q samples with the SIN and COS components of the IF frequency. Thus, the 20 MHz signal can directly multiply the output waveform and the exact component multiplications will be handled automatically. Therefore, there is no need for a discrete SIN(IF)/COS(IF) generation circuit to multiply the I/Q samples from the D/A as is in the receiver. This also removes isolation feed through in the mixer from the baseband to the output of the mixer. - The output data stored in the
transmitter FIR filter 132 is computed to correct for any errors that may occur due to the {fraction (1/50)} T difference in the I and Q time values. Also the IF filter in the RFU (FIGS. 28 and 29 ) adds the two values together to form the correct transmitted waveform since its bandwidth is relatively small compared to the IF frequency. - In the modem receiver section, the
mixer 138 mixes an analog waveform received from the RFU online 150 via a 20 MHz bandpass filter (not shown) with a 20 MHz IF signal online 151 to down convert the analog signal to baseband online 152. The analog signal is then converted by the A/O converter 139 to a digital signal online 153 which is buffered in theFIFO stack 140 for processing by themicroprocessor 141. Themicroprocessor 141 performs frequency and bit tracking of the received digital signal and also performs the FIR filtering and demodulation of the signal into a binary symbol stream that is provided online 154 to the CCU. - In addition to the analog and digital data signals which are processed by the modem, a number of control and status signals are sent to and from the modem. These signals generally are sent to the modem from the CCU. The modem also sends control signals to the RFU to control such functions as the transmit power level, frequency, AGC, and antenna switching for diversity.
- The modem interfaces are shown in
FIGS. 26 and 27 . The modem receives most of its inputs from the CCU. Other inputs are from the RFU and the timing units. The modem inputs are as follows: - The following lines carry the signals described to the is
modem CCU 18, 29: - The TX DATA lines 156 carry a 4 bit symbol to be transmitted by the modem (2 bits for QPSK, 1 bit for BPSK). The MOD BUS 157 is a bidirectional microprocessor bus that provides control/status information to/from the modem. The MOD WR line 158 carries a control signal to the latch MOD BUS into the modem. The MOD RD line 159 carries a control signal to put modem status and other information onto the MOD BUS for transmission to the
CCU - The IF RECEIVE line 165 carries an IF receive frequency input signal to the
modem RFU - The following lines carry the signals described to the
modem 19 from theSTIMU 35. The 80MHZ line 167 carries an 80 MHz ECL clock signal. A like signal is provided to themodem 30 a by a timing unit (not shown) in the subscriber station. The 16KHz line 168 carries a master TX CLK signal used in base station. The SOMF line carries a master start of frame signal in the base station from STIMU. This signal is not used in the modem, but forwarded to theCCU - The following lines carry the signals described from the
modem CCU TX CLK line 171 carries a 16 KHz clock signal that provides the CCU with the symbol transmit timing. Symbols are clocked into the modem with the rising edge of this clock. In the base station, all slots have the same master TX CLK. Thus all signals from the base station are sent at the same time. In the subscriber station, the TX CLK is offset by the fractional range delay by the modem on information supplied by the CCU. The RX CLK line 172 carries the 16 KHz clock signal that is derived from the received signal. This signal is always provided in the subscriber station, but is provided only during control slot acquisition in the base station.) This clock signal clocks out the received symbol to the CCU and provide symbol timing to the CCU. The RX DATA lines 173 carry the four bit received symbol, clocked by RX CLK signal. The MOD BUS 157 carries status and data information from the modem. TheMOD SOMF line 175 forwards the SOMF signal from the STIMU to the CCU in the base station. The AM STROBE line 176 carries a high to low transition to give the CCU a rough frame marker during RCC acquisition in the subscriber station. This is a one shot line that is pulsed when themicroprocessor 141 determines the approximate location of the AM hole. - The following lines carry the signals described from the
modem RFU RX 80 MHZ REF line 180 carries anECL 80 MHz reference clock signal to the RFU RX section. TheTX EN line 182 to the RFU TX section carries a signal to enable RF transmission. The RX EN line 183 to RFU RX section carries a signal to enable RF reception. The AGC WR line 184 carries a write strobe to latch AGC data into RFU RX section. The RXFREQ WR line 185 carries a write strobe for frequency writes to the RFU TX section. The PWR WR line 186 carries a write strobe to latch power information into RFU TX section. The PWR RD line 187 carries a read strobe to read back power information from the RFU TX section. The TXFREQ RD line 188 carries a read strobe to read back transmit frequency from the RFU TX section. TheTXFREQ WR line 189 carries write strobe frequency writes to the RFU TX section. The IF TRANSMIT line 190 carries the transmitted signal at IF frequency to the RFU. - The following lines carry the signals described from the
modem 19 to theSTIMU 35. TheVCXO BUS 192 is a 20-bit data bus to a VCXO in theSTIMU 35 with control information for frequency tracking. The VCXO WR line carries a write pulse to the VCXO circuit for latching theVCXO BUS 192 into the VCXO. Like signals are carried from themodem 30 a to a timing unit (not shown) in the subscriber station. - The base station modem operation is assigned to a fixed RF frequency. Communication at the base station is full duplex, therefore the modem receiver and transmitter will be operating simultaneously. A modem also is assigned to be the control frequency channel modem, thus only transmitting and receiving information with the radio control channel (RCC) format during the allocated control slot period. All transmissions from the base station modems are clocked to the master TX CLK signal at 16 KHz on
line 171. Unlike the subscriber modems, the base station modems 19 output to theCCU 18 the fractional part of the symbol time between the master TX CLK signal online 171 and the derived RX CLK signal on line 172 in themodem 19. This information is then sent to the subscriber station in the RCC so that the subscriber station will delay its transmission in order that is signal is received at the base station synchronous with all other slots. - The
base station modem 19 also transmits a null energy signal in the control slot to provide the RCC AM hole (which establishes a frame reference) when the RFU transmits a null energy signal. This no-carrier portion of the RCC transmission is used for initial RX acquisition at the subscriber station. - The
modem 19 is unaware of the fact that there are four voice codecs in the base station, multiplexed by theCCU 18, for four 16 PSK subscriber slot assignments. Themodem 19 accepts the bit stream from theCCU 18 and treats the transmission just as a single codec subscriber. - All operations in the
subscriber station modem 30 a are derived from the received RX CLK signal on line 172 which is recovered from the received transmission. This serves as the master clock of the subscriber station. The TX CLK signal online 171 to theCCU 29 is not a master clock as in the base station. It is derived from the RX CLK signal on line 172 and delayed by the fractional time as selected by theCCU 29. TheCCU 29 determines the delay from the RCC. The delay is determined by the distance between base and subscriber stations. Thesubscriber station CCU 29 feeds this fractional time information to themodem 30 a through MOD BUS 157. Themodem 30 a itself accounts for the fractional delay. TheCCU 29 accounts for the integer symbol delay be insertion of the TX SOS signal an line 162 delayed by the correct number of symbols. This process aligns the signals arriving at the base station from variations in the range of all subscriber stations. - Communication is half-duplex at the subscriber station. Thus, when the transmitter is idle, it is inhibited. The
modem 30 a, when not actively transmitting, is set to its receive mode and can thus monitor the gain levels of the receive signal to be prepared when a burst arrives from the base station. - The
subscriber station modem 30 a does not transmit an AM guard band for the RCC slot. None is required since the base station defines the frame. Unlike the fixed frequency base station modems 19, subscriber station modems 30 a also can transmit or receive data over any one of the 26 frequencies selected in the RFU by theCCU 29. - There are many sources of delay in the modem that have a pronounced affect upon the system timing. Such things include analog filter delays, propagation delays, FIR filter processing delays, etc. These delays skew the TX and RX frames from one another, and these skews must be taken into careful account.
- The delay between the TX SOS signal on line 162 in the base station and the first received analog symbol “peak” at the base station is +7.4 symbols. Therefore, there is a skew between TX and RX slots. To correctly decode the incoming phase, the modem must begin sampling about 3.5 symbols before the “peak” arrives. Therefore, the skew between TX SOS signal and the beginning of RX sampling is about 4 symbols in length.
- At the base station, the start of the RX slot occurs about 4 T after the start of the TX slot. The RX slot start is defined as the time the first analog sample is taken in order to detect the first “peak” that is received.
- The subscriber station clocks are derived completely from a
master 80 MHz VCXO in the subscriber station timing unit (not shown). The VCXO is controlled by an analog line from themodem 30 a. From this, all receive and transmit clocks are calculated. Themodem 30 a then provides theCCU 29 with the 16 KHz RX CLK signal on line 172 derived from the incoming data stream. TheCCU 29 itself detects the unique word in the control channel and can determine frame and slot markers from the unique word and the RX CLK signal on line 172. The AM hole signal from the signal demodulated by the modem informs theCCU 29 where to look for the unique word. - During the reception of any slot, the
modem microprocessor 141 through a D/A converter. The microprocessor frequency acquisition and tracking algorithms compute the changes in the VCXO necessary to maintain synchronization. - In the base station, an OCXO located in the
STIMU 35 is fixed and acts as the master clock of the system. Therefore, no frequency deviations will occur on reception. - During the receipt of any slot, the
modem microprocessor 141 has control over a variable frequency divider of the 80 MHz VCXO or OCXO (only during control slot demodulation). Inside of the bit tracking loop, themicroprocessor 141 modifies the frequency division in order to obtain bit synchronization. During the reception of a voice channel, the division values have step sizes of 0.1% of 16 KHz, but during a control slot the values may change more drastically, as much as .+−0.50%. - Frame synchronization is handled in completely different ways in the base station and the subscriber stations. In the base station, the master SOMF (start of modem frame) signal is forwarded to the
CCU 18 online 175 from the timing unit online 169 via themodem 19. This is the master SOMF signal used for all transmission from the base station. From this and the master system symbol clock signal (16 KHz), theCCU 18 can derive all slot and frame timing. - In the subscriber station, frame synchronization is done by the
CCU 29 with the detection of the unique word in the received RCC data stream. Upon initial acquisition, themodem 30 a provides a one shot, approximate frame marker (AM STROBE) on line 176. During acquisition, themodem 30 a searches for the AM HOLE in the RCC. IF the AM HOLE is detected, themodem 30 a counts it for a few frames and then provide the AM STROBE marker on line 176 to theCCU 29 at the frame location of the AM HOLE. TheCCU 29 uses this strobe marker to set un initial frame marker counters (windowing) that can he modified by CCU software for exact frame sync. This also signifies that the AM HOLE was detected and the RCC is acquired. - Slot synchronization is under the control of the
CCU modem line 171 and the RX CLK signal on line 172 respectively. - The self adapting mode is a looped-back state that the modem enters to train the receiver's digital FIR filter coefficients to correct for any receive analog filter degradations that may occur in time or with temperature. The analysis is done by looping back the transmitter data through the RF unit and receiving a known pattern in the receiver. The coefficients are optimized over a 5 constraint LaGrangian system. These constraints are (1) the received data stream; (2) the data stream delayed by 0.05 T; (3) the data stream advanced by 0.05 T; (4) the data stream from the adjacent upper channel; and (5) the data steam from the adjacent lower channel.
- During training, the
microprocessor 141 provides to the TX FIR filter 131 on line 143 a series of 32 symbol long training patterns. This is done via a FIFO stack (not shown) that is enabled during the training mode. Advances/delays are done by the receive bit track circuitry that will skew the two streams by 0.05 T. - The
CCU modem CCU CCU RFU - The modem is described in further detail a co-pending U.S. patent application entitled “Modem for Subscriber RF Telephone System” filed on even date herewith by Eric Paneth, David N. Critchlow and Moshe Yehushua the disclosure of which is incorporated herein by reference.
- RF/IF Unit (RFU) and Antenna Interface
- The RFU subsystem provides the communications channel link between the modem and the antenna in both the base station and the subscriber station. The RFU functions as a linear amplitude and frequency translator and is essentially transparent to the channel data and modulation characteristics.
- The antenna interface circuit for the subscriber station is shown in
FIG. 28 . A RFUcontrol logic circuit 192 is coupled to thetransmitter antenna 32, and the threereceiver antennas control logic circuit 192 is also interfaced with the transmit section of themodem 30 a, and the receive sections of themodems - The transmitter section of the antenna interface includes an up converter and
amplifier circuit 193, aTX synthesizer 194, apower amplifier 196 and a TX/RX mode switch 197. A fistreceiver section RX 1 of the antenna interface includes a down converter andamplifier 198, aRX synthesizer 199 and apreamplifier 200 which is connected to switch 197. Each additional diversity receiver section, TXn (n=2, 3) includes a down converter andamplifier 202, a RX synthesizer 203 and apreamplifier 204. - The RFU
control logic circuit 192 provides the following signals to the transmitter section of the antenna interface circuit in response to the signals received from the transmit section of themodem 30 a: (1) a TX enable signal online 206 for causing the TX/RX switch 197 to enable transmission by thetransmitter antenna 32; (2) an IF input signal online 207 to the up converter andamplifier 193; (3) a power control signal online 208, also up to the up converter andamplifier 193; (4) a clock reference signal online 209 to theTX synthesizer 194; and (5) a channel select signal online 210, also to theTX synthesizer 194. TheTX synthesizer 194 responds to the channel select signal online 210 by providing a TX frequency select signal online 211 to the up converter andamplifier 193 that is equal to the difference between the desired transmit frequency and the modem IF frequency. - The RFU
control logic circuit 192 provides the following signals to each of the receiver sections of the antenna interface circuit in response to the signals received from the respective receive sections of themodems amplifier circuits amplifier circuits lines 215 to theRX synthesizers 199, 203; and (4) a channel select signal onlines 216 also to theRX synthesizers 199, 203 respond to the channel select signal onlines 216 by providing a RX frequency select signal onlines 217 to the down converter andamplifier circuits amplifier circuits control logic circuit 192 for delivery to the receive sections of therespective modems - The up converter and
amplifier circuit 193 in the transmitter section receives the modulated IF signal online 207, amplifies it and translates it to the selected RF channel frequency. A combination of filters (not shown),amplifiers - The subscriber station RFU functions as a half-duplex transceiver with the receivers inactive during the transmit intervals. The transmit burst rate is sufficiently high to simulate full-duplex operation to the user. The frequency channel assigned is that selected by the base station RPU.
- The antenna interface circuit for the base station is shown in
FIG. 29 . An RFUcontrol logic circuit 219 is coupled to thetransmitter antenna 23, and the threereceiver antennas control logic circuit 219 is also interfaced with the transmit section of themodem 19, and the receive sections of themodems Modems FIG. 2 .) - The transmitter section of the antenna interface includes an up converter and
amplifier circuit 220, aTX synthesizer 221, apower amplifier 222, ahigh power amplifier 223, in apower detector 224 and abandpass filter 225. A firstreceiver section RX 1 of the antenna interface includes a down converter andamplifier 230, aRX synthesizer 231, apreamplifier 232 and abandpass filter 233. Each additional diversity receiver section, RXn includes a down converter andamplifier 234, aRX synthesizer 235, apreamplifier 236, and abandpass filter 237. - The RFU
control logic circuit 219 provides the following signals to the transmitter section of the antenna interface circuit in response to the signals received from the transmit section of the modem 19: (1) a TX ON signal online 235 to the up converter andamplifier 220 for turning on the transmission section to enable transmission by thetransmitter antenna 23; (2) an IF input signal online 240, also to the up converter andamplifier 220; (3) a clock reference signal online 24 to theTX synthesizer 221; and (4) a channel select signal online 242, also to theTX synthesizer 221. TheTX synthesizer 221 responds to the channel select signal online 242 by providing a RX frequency select signal online 243 to the up converter andamplifier 220 that is equal to the difference between the desired transmit frequency and the modem IF frequency. A level control signal is provided online 244 from thepower detector 224 to the up converter andamplifier 220. - The RFU
control logic circuit 219 provides the following signals to each of the receiver sections of the antenna interface circuit in response to the signals received from the respective receive sections of themodems lines 245 to the down converter andamplifier circuits lines 246 to theRX synthesizers lines 247 also to theRX synthesizers RX synthesizers lines 247 by providing a RX frequency select signal on lines 248 to the down converter andamplifier circuits amplifier circuit line 249 to the RFUcontrol logic circuit 219 for delivery to the receive sections of therespective modems - The RFU's in the base station and the subscriber stations are similar with the exception of the additional
high power amplifier 223 used to increase the transmit power of the base station RF outputs. The basic function of the RFU's in either station is to convert the modulated IF (20.2 MHz) signal from the modem transmitter section to the desired RF transmission frequency in the 450 MHz UHF range. The receive side of the RF unit performs the opposite action of downconverting the receive 450 MHz UHF signals to an IF signal at 20 MHz. The transmit and receive frequencies are offset from each other by 5 MHz. The RF units are programmed by the CCU control function to operate on different frequencies used in the overall system. Typically, each base station RFU will be set to operate on a given frequency assignment upon system initialization and will not change. The number of RFU's in the base station corresponds to the number of transmit and receive frequency channel pairs supported in the base station. The subscriber station RFUs will typically chance frequency of operation with each new phone connection. - The RFUs include variable AGC and transmit power level adjustments. The AGC gain coefficient is provided by the modem based on a computation in the receive
section processor 141 in the modem. The subscriber station transmit power level is computed by the CCU based on messages received from the base station on the RCC channel and other control parameters. - If all slots in a frequency channel are not used, the RFU will transmit an idle pattern placed into it by the CCU. If a completed frequency channel is not used, the transmitter for that frequency can be disabled by the CCU software through the modem.
- The switching time for the diversity switches shall be less than 50 microseconds.
- Three antennas and three separate RF/IF units are provided. (Single transmit, three receive).
- Many portions of the base station RFU and antenna interface are identical to those described above for the subscriber station. This subsection emphasizes the differences
- The base station RFUs and antenna interface circuits operate on a full duplex basis. All transmitters and receivers normally operate at 100 percent duty cycle. In addition, it is economically attractive for the base station to operate at higher transmit power and to use lower noise figure receivers with diversity. The transmitter is intended for operation at the highest permitted power level without dynamic control. Receive diversity is provided by multiple receive antennas and multiple modems.
- The base station ordinarily does not change operating frequency or transmit power level during normal operation. The transmitter and receiver sections are fully tunable to each of the 26 channels.
- The transmit section of the base station antenna interface receives the modulated IF INPUT signal on
line 239 from the modem and processes it as in the subscriber transmitter section described above. It is further amplified to the required power level and filtered by a cavitypreselector bandpass filter 221, to reduce noise at the operating frequencies of co-located receivers and to reduce spurious emission level. - The base station receive section of the antenna interface is similar to that discussed for the subscriber station except that the front end is preceded by cavity preselector bandpass filters 233, 237, which help to eliminate the desensitization caused by co-located or nearby transmitters. Low noise preamplifiers are also used to reduce the usable threshold signal level. All
antennas - Diversity Reception Processing
- Diversity reception is used to reduce the probability of experiencing a channel fade below an accepted threshold. The diversity system is capable of adding three branch diversity over the subscriber to base and the base to subscriber paths. The diversity hardware at both the base station and the subscriber stations includes a special diversity combiner circuit, three modems and their associated RF units and antennas. Only one modem-RFU-antenna combination has transmit capability. Although the
diversity combiner circuit 33 is shown only in the subscriber system diagram ofFIG. 2 , it is present and connected to the modems and CCU in the base station in the same manner as in the subscriber station. - When operating with diversity reception, the base station or subscriber station uses three receive antennas separated by a distance great enough to insure that the fading characteristics of the signals received will be uncorrelated. These three antennas feed through three identical receiver sections in the antenna interface to the RFU control logic circuit whose IF outputs go into separate modems for demodulation. A
TMS 320 microprocessor in the diversity combiner circuit 33 (diversity processor) takes the outputs from the modems and provide a more reliable data stream to the rest of the system in a way that emulates a single modem. The two tasks of performing the diversity combination and appearing as a single modem to the CCU are the responsibility of the diversity processor hardware and software. - The diversity processor reads from the three modems their data symbols, AGC values, signal+noise, magnitude and phase error (deviation of the detected phase from the ideal 22.5 degree reference vectors). The algorithm used to determine the demodulated symbol involves using a majority vote and calculations of signal-to-noise ratios for each modem to identify the modem with the most likely right answer.
- The diversity processor-CCU interface registers are almost identical to the resisters found in the modems, with the exception that the extra registers used to pass information used in the diversity processing function are not needed and therefore only three address bits are needed.
- Because the I/O capabilities of the TMS320 microprocessor are small, and most of the processing works with one type of I/O register at a time, a special register which will hold the register address needed at the time is used. For example, the AGC value from each modem must be read, the highest value chosen, and the result written to the diversity processor's I/O registers where it can be read by the CCU. The addressing of these registers is most efficiently done if the address of the AGC register is first written to a part where it is placed on the modem address lines. Thereafter, the processor need only address the correct modem or the microprocessor register bank, thereby speeding I/O operations.
- In the subscriber station diversity system, each modem has its own timing unit, and the timing signals used by the three modems in the diversity system are not necessarily in phase. Because the modem clock signals of the three modems are not synchronized to each other, latches are needed to hold the data symbol output from each modem until the diversity processor reads it.
- An important function of the diversity processor is to maintain communications between the CCU and the three modems. This communication must be done quickly enough so as to meet all of the CCU's requirements but not so fast as to overload the diversity processor.
Claims (51)
1. A communication system which wirelessly transmits multiple information signals between one or more base stations and a plurality of subscriber units, said system comprising:
(a) a transmitter for transmitting information signals from an originating source to at least one of said subscriber units over a channel including a plurality of time frames, each time frame including a plurality of time slots; and
(b) a processor for (i) assigning a duration of time for said information signals, wherein said duration equals the duration of at least one of said time slots, (ii) maintaining a memory of assigned time slots in said channel, and (iii) providing a time slot assignment signal to complete a communication connection based on said assigned time slots in said memory.
2. The system of claim 1 wherein a designated time frame includes other information signals from other originating sources that are assigned to time slots other than said at least one of said time slots.
3. The system of claim 1 wherein said information signals include data information.
4. The system of claim 2 wherein said information signals include voice information.
5. The system of claim 4 wherein said voice information signals have a predetermined bit processing rate.
6. The system of claim 1 wherein said processor assigns information signals having respective different bit processing rates to time slots in a designated time frame.
7. The system of claim 1 wherein said information signals are communicated over said channel by modulating said information signals onto one of a plurality of frequencies assigned to said channel.
8. The system of claim 7 further comprising:
(c) a modulator for modulating said information signals onto said one frequency, and for modulating different information signals having respective different modulation types, wherein said processor assigns information signals having respective different modulation types to said at least one of said time slots.
9. The system of claim 8 wherein said modulator uses modulation to transmit at least two bits per symbol.
10. The system of claim 8 wherein a first modulation type comprises phase shift keying (PSK) modulation.
11. The system of claim 1 further comprising:
(c) a linear modulator including a linear amplifier.
12. The system of claim 1 further comprising:
(c) a receiver for receiving reverse information signals from an originating one of said subscriber units to a destination over a reverse channel at an assigned frequency, said reverse information signal being present on at least one time slot within a designated time frame.
13. The system of claim 1 wherein at least one of said subscriber units is a mobile subscriber unit.
14. The system of claim 1 further comprising:
(c) a multiplexer for multiplexing said information signals onto said channel.
15. A communication system which wirelessly transmits multiple information signals between one or more base stations and a plurality of subscriber units, said system comprising:
(a) a transmitter for transmitting information signals from an originating source to at least one of said subscriber units over a time division multiplex (TDM) channel including a plurality of time frames, each time frame including a predetermined number of time slots, each time slot having a predetermined position in the time frame; and
(b) a processor for (i) assigning segments of each of said information signals to said time slots of said TDM channel, (ii) maintaining a memory of the predetermined positions of assigned time slots in said TDM channel, and (iii) providing a time slot assignment signal to complete a communication connection based on said predetermined positions in said memory.
16. The system of claim 15 wherein a frequency assigned to said channel has N time slots per time frame where N is at least four and N TDM channels are assigned to said at least one frequency such that an ith TDM channel corresponds to the time slots of an ith time slot position of said time frames, for i=1 to N, and said processor unit assigns a series of segments, which series combine to constitute a given information signal, to the ith time slot of consecutive time frames of the frequency in order to communicate the given information signal to a subscriber unit via the ith TDM channel of the frequency.
17. The system of claim 15 further comprising:
(c) a multiplexer for multiplexing said assigned segments into a series corresponding to said assigned time slots; and
(d) an information signal buffer unit for providing information signals in segments of a selected size to said multiplexer corresponding said assigned time slots.
18. The system of claim 15 wherein said processor assigns segments of information signals intended for different subscriber units to different time slots of a designated TDM channel.
19. The system of claim 15 wherein said processor assigns time slots of consecutive time frames for each segment of a given information signal.
20. The system of claim 15 further comprising:
(c) a receiver for receiving signals on reception frequencies, wherein each frequency used for transmission has an associated frequency used for reception such that received signals on each respective reception frequency have time frames having the same predetermined number of time slots as signals transmitted on said associated frequency.
21. The system of claim 20 wherein each frequency used for transmission is different from said associated frequency used for reception and is separated therefrom by approximately 5 MHz.
22. The system of claim 15 wherein said information signals include voice information signals, said system further comprising:
(c) a voice coder unit for compressing said voice information signals into compressed voice information signals, wherein said processor assigns time slots for segments of said compressed voice information signals output by said voice coder unit.
23. The system of claim 15 wherein said information signals include command information signals, and said processor makes time slot assignments for segments of said command information signals to a TDM channel designated as a radio control channel (RCC) for said subscriber units.
24. The system of claim 15 wherein said processor allocates and deallocates time slot positions of frequency time frames by consulting said memory to dynamically define TDM channels.
25. The system of claim 24 wherein at least one frequency has time frames which each have four time slots and wherein said processor allocates either one or two time slots per time frame for the frequency's TDM channels such that the processor allocates for the frequency a maximum of four TDM channels, each corresponding to the time slots of a respective first, second, third or fourth time slot position of each of the frequency's time frame and a minimum of two TDM channels, one corresponding to the time slots of first and second time slot positions of the frequency's time frames and the other corresponding to the time slots of third and fourth time slot positions of the frequency's time frames.
26. A communication system which wirelessly transmits multiple information signals between one or more base stations and a plurality of subscriber units, said system comprising:
(a) a transmitter for transmitting information signals from an originating source to at least one of said subscriber units in selected time slots of time frames of assigned frequencies, wherein the time frames for each frequency have a predetermined position in the time frame, and channels are defined by a group of time slots having the same relative position in each of a frequency's time frames; and
(b) a processor which (i) assigns time slots for segments of each information signal being sent to a subscriber unit such that segments of a particular information signal are assigned to the time slots of a selected channel, (ii) maintains information in a memory indicating which time slot positions in the time frames of each frequency are allocated to which channels, and (iii) provides a time slot assignment signal to complete a communication connection based on said predetermined positions in said memory.
27. In a communication system which wirelessly transmits multiple information signals between one or more base stations and a plurality of subscriber units, a method comprising:
(a) transmitting information signals from an originating source to at least one of said subscriber units over a channel including a plurality of time frames, each time frame including a plurality of time slots;
(b) assigning a duration of time for said information signals, wherein said duration equals the duration of at least one of said time slots;
(c) maintaining a memory of assigned time slots in said channel; and
(d) providing a time slot assignment signal to complete a communication connection based on said assigned time slots in said memory.
28. The method of claim 27 wherein a designated time frame includes other information signals from other originating sources that are assigned to time slots other than said at least one of said time slots.
29. The method of claim 27 wherein said information signals include data information.
30. The method of claim 27 wherein said information signals include voice information.
31. The method of claim 30 wherein said voice information signals have a predetermined bit processing rate.
32. The method of claim 27 wherein said processor assigns information signals having respective different bit processing rates to time slots in a designated time frame.
33. The method of claim 27 wherein said information signals are communicated over said channel by modulating said information signals onto one of a plurality of frequencies assigned to said channel.
34. The method of claim 33 further comprising:
(e) modulating said information signals onto said one frequency, and for modulating different information signals having respective different modulation types, wherein said processor assigns information signals having respective different modulation types to said at least one of said time slots.
35. The method of claim 34 wherein said modulated information signals are transmitted at a rate of at least two bits per symbol.
36. The method of claim 34 wherein a first modulation type comprises phase shift keying (PSK) modulation.
37. The method of claim 27 further comprising:
(e) receiving reverse information signals from an originating one of said subscriber units to a destination over a reverse channel at an assigned frequency, said reverse information signal being present on at least one time slot within a designated time frame.
38. The method of claim 27 wherein at least one of said subscriber units is a mobile subscriber unit.
39. The method of claim 27 further comprising:
(e) multiplexing said information signals onto said channel.
40. In a communication system which wirelessly transmits multiple information signals between one or more base stations and a plurality of subscriber units, a method comprising:
(a) transmitting information signals from an originating source to at least one of said subscriber units over a time division multiplex (TDM) channel including a plurality of time frames, each time frame including a predetermined number of time slots, each time slot having a predetermined position in the time frame;
(b) assigning segments of each of said information signals to said time slots of said TDM channel;
(c) maintaining a memory of the predetermined positions of assigned time slots in said TDM channel; and
(d) providing a time slot assignment signal to complete a communication connection based on said predetermined positions in said memory.
41. The method of claim 40 wherein a frequency assigned to said channel has N time slots per time frame where N is at least four and N TDM channels are assigned to said at least one frequency such that an ith TDM channel corresponds to the time slots of an ith time slot position of said time frames, for i=1 to N, and said processor unit assigns a series of segments, which series combine to constitute a given information signal, to the ith time slot of consecutive time frames of the frequency in order to communicate the given information signal to a subscriber unit via the ith TDM channel of the frequency.
42. The method of claim 40 further comprising:
(e) multiplexing said assigned segments into a series corresponding to said assigned time slots; and
(f) providing information signals in segments of a selected size to said multiplexer corresponding said assigned time slots.
43. The method of claim 40 wherein segments of information signals intended for different subscriber units are assigned to different time slots of a designated TDM channel.
44. The method of claim 40 wherein time slots of consecutive time frames are assigned for each segment of a given information signal.
45. The method of claim 40 further comprising:
(e) receiving signals on reception frequencies, wherein each frequency used for transmission has an associated frequency used for reception such that received signals on each respective reception frequency have time frames having the same predetermined number of time slots as signals transmitted on said associated frequency.
46. The method of claim 45 wherein each frequency used for transmission is different from said associated frequency used for reception and is separated therefrom by approximately 5 MHz.
47. The method of claim 40 wherein said information signals include voice information signals, said method further comprising:
(e) compressing said voice information signals into compressed voice information signals; and
(f) assigning time slots for segments of said compressed voice information signals.
48. The method of claim 40 wherein said information signals include command information signals, the method further comprising:
(e) assigning time slots for segments of said command information signals to a TDM channel designated as a radio control channel (RCC) for said subscriber units.
49. The method of claim 40 further comprising:
(e) allocating and deallocating time slot positions of frequency time frames by accessing said memory to dynamically define TDM channels.
50. The method of 49 wherein at least one frequency has time frames which each have four time slots, the method further comprising:
(f) allocating either one or two time slots per time frame for the frequency's TDM channels such the frequency is allocated a maximum of four TDM channels, each corresponding to the time slots of a respective first, second, third or fourth time slot position of each of the frequency's time frame and a minimum of two TDM channels, one corresponding to the time slots of first and second time slot positions of the frequency's time frames and the other corresponding to the time slots of third and fourth time slot positions of the frequency's time frames.
51. In a communication system which wirelessly transmits multiple information signals between one or more base stations and a plurality of subscriber units, a method comprising:
(a) transmitting information signals from an originating source to at least one of said subscriber units in selected time slots of time frames of assigned frequencies, wherein the time frames for each frequency have a predetermined position in the time frame, and channels are defined by a group of time slots having the same relative position in each of a frequency's time frames;
(b) assigning time slots for segments of each information signal being sent to a subscriber unit such that segments of a particular information signal are assigned to the time slots of a selected channel;
(c) maintaining information in a memory indicating which time slot positions in the time frames of each frequency are allocated to which channels; and
(d) providing a time slot assignment signal to complete a communication connection based on said predetermined positions in said memory.
Priority Applications (1)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US10/922,427 US20050018636A1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2004-08-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
Applications Claiming Priority (12)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US06/713,925 US4675863A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1985-03-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US07031045 US4817089B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1987-03-27 | Subscriber rf telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of rf channels |
US07/324,651 US4912705A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1989-03-16 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US07349301 US5022024B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1989-05-08 | Subscriber rf telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a signal or a plurality of rf channels |
US07/634,770 US5119375A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1990-12-27 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US83119892A | 1992-01-31 | 1992-01-31 | |
US08/724,930 US5734678A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1996-10-02 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US08/926,405 US6014374A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1997-09-09 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US09/433,430 US6282180B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1999-11-04 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US09/923,171 US6393002B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2001-08-06 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/132,670 US6842440B2 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2002-04-25 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/922,427 US20050018636A1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2004-08-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US10/132,670 Continuation US6842440B2 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2002-04-25 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20050018636A1 true US20050018636A1 (en) | 2005-01-27 |
Family
ID=24868102
Family Applications (19)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US06/713,925 Expired - Lifetime US4675863A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1985-03-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US07031045 Expired - Lifetime US4817089B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1987-03-27 | Subscriber rf telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of rf channels |
US07/324,651 Expired - Lifetime US4912705A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1989-03-16 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US07349301 Expired - Lifetime US5022024B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1989-05-08 | Subscriber rf telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a signal or a plurality of rf channels |
US07/439,100 Expired - Lifetime US5121391A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1989-11-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data singals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US07/634,770 Expired - Lifetime US5119375A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1990-12-27 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US08/051,762 Expired - Lifetime US5687194A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1993-04-22 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US08/052,013 Expired - Lifetime US5657358A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1993-04-22 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or plurality of RF channels |
US08/724,930 Expired - Fee Related US5734678A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1996-10-02 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US08/926,405 Expired - Fee Related US6014374A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1997-09-09 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US09/433,430 Expired - Fee Related US6282180B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1999-11-04 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US09/923,171 Expired - Fee Related US6393002B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2001-08-06 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/132,670 Expired - Fee Related US6842440B2 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2002-04-25 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/145,551 Expired - Fee Related US6954470B2 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2002-05-14 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/374,208 Expired - Fee Related US6771667B2 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2003-02-26 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/922,427 Abandoned US20050018636A1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2004-08-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/923,285 Abandoned US20050025094A1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2004-08-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/922,361 Abandoned US20050025101A1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2004-08-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/925,027 Abandoned US20050025097A1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2004-08-24 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
Family Applications Before (15)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US06/713,925 Expired - Lifetime US4675863A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1985-03-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US07031045 Expired - Lifetime US4817089B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1987-03-27 | Subscriber rf telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of rf channels |
US07/324,651 Expired - Lifetime US4912705A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1989-03-16 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US07349301 Expired - Lifetime US5022024B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1989-05-08 | Subscriber rf telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a signal or a plurality of rf channels |
US07/439,100 Expired - Lifetime US5121391A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1989-11-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data singals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US07/634,770 Expired - Lifetime US5119375A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1990-12-27 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US08/051,762 Expired - Lifetime US5687194A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1993-04-22 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US08/052,013 Expired - Lifetime US5657358A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1993-04-22 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or plurality of RF channels |
US08/724,930 Expired - Fee Related US5734678A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1996-10-02 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US08/926,405 Expired - Fee Related US6014374A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1997-09-09 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US09/433,430 Expired - Fee Related US6282180B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1999-11-04 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US09/923,171 Expired - Fee Related US6393002B1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2001-08-06 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/132,670 Expired - Fee Related US6842440B2 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2002-04-25 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/145,551 Expired - Fee Related US6954470B2 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2002-05-14 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/374,208 Expired - Fee Related US6771667B2 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2003-02-26 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
Family Applications After (3)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US10/923,285 Abandoned US20050025094A1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2004-08-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/922,361 Abandoned US20050025101A1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2004-08-20 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US10/925,027 Abandoned US20050025097A1 (en) | 1985-03-20 | 2004-08-24 | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
Country Status (27)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (19) | US4675863A (en) |
JP (6) | JP2816349B2 (en) |
KR (1) | KR900007130B1 (en) |
CN (1) | CN1008962B (en) |
AT (1) | AT404202B (en) |
AU (2) | AU576627B2 (en) |
BE (1) | BE904065A (en) |
BR (1) | BR8505598A (en) |
CA (1) | CA1250673A (en) |
CH (1) | CH675333A5 (en) |
DE (4) | DE3645360C2 (en) |
DK (4) | DK171304B1 (en) |
ES (1) | ES8707831A1 (en) |
FI (2) | FI81940B (en) |
FR (1) | FR2579391B1 (en) |
GB (1) | GB2174571C (en) |
HK (1) | HK390A (en) |
IE (1) | IE56780B1 (en) |
IL (1) | IL76618A (en) |
IN (1) | IN165724B (en) |
IT (1) | IT1191300B (en) |
MX (1) | MX162175A (en) |
MY (2) | MY100722A (en) |
NL (1) | NL195021C (en) |
NO (3) | NO854603L (en) |
SE (4) | SE506944C2 (en) |
SG (1) | SG64989G (en) |
Cited By (4)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20080045153A1 (en) * | 2006-06-05 | 2008-02-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for providing beamforming feedback in wireless communication systems |
US20080316978A1 (en) * | 2007-06-19 | 2008-12-25 | Levi Ronen | Transmit and receive transition accelerator |
US20090171658A1 (en) * | 2007-12-26 | 2009-07-02 | Maor Margalit | Selection of speech encoding scheme in wireless communication terminals |
WO2022256916A1 (en) * | 2021-06-07 | 2022-12-15 | Lakhani Abdul Karim | Full duplex wireless communication system with single master clock |
Families Citing this family (815)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US4837827A (en) * | 1984-06-29 | 1989-06-06 | Siemens Aktiengesellschaft | Method for transmitting two independent types of information and device for implementing the method |
US4697281A (en) | 1986-03-14 | 1987-09-29 | Spectrum Cellular Communications Corporation, Inc. | Cellular telephone data communication system and method |
US4713808A (en) * | 1985-11-27 | 1987-12-15 | A T & E Corporation | Watch pager system and communication protocol |
US4675863A (en) | 1985-03-20 | 1987-06-23 | International Mobile Machines Corp. | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
SE448199B (en) * | 1985-05-09 | 1987-01-26 | Ericsson Telefon Ab L M | INSTALLATION WITH MULTIPLE BERBARA, CORDLESS PHONE DEVICES |
US4788711A (en) * | 1985-11-25 | 1988-11-29 | Cellular Communications Corporation | Apparatus and method for a cellular freeway emergency telephone service |
JP2713883B2 (en) * | 1986-02-07 | 1998-02-16 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Time division switch |
EP0239293A3 (en) * | 1986-03-24 | 1988-12-14 | Gpt Limited | Data transmission systems |
US4754450A (en) * | 1986-03-25 | 1988-06-28 | Motorola, Inc. | TDM communication system for efficient spectrum utilization |
US4742514A (en) * | 1986-03-25 | 1988-05-03 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and apparatus for controlling a TDM communication device |
JPH0622344B2 (en) * | 1986-07-26 | 1994-03-23 | 日本電気株式会社 | Mobile communication system |
US4825448A (en) * | 1986-08-07 | 1989-04-25 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Subscriber unit for wireless digital telephone system |
US4777646A (en) * | 1986-10-01 | 1988-10-11 | Harris Arlene J | Communication system |
US4779262A (en) * | 1986-10-21 | 1988-10-18 | International Mobile Machines Corp. | Connection of subscriber communication network base station to external information network |
US4777633A (en) * | 1987-08-14 | 1988-10-11 | International Mobile Machines Corp. | Base station for wireless digital telephone system |
US4914686A (en) * | 1986-11-28 | 1990-04-03 | Hagar Iii William G | Cordless phone data logger |
US4837858A (en) * | 1987-04-30 | 1989-06-06 | Motorola, Inc. | Subscriber unit for a trunked voice/data communication system |
US4885799A (en) * | 1987-07-01 | 1989-12-05 | Motorola, Inc. | Load pull isolation switch for a fast locking synthesizer |
US4811420A (en) * | 1987-07-08 | 1989-03-07 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Initialization of communication channel between a subsciber station and a base station in a subscriber communication system |
FR2645690B1 (en) * | 1987-07-08 | 1997-12-19 | Int Mobile Machines | DEVICE FOR INITIALIZING A COMMUNICATION CHANNEL BETWEEN A SUBSCRIBER STATION AND A BASE STATION IN A COMMUNICATION SYSTEM |
BE1004074A3 (en) * | 1987-07-08 | 1992-09-22 | Internat Mobile Machines Corp | System for initialising a communication channel between a subscriber stationand a base station in a communication system |
BE1004075A3 (en) * | 1987-07-08 | 1992-09-22 | Internat Mobile Machines Corp | System for initialising communication between subscriber station - uses radio channel to establish communication prior to use of main communication channel |
FR2645691B1 (en) * | 1987-07-08 | 1994-10-21 | Int Mobile Machines | DEVICE FOR INITIALIZING A COMMUNICATION CHANNEL BETWEEN A SUBSCRIBER STATION AND A BASE STATION IN A COMMUNICATION SYSTEM |
US4785450B1 (en) * | 1987-08-06 | 1999-10-12 | Interdigital Tech Corp | Apparatus and method for obtaining frequency agility in digital communication system |
US7106819B1 (en) * | 1987-11-20 | 2006-09-12 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Plural subscriber system utilizing synchronized timeslots on a single frequency |
US5930297A (en) * | 1989-11-20 | 1999-07-27 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Base station emulator |
US5495508A (en) * | 1987-11-20 | 1996-02-27 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Base station emulator |
US4935927A (en) * | 1987-11-20 | 1990-06-19 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Base station emulator |
US4821310A (en) * | 1987-12-22 | 1989-04-11 | Motorola, Inc. | Transmission trunked radio system with voice buffering and off-line dialing |
US4928274A (en) * | 1988-01-19 | 1990-05-22 | Qualcomm, Inc. | Multiplexed address control in a TDM communication system |
US4979170A (en) * | 1988-01-19 | 1990-12-18 | Qualcomm, Inc. | Alternating sequential half duplex communication system |
SE460449B (en) * | 1988-02-29 | 1989-10-09 | Ericsson Telefon Ab L M | CELL DIVIDED DIGITAL MOBILE RADIO SYSTEM AND PROCEDURE TO TRANSFER INFORMATION IN A DIGITAL CELL DIVIDED MOBILE RADIO SYSTEM |
USRE37754E1 (en) * | 1988-02-29 | 2002-06-18 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Cellular digital mobile radio system and method of transmitting information in a digital cellular mobile radio system |
DE3814355A1 (en) * | 1988-04-28 | 1989-11-09 | Philips Patentverwaltung | MESSAGE TRANSFER SYSTEM |
SE8802229D0 (en) * | 1988-06-14 | 1988-06-14 | Ericsson Telefon Ab L M | MOBILE RADIO STATION PROCEDURE |
US20010050943A1 (en) * | 1989-08-03 | 2001-12-13 | Mahany Ronald L. | Radio frequency communication network having adaptive communication parameters |
US7606575B2 (en) * | 1988-08-04 | 2009-10-20 | Broadcom Corporation | Remote radio data communication system with data rate switching |
CA1317638C (en) * | 1988-09-09 | 1993-05-11 | Stephen B. Meads | Mobile pay telephone system |
GR1000657B (en) * | 1988-10-14 | 1992-09-25 | Int Mobile Machines | Communication system |
FR2638307B1 (en) * | 1988-10-21 | 1994-06-10 | Cit Alcatel | SWITCHING CENTER FOR RADIOMOBILE APPLICATION |
DE3845015B4 (en) * | 1988-11-07 | 2006-08-31 | Interdigital Technology Corporation, Wilmington | Wireless digital telephone communications system - has subscriber of each pair of dual subscribers separately assignable to adjacent slots in selected frequency channel |
US5276685A (en) * | 1988-11-30 | 1994-01-04 | Motorola, Inc. | Digital automatic gain control |
US4953197A (en) * | 1988-12-08 | 1990-08-28 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Combination spatial diversity system |
GB8829661D0 (en) * | 1988-12-20 | 1989-02-15 | Shaye Communications Ltd | Duplex communications systems |
US4972839A (en) * | 1988-12-22 | 1990-11-27 | Angelsen Bjorn A J | Miniaturized mechanically-steerable ultrasonic probe |
DE3843565A1 (en) * | 1988-12-23 | 1990-06-28 | Standard Elektrik Lorenz Ag | RADIO TELEPHONE SYSTEM IN THE FORM OF A PABX |
US5025442A (en) * | 1989-01-23 | 1991-06-18 | Motorola, Inc. | TDM/FDM communication system with pseudo-duplex capability |
US5038342A (en) * | 1989-01-23 | 1991-08-06 | Motorola, Inc. | TDM/FDM communication system supporting both TDM and FDM-only communication units |
US4942570A (en) * | 1989-01-23 | 1990-07-17 | Motorola, Inc. | Multiple control slot TDM/FDM communication system |
GB2227393A (en) * | 1989-01-24 | 1990-07-25 | Marconi Gec Ltd | Communication arrangement |
GB8907317D0 (en) * | 1989-03-31 | 1989-05-17 | Plessey Telecomm | Communications systems |
US5127100A (en) * | 1989-04-27 | 1992-06-30 | Motorola, Inc. | Digital radio communication system and two way radio |
US5109392A (en) * | 1989-05-11 | 1992-04-28 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Inc. | Diversity receiver arrangement for digital signals |
US5128981A (en) * | 1989-05-24 | 1992-07-07 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Radio communication system and a portable wireless terminal |
JPH02308694A (en) * | 1989-05-24 | 1990-12-21 | Hitachi Ltd | Radio communication system |
EP0427871B1 (en) * | 1989-05-30 | 1996-03-20 | Fujitsu Limited | Inter-network connection system |
US4974099A (en) * | 1989-06-21 | 1990-11-27 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Communication signal compression system and method |
US5200957A (en) * | 1989-06-26 | 1993-04-06 | Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson | Mobile assisted handoff |
US6243446B1 (en) * | 1997-03-11 | 2001-06-05 | Inline Connections Corporation | Distributed splitter for data transmission over twisted wire pairs |
US5010399A (en) * | 1989-07-14 | 1991-04-23 | Inline Connection Corporation | Video transmission and control system utilizing internal telephone lines |
US5793843A (en) * | 1989-10-31 | 1998-08-11 | Intelligence Technology Corporation | Method and apparatus for transmission of data and voice |
EP0450062A4 (en) * | 1989-10-31 | 1992-09-23 | Intelligence Technology Corporation | Data and voice transmission over a cellular telephone system |
SE464955B (en) * | 1989-11-03 | 1991-07-01 | Ericsson Telefon Ab L M | PROCEDURE TO CLASSIFY A FRAMEWORK STRUCTURE IN A MOBILE STATION |
JPH03158040A (en) * | 1989-11-16 | 1991-07-08 | Fujitsu Ltd | data transformer |
US6389010B1 (en) * | 1995-10-05 | 2002-05-14 | Intermec Ip Corp. | Hierarchical data collection network supporting packetized voice communications among wireless terminals and telephones |
US5001742A (en) * | 1990-01-29 | 1991-03-19 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Baseband signal processing unit and method of operating the same |
US5170266A (en) * | 1990-02-20 | 1992-12-08 | Document Technologies, Inc. | Multi-capability facsimile system |
US5228029A (en) * | 1990-02-27 | 1993-07-13 | Motorola, Inc. | Cellular tdm communication system employing offset frame synchronization |
US5166973A (en) * | 1990-03-06 | 1992-11-24 | Seiko Corp. | Radio paging system with local local loop |
US5249174A (en) * | 1990-03-06 | 1993-09-28 | Iwatsu Electric Co., Ltd. | Time-division communication method for mobile bodies and system using said method |
AU7699391A (en) * | 1990-04-09 | 1991-10-30 | Richard Kollin | System for searching and retrieving data from data bases via audio access with automatic faxing of results |
US5014314A (en) * | 1990-04-27 | 1991-05-07 | Motorola, Inc. | Method for developing and transmitting usage context information in an RF communication system |
US5260987A (en) * | 1990-06-18 | 1993-11-09 | Northern Telecom Limited | Mobile communications |
GB9013605D0 (en) * | 1990-06-18 | 1990-08-08 | Stc Plc | Mobile communications |
GB2245454B (en) * | 1990-06-18 | 1994-03-23 | Stc Plc | Mobile communications |
DE4019890A1 (en) * | 1990-06-22 | 1992-01-02 | Kurt Biller | Radio taxi communication method for direct ordering and confirmation - using digital data link between customer and vehicle terminals with transactions recorded for future billing |
JP3093243B2 (en) * | 1990-07-12 | 2000-10-03 | 株式会社東芝 | Mobile radio communication system |
US5111454A (en) * | 1990-08-16 | 1992-05-05 | Motorola, Inc. | Digital cellular tdm system employing 6:1 packing of transcoded information |
US5170490A (en) * | 1990-09-28 | 1992-12-08 | Motorola, Inc. | Radio functions due to voice compression |
US5371780A (en) * | 1990-10-01 | 1994-12-06 | At&T Corp. | Communications resource assignment in a wireless telecommunications system |
US5384826A (en) * | 1990-10-01 | 1995-01-24 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Distributed packetized switching cellular radio telephone communication system with handoff |
IL95990A (en) * | 1990-10-15 | 1994-07-31 | B V R Technologies Ltd | Anti-collision warning system |
US5283780A (en) * | 1990-10-18 | 1994-02-01 | Stanford Telecommunications, Inc. | Digital audio broadcasting system |
CA2094710C (en) * | 1990-10-23 | 1998-12-01 | Robert Clyde Dixon | Method and apparatus for establishing spread spectrum communications |
US5159625A (en) * | 1990-10-24 | 1992-10-27 | Gte Mobile Communications Service Corp. | Method of selecting the cellular system with which a cellular mobile radiotelephone communicates |
US5144649A (en) * | 1990-10-24 | 1992-09-01 | Gte Mobile Communications Service Corporation | Cellular radiotelephone credit card paystation method |
US5247564A (en) * | 1990-10-24 | 1993-09-21 | Gte Mobile Communications Service Corp. | Adaptive vehicle alarm detection and reporting system |
US5128928A (en) * | 1990-10-31 | 1992-07-07 | Rose Communications, Inc. | Digital radio telephone system |
US5307348A (en) * | 1990-11-05 | 1994-04-26 | Motorola, Inc. | Scheduling in a communication system |
US5703881A (en) * | 1990-12-06 | 1997-12-30 | Hughes Electronics | Multi-subscriber unit for radio communication system and method |
US5299198A (en) * | 1990-12-06 | 1994-03-29 | Hughes Aircraft Company | Method and apparatus for exploitation of voice inactivity to increase the capacity of a time division multiple access radio communications system |
US5633873A (en) * | 1990-12-06 | 1997-05-27 | Hughes Electronics | Combined fixed and mobile radio communication system and method |
US5297144A (en) * | 1991-01-22 | 1994-03-22 | Spectrix Corporation | Reservation-based polling protocol for a wireless data communications network |
SE467856B (en) * | 1991-01-31 | 1992-09-21 | Ericsson Telefon Ab L M | TRANSCODER FOR A MOBILE RADIO SYSTEM |
GB2254971B (en) * | 1991-03-07 | 1994-12-21 | Ericsson Telefon Ab L M | Mobile radio communications stations |
JPH04287462A (en) * | 1991-03-18 | 1992-10-13 | Fujitsu Ltd | Cordless telephone set and cordless telephone system provided with the same |
CA2063901C (en) * | 1991-03-25 | 2002-08-13 | Arunas G. Slekys | Cellular data overlay system |
IL97671A (en) * | 1991-03-25 | 1994-11-11 | Constanza 330 Ltd | Method and apparatus for broadcasting and receiving broadcasted information |
US5504936A (en) * | 1991-04-02 | 1996-04-02 | Airtouch Communications Of California | Microcells for digital cellular telephone systems |
DE69231877D1 (en) * | 1991-04-04 | 2001-07-26 | Canon Kk | Wireless transmission device and printer using this device |
US5239167A (en) * | 1991-04-30 | 1993-08-24 | Ludwig Kipp | Checkout system |
USRE38627E1 (en) | 1991-05-15 | 2004-10-19 | Interdigital Technology Corp. | High capacity spread spectrum channel |
US5434798A (en) * | 1991-05-23 | 1995-07-18 | Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericcson | Reconfiguration in a cellular communications network |
JPH04352533A (en) * | 1991-05-30 | 1992-12-07 | Fujitsu Ltd | Packet retransmission method in slotted Aloha satellite communication system |
US5285469A (en) * | 1991-06-03 | 1994-02-08 | Omnipoint Data Corporation | Spread spectrum wireless telephone system |
US7197623B1 (en) * | 1991-06-27 | 2007-03-27 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Multiple processor cellular radio |
US5668880A (en) * | 1991-07-08 | 1997-09-16 | Alajajian; Philip Michael | Inter-vehicle personal data communications device |
CA2066538C (en) * | 1991-07-09 | 1997-12-23 | Brian David Bolliger | Mobile-telephone system call processing arrangement |
US5195090A (en) * | 1991-07-09 | 1993-03-16 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Wireless access telephone-to-telephone network interface architecture |
JPH0529997A (en) * | 1991-07-18 | 1993-02-05 | Iwatsu Electric Co Ltd | Diversity communication method for time division mobile communication |
US5210771A (en) * | 1991-08-01 | 1993-05-11 | Motorola, Inc. | Multiple user spread-spectrum communication system |
US5499032A (en) * | 1992-12-22 | 1996-03-12 | Terrapin Corporation | Navigation and positioning system and method using uncoordinated beacon signals |
JPH0568243A (en) * | 1991-09-09 | 1993-03-19 | Hitachi Ltd | Variable length coding controlling system |
US5745758A (en) * | 1991-09-20 | 1998-04-28 | Shaw; Venson M. | System for regulating multicomputer data transfer by allocating time slot to designated processing task according to communication bandwidth capabilities and modifying time slots when bandwidth change |
US6424989B1 (en) * | 1991-09-20 | 2002-07-23 | Venson M. Shaw | Object-oriented transaction computing system |
US5357559A (en) * | 1991-12-12 | 1994-10-18 | Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson | Listening control channel in a cellular mobile radiotelephone system |
JP3766434B2 (en) * | 1991-12-16 | 2006-04-12 | ザーカム ワイヤレス, インコーポレイテッド | Spread spectrum data transmission system |
CA2089589A1 (en) * | 1992-02-21 | 1993-08-22 | Takayuki Shibata | Transmission signal level control device for radio transmitter |
ZA931077B (en) | 1992-03-05 | 1994-01-04 | Qualcomm Inc | Apparatus and method for reducing message collision between mobile stations simultaneously accessing a base station in a cdma cellular communications system |
US5282204A (en) * | 1992-04-13 | 1994-01-25 | Racotek, Inc. | Apparatus and method for overlaying data on trunked radio |
US5343513A (en) * | 1992-04-20 | 1994-08-30 | Hughes Aircraft Company | Channel compression and dynamic repartitioning for dual mode cellular radio |
US5630152A (en) * | 1992-05-18 | 1997-05-13 | Motorola, Inc. | Communication protocol between master and slave device with register information sharing |
EP0578260B1 (en) * | 1992-07-09 | 1999-10-20 | Nec Corporation | TDMA cellular mobile communciation system |
AU4454993A (en) * | 1992-08-10 | 1994-02-17 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | A radio communication system and a radio base station for use in such a system |
US5999810A (en) * | 1992-08-11 | 1999-12-07 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | Architecture for a wireless telecommunication system |
FI95983C (en) * | 1992-08-17 | 1996-04-10 | Nokia Telecommunications Oy | Arrangement for facsimile transmission in a digital cellular radio network |
FI92894C (en) * | 1992-08-17 | 1995-01-10 | Nokia Telecommunications Oy | Arrangements for streamlining data transmission in a digital cellular radio network |
EP0671110B1 (en) * | 1992-08-26 | 2003-01-02 | Sonera Oyj | Mobile telephone system |
US5289464A (en) * | 1992-09-21 | 1994-02-22 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Frequency-multiplexed cellular telephone cell site base station and method of operating the same |
US5918184A (en) * | 1992-09-21 | 1999-06-29 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | Method and apparatus for detecting a supervisory audio tone |
CA2099738C (en) * | 1992-09-25 | 1999-01-12 | William Keith Cline | Architecture for a wireless telecommunication system |
US5459784A (en) * | 1992-09-28 | 1995-10-17 | Comsat Corporation | Dual-tone multifrequency (DTMF) signalling transparency for low-data-rate vocoders |
US5546443A (en) * | 1992-10-26 | 1996-08-13 | Ericsson Ge Mobile Communications, Inc. | Communication management technique for a radiotelephone system including microcells |
US7064749B1 (en) * | 1992-11-09 | 2006-06-20 | Adc Technology Inc. | Portable communicator |
US5463671A (en) * | 1992-11-16 | 1995-10-31 | Csir | Telecommunications network having a distributed network of decentralized local stations |
DE4240249C1 (en) * | 1992-11-25 | 1994-05-05 | Andreas Hachencerger | Switching device and method for a radio telephony system with the character of a local or branch exchange |
CA2110029C (en) * | 1992-11-27 | 1997-05-06 | Shigeru Otsuka | Mobile radio communication system |
GB2273024B (en) * | 1992-11-28 | 1996-10-09 | Motorola Ltd | A transcoder |
IT1264320B (en) * | 1992-12-01 | 1996-09-23 | SYSTEM FOR AUTOMATICALLY DISTRIBUTING CALLS TO RADIOTAXI | |
US5878209A (en) * | 1992-12-02 | 1999-03-02 | Motorola, Inc. | Apparatus and method for identifying a failed subscriber unit in a wireless communication system |
US5801848A (en) * | 1993-01-06 | 1998-09-01 | Fontech Ltd. | Process for transmitting and/or storing information |
US7082106B2 (en) * | 1993-01-08 | 2006-07-25 | Multi-Tech Systems, Inc. | Computer-based multi-media communications system and method |
CN1040274C (en) * | 1993-01-18 | 1998-10-14 | 李嘉骏 | Wireless broadcast system of literal pattern and data information |
US5396503A (en) * | 1993-02-19 | 1995-03-07 | Hewlett-Packard Company | Method and system for communicating data |
DE69434015D1 (en) * | 1993-02-26 | 2004-10-28 | Toshiba Kawasaki Kk | Room diversity receiver for a digital communication system |
US5412690A (en) * | 1993-03-08 | 1995-05-02 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and apparatus for receiving electromagnetic radiation within a frequency band |
US6330334B1 (en) | 1993-03-15 | 2001-12-11 | Command Audio Corporation | Method and system for information dissemination using television signals |
US5448570A (en) * | 1993-03-17 | 1995-09-05 | Kyocera Corporation | System for mutual synchronization and monitoring between base stations |
JPH0738613B2 (en) * | 1993-03-30 | 1995-04-26 | 日本電気株式会社 | Complex data communication system and device used for this system |
US5365590A (en) * | 1993-04-19 | 1994-11-15 | Ericsson Ge Mobile Communications Inc. | System for providing access to digitally encoded communications in a distributed switching network |
JPH0828907B2 (en) * | 1993-05-10 | 1996-03-21 | 日本電気株式会社 | Call path control method in mobile communication system |
US7924783B1 (en) | 1994-05-06 | 2011-04-12 | Broadcom Corporation | Hierarchical communications system |
US6970434B1 (en) * | 1995-06-07 | 2005-11-29 | Broadcom Corporation | Hierarchical communication system providing intelligent data, program and processing migration |
JPH09501280A (en) * | 1993-05-20 | 1997-02-04 | マツシタ アビオニクス システムズ コーポレーシヨン | Integrated video and audio signal distribution system for commercial aircraft and other vehicles. |
GB2282736B (en) * | 1993-05-28 | 1996-12-11 | Nec Corp | Radio base station for a mobile communications system |
US5602880A (en) * | 1993-06-02 | 1997-02-11 | Alcatel Network Systems | Method and system for minimizing resynchronization delays in digital microwave radio systems |
DE4329010A1 (en) * | 1993-08-28 | 1995-03-02 | Sel Alcatel Ag | Radio system |
US5619550A (en) * | 1993-09-23 | 1997-04-08 | Motorola, Inc. | Testing within communication systems using an arq protocol |
US5546383A (en) | 1993-09-30 | 1996-08-13 | Cooley; David M. | Modularly clustered radiotelephone system |
US6021333A (en) * | 1993-11-01 | 2000-02-01 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and system for transferring information within a mobile communication system |
US6088590A (en) | 1993-11-01 | 2000-07-11 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and system for mobile controlled handoff and link maintenance in spread spectrum communication |
US6094575A (en) * | 1993-11-01 | 2000-07-25 | Omnipoint Corporation | Communication system and method |
US6005856A (en) * | 1993-11-01 | 1999-12-21 | Omnipoint Corporation | Communication protocol for spread spectrum wireless communication system |
ZA948428B (en) * | 1993-11-15 | 1995-06-30 | Qualcomm Inc | Method for providing a voice request in a wireless environment |
US5487175A (en) * | 1993-11-15 | 1996-01-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method of invoking and canceling voice or data service from a mobile unit |
US5586150A (en) * | 1993-11-24 | 1996-12-17 | Rajupandaram K. Balasubramaniam | Method and apparatus for symbol synchronization in multi-level digital FM radio |
US5721762A (en) * | 1993-12-01 | 1998-02-24 | Sharp Microelectronics Technology, Inc. | Shared base stations for voice and data cellular telecommunications and method |
US5475735A (en) * | 1993-12-02 | 1995-12-12 | Motorola, Inc. | Method of providing wireless local loop operation with local mobility for a subscribed unit |
US5471655A (en) * | 1993-12-03 | 1995-11-28 | Nokia Mobile Phones Ltd. | Method and apparatus for operating a radiotelephone in an extended stand-by mode of operation for conserving battery power |
JPH07170288A (en) * | 1993-12-15 | 1995-07-04 | Hitachi Ltd | Voice communication system and voice communication method |
US5761621A (en) | 1993-12-15 | 1998-06-02 | Spectrum Information Technologies, Inc. | Apparatus and methods for networking omni-modal radio devices |
US6934558B1 (en) * | 1993-12-15 | 2005-08-23 | Mlr, Llc | Adaptive omni-modal radio apparatus and methods |
US5440544A (en) * | 1993-12-27 | 1995-08-08 | General Electric Company | Integrated data link concept for air traffic control applications |
US6157811A (en) * | 1994-01-11 | 2000-12-05 | Ericsson Inc. | Cellular/satellite communications system with improved frequency re-use |
US5619503A (en) * | 1994-01-11 | 1997-04-08 | Ericsson Inc. | Cellular/satellite communications system with improved frequency re-use |
US5519640A (en) * | 1994-01-26 | 1996-05-21 | Hughes Aircraft Company | Multimedia frame relay codec |
CN1139988A (en) * | 1994-02-01 | 1997-01-08 | 夸尔柯姆股份有限公司 | Burst excited linear prediction |
US5465269A (en) * | 1994-02-02 | 1995-11-07 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and apparatus for encoding and decoding a supplementary signal |
US5574773A (en) * | 1994-02-22 | 1996-11-12 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus of providing audio feedback over a digital channel |
US5606581A (en) * | 1994-03-17 | 1997-02-25 | Myers; Glen A. | Method and apparatus for the cancellation of interference in electrical systems |
FR2717969B1 (en) * | 1994-03-22 | 1996-05-31 | Nortel Matra Cellular | Method and equipment for broadcasting messages to mobile radio stations. |
EP0775412A4 (en) * | 1994-03-29 | 1999-03-03 | Walker C Morris | Method and apparatus for transmission of data and voice |
US5430713A (en) * | 1994-05-06 | 1995-07-04 | At&T Corp. | Frequency hopping in digital cellular networks |
US5530702A (en) * | 1994-05-31 | 1996-06-25 | Ludwig Kipp | System for storage and communication of information |
US6418131B1 (en) | 1994-06-17 | 2002-07-09 | Lake Communications Limited | Spectrum monitoring for PSTN subscribers |
US5511067A (en) * | 1994-06-17 | 1996-04-23 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Layered channel element in a base station modem for a CDMA cellular communication system |
US5555258A (en) * | 1994-06-17 | 1996-09-10 | P. Stuckey McIntosh | Home personal communication system |
US6058104A (en) * | 1994-06-17 | 2000-05-02 | Home Wireless Networks, Inc. | Communications webs for PSTN subscribers |
US6404761B1 (en) * | 1994-06-17 | 2002-06-11 | Home Wireless Networks, Inc. | Communications webs with personal communications links for PSTN subscribers |
US5537459A (en) * | 1994-06-17 | 1996-07-16 | Price; Evelyn C. | Multilevel cellular communication system for hospitals |
US5805582B1 (en) * | 1994-06-17 | 1999-11-09 | Home Wireless Networks Inc | Home personal communications system |
US5995515A (en) * | 1994-06-20 | 1999-11-30 | Sony Corporation | Communication system, base station, mobile station, and radio communication system |
US5542115A (en) * | 1994-06-24 | 1996-07-30 | Pioneer Tech Development Limited | Paging method and apparatus |
US5845201A (en) * | 1994-07-01 | 1998-12-01 | Noller Communications, Inc. | Subscriber RF telephone system having distributed channel switching capability |
JP2840028B2 (en) * | 1994-07-11 | 1998-12-24 | 日立電子株式会社 | Wireless telephone system |
US6243399B1 (en) | 1994-07-21 | 2001-06-05 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Ring signal generator |
US6775531B1 (en) * | 1994-07-21 | 2004-08-10 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Subscriber terminal temperature regulation |
WO1996003811A1 (en) | 1994-07-21 | 1996-02-08 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Power consumption control method and apparatus for a communication system subscriber unit |
US5490144A (en) * | 1994-07-29 | 1996-02-06 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and system for efficiently optimizing throughput and minimizing delay for a channel in a communication system |
US5517504A (en) * | 1994-07-29 | 1996-05-14 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and system for providing uplink/downlink collision avoidance in a wireless communication system |
AU3326695A (en) * | 1994-08-15 | 1996-03-07 | Ken Bailey | Cellular telephone credit card billing system |
US5541978A (en) * | 1994-08-18 | 1996-07-30 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson | Method and system for implementing a backup digital control channel within a cellular telecommunications network |
US5614914A (en) | 1994-09-06 | 1997-03-25 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Wireless telephone distribution system with time and space diversity transmission for determining receiver location |
US5629956A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1997-05-13 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and apparatus for reception and noncoherent serial correlation of a continuous phase modulated signal |
US5754585A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1998-05-19 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and apparatus for serial noncoherent correlation of a spread spectrum signal |
US5610940A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1997-03-11 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and apparatus for noncoherent reception and correlation of a continous phase modulated signal |
US5856998A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1999-01-05 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and apparatus for correlating a continuous phase modulated spread spectrum signal |
US5881100A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1999-03-09 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and apparatus for coherent correlation of a spread spectrum signal |
US5659574A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1997-08-19 | Omnipoint Corporation | Multi-bit correlation of continuous phase modulated signals |
US5692007A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1997-11-25 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and apparatus for differential phase encoding and decoding in spread-spectrum communication systems with continuous-phase modulation |
US5680414A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1997-10-21 | Omnipoint Corporation | Synchronization apparatus and method for spread spectrum receiver |
US5648982A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1997-07-15 | Omnipoint Corporation | Spread spectrum transmitter |
US5754584A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1998-05-19 | Omnipoint Corporation | Non-coherent spread-spectrum continuous-phase modulation communication system |
US5963586A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1999-10-05 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and apparatus for parallel noncoherent correlation of a spread spectrum signal |
US5627856A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1997-05-06 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and apparatus for receiving and despreading a continuous phase-modulated spread spectrum signal using self-synchronizing correlators |
US5832028A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1998-11-03 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and apparatus for coherent serial correlation of a spread spectrum signal |
US5953370A (en) | 1994-09-09 | 1999-09-14 | Omnipoint Corporation | Apparatus for receiving and correlating a spread spectrum signal |
US5757847A (en) * | 1994-09-09 | 1998-05-26 | Omnipoint Corporation | Method and apparatus for decoding a phase encoded signal |
US5606560A (en) * | 1994-09-23 | 1997-02-25 | Motorola, Inc. | Between a base station and a portable device |
US6334219B1 (en) * | 1994-09-26 | 2001-12-25 | Adc Telecommunications Inc. | Channel selection for a hybrid fiber coax network |
US5566173A (en) * | 1994-10-12 | 1996-10-15 | Steinbrecher Corporation | Communication system |
JP2596388B2 (en) * | 1994-10-28 | 1997-04-02 | 日本電気株式会社 | Digital cordless telephone system |
US5742583A (en) | 1994-11-03 | 1998-04-21 | Omnipoint Corporation | Antenna diversity techniques |
SE9403839L (en) | 1994-11-07 | 1996-05-08 | Telia Ab | Device for increasing the speed of a digital mobile telephony system |
US5515366A (en) * | 1994-11-17 | 1996-05-07 | International Business Machines Corporation | Method and apparatus for direct communication in a TDMA radio communication system |
US6889356B1 (en) | 1994-11-23 | 2005-05-03 | Cingular Wireless Ii, Llc | Cyclic trellis coded modulation |
US5675590A (en) * | 1994-11-23 | 1997-10-07 | At&T Wireless Services, Inc. | Cyclic trellis coded modulation |
US5812951A (en) * | 1994-11-23 | 1998-09-22 | Hughes Electronics Corporation | Wireless personal communication system |
US5659578A (en) * | 1994-11-23 | 1997-08-19 | At&T Wireless Services, Inc. | High rate Reed-Solomon concatenated trellis coded 16 star QAM system for transmission of data over cellular mobile radio |
US6006069A (en) * | 1994-11-28 | 1999-12-21 | Bosch Telecom Gmbh | Point-to-multipoint communications system |
US5790527A (en) * | 1994-12-20 | 1998-08-04 | Research Triangle Park | Trunked radio frequency communication system for accommodating both frequency and time division based RF communications |
US5867779A (en) * | 1995-01-05 | 1999-02-02 | Ntt Mobile Communications Network, Inc. | Paging equipment and method for reducing traffic in a mobile data communication system |
US5544223A (en) * | 1995-01-31 | 1996-08-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for paging a concentrated subscriber system for wireless local loop |
US7280564B1 (en) | 1995-02-06 | 2007-10-09 | Adc Telecommunications, Inc. | Synchronization techniques in multipoint-to-point communication using orthgonal frequency division multiplexing |
USRE42236E1 (en) | 1995-02-06 | 2011-03-22 | Adc Telecommunications, Inc. | Multiuse subcarriers in multipoint-to-point communication using orthogonal frequency division multiplexing |
US5513181A (en) * | 1995-02-17 | 1996-04-30 | At&T Corp. | Multi-signal multi-coder transcoder |
US5577056A (en) * | 1995-02-24 | 1996-11-19 | Hughes Aircraft Co. | Method and apparatus for adjusting the postamble false detection probability threshold for a burst transmission |
KR19980702591A (en) * | 1995-02-28 | 1998-07-15 | 다니엘 케이. 니콜스 | Method and apparatus for speech compression in a communication system |
FI950916A (en) * | 1995-02-28 | 1996-08-29 | Nokia Telecommunications Oy | Base station in a radio system |
WO1996028928A1 (en) * | 1995-03-13 | 1996-09-19 | Siemens Aktiengesellschaft | Process and arrangement for the simultaneous transmission of digitally compressed speech and still images |
CA2171485C (en) * | 1995-03-23 | 1999-10-12 | Shrirang Jangi | Dtmf tone passer in a voice communication system |
US5812522A (en) * | 1995-03-31 | 1998-09-22 | Airtouch Communications, Inc. | Location-ruled radio-integrated network |
US6157612A (en) * | 1995-04-03 | 2000-12-05 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | Fast fading packet diversity transmission method and system |
US5943376A (en) * | 1995-04-06 | 1999-08-24 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and system for time aligning a frame in a communication system |
KR0140131B1 (en) * | 1995-04-26 | 1998-07-01 | 김주용 | Selector and Multiple Vocoder Interface Devices and Methods in Mobile Communication Systems |
US5535215A (en) * | 1995-05-01 | 1996-07-09 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and apparatus for providing control channels and message channels in a radio communication system |
AU5257296A (en) * | 1995-05-05 | 1996-11-21 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and system for demodulation of m-ary signaling |
AU5524796A (en) * | 1995-05-05 | 1996-11-21 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and system for demodulation of multi-level pcm |
US5638372A (en) * | 1995-05-08 | 1997-06-10 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson | Providing filler data to transmitters in a radio communication system |
US5959980A (en) * | 1995-06-05 | 1999-09-28 | Omnipoint Corporation | Timing adjustment control for efficient time division duplex communication |
US5745484A (en) * | 1995-06-05 | 1998-04-28 | Omnipoint Corporation | Efficient communication system using time division multiplexing and timing adjustment control |
US5802046A (en) * | 1995-06-05 | 1998-09-01 | Omnipoint Corporation | Efficient time division duplex communication system with interleaved format and timing adjustment control |
US5689502A (en) * | 1995-06-05 | 1997-11-18 | Omnipoint Corporation | Efficient frequency division duplex communication system with interleaved format and timing adjustment control |
SE503648C2 (en) * | 1995-06-12 | 1996-07-22 | Ericsson Telefon Ab L M | Device and method for receiving and demodulating different signal types in a base station |
KR0165210B1 (en) * | 1995-06-26 | 1999-02-01 | 김광호 | Voice Calling Device and Method of Wireless Call Receiver |
US7072380B2 (en) * | 1995-06-30 | 2006-07-04 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Apparatus for initial power control for spread-spectrum communications |
US5918171A (en) * | 1995-06-30 | 1999-06-29 | Nusantara Communications Inc. | Subscriber RF telephone system having distributed channel switching capability |
US7929498B2 (en) | 1995-06-30 | 2011-04-19 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Adaptive forward power control and adaptive reverse power control for spread-spectrum communications |
US7020111B2 (en) | 1996-06-27 | 2006-03-28 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | System for using rapid acquisition spreading codes for spread-spectrum communications |
US7123600B2 (en) | 1995-06-30 | 2006-10-17 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Initial power control for spread-spectrum communications |
ZA965340B (en) | 1995-06-30 | 1997-01-27 | Interdigital Tech Corp | Code division multiple access (cdma) communication system |
US6885652B1 (en) | 1995-06-30 | 2005-04-26 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Code division multiple access (CDMA) communication system |
US6041046A (en) * | 1995-07-14 | 2000-03-21 | Omnipoint Corporation | Cyclic time hopping in time division multiple access communication system |
US5768268A (en) * | 1995-07-19 | 1998-06-16 | Watkins Johnson Company | Wideband base station architecture for digital cellular communications system |
US5812390A (en) * | 1995-07-28 | 1998-09-22 | Dell Usa, L.P. | Apparatus and method for message variable reordering |
JP2954000B2 (en) * | 1995-08-21 | 1999-09-27 | 日本電気通信システム株式会社 | Mobile communication system |
US5675629A (en) * | 1995-09-08 | 1997-10-07 | At&T | Cordless cellular system base station |
US5911120A (en) | 1995-09-08 | 1999-06-08 | At&T Wireless Services | Wireless communication system having mobile stations establish a communication link through the base station without using a landline or regional cellular network and without a call in progress |
US6108704A (en) | 1995-09-25 | 2000-08-22 | Netspeak Corporation | Point-to-point internet protocol |
US5857153A (en) * | 1995-10-13 | 1999-01-05 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Cellular telecommunications network having seamless interoperability between exchanges while providing voice, asynchronous data and facsimile services in multiple frequency hyperbands |
US5751731A (en) * | 1995-10-18 | 1998-05-12 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson | Simplifying decoding of codewords in a wireless communication system |
US6522867B1 (en) | 1995-11-14 | 2003-02-18 | Harris Corporation | Wireless, frequency-agile spread spectrum ground link-based aircraft data communication system with wireless unit in communication therewith |
US6047165A (en) | 1995-11-14 | 2000-04-04 | Harris Corporation | Wireless, frequency-agile spread spectrum ground link-based aircraft data communication system |
KR100485459B1 (en) * | 1995-12-01 | 2005-08-31 | 코닌클리케 필립스 일렉트로닉스 엔.브이. | Wireless telephone systems, including digital wireless telephone systems, wireless base stations, and wireless base stations and wireless handsets. |
US5956674A (en) * | 1995-12-01 | 1999-09-21 | Digital Theater Systems, Inc. | Multi-channel predictive subband audio coder using psychoacoustic adaptive bit allocation in frequency, time and over the multiple channels |
WO1997021314A1 (en) * | 1995-12-07 | 1997-06-12 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Emergency call handling in a cellular telecommunications system |
US5721735A (en) * | 1995-12-08 | 1998-02-24 | Multipoint Networks | Method and apparatus for arbitrating access of plural bidding devices to a central device using a goal index |
US5790784A (en) * | 1995-12-11 | 1998-08-04 | Delco Electronics Corporation | Network for time synchronizing a digital information processing system with received digital information |
US5815115A (en) * | 1995-12-26 | 1998-09-29 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | High speed wireless transmitters and receivers |
US5912882A (en) | 1996-02-01 | 1999-06-15 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for providing a private communication system in a public switched telephone network |
US5875234A (en) | 1996-02-14 | 1999-02-23 | Netphone, Inc. | Computer integrated PBX system |
FI113320B (en) * | 1996-02-19 | 2004-03-31 | Nokia Corp | Method for enhancing data transmission |
JPH09233054A (en) * | 1996-02-27 | 1997-09-05 | Oki Electric Ind Co Ltd | Decoder |
US5758293A (en) * | 1996-03-06 | 1998-05-26 | Motorola Inc. | Subscriber unit and delivery system for wireless information retrieval |
US5754537A (en) * | 1996-03-08 | 1998-05-19 | Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson (Publ) | Method and system for transmitting background noise data |
JP3437706B2 (en) * | 1996-03-19 | 2003-08-18 | 富士通株式会社 | Switches and switching systems |
JP3731619B2 (en) * | 1996-03-19 | 2006-01-05 | ソニー株式会社 | Portable wireless communication device and lighting control method thereof |
JP2877195B2 (en) * | 1996-03-19 | 1999-03-31 | 日本電気株式会社 | Digital portable wireless terminal device and backlight driving method thereof |
US5819177A (en) * | 1996-03-20 | 1998-10-06 | Dynamic Telecommunications, Inc. | Fixed wireless terminals with network management method and apparatus |
US5809472A (en) * | 1996-04-03 | 1998-09-15 | Command Audio Corporation | Digital audio data transmission system based on the information content of an audio signal |
US5796729A (en) * | 1996-05-09 | 1998-08-18 | Bell Communications Research, Inc. | Integrated telecommunication system architecture for wireless and wireline access featuring PACS radio technology |
US5912895A (en) | 1996-05-01 | 1999-06-15 | Northern Telecom Limited | Information network access apparatus and methods for communicating information packets via telephone lines |
US5918024A (en) * | 1996-05-08 | 1999-06-29 | Ericsson, Inc. | Method and apparatus for providing single channel communications |
US5815671A (en) * | 1996-06-11 | 1998-09-29 | Command Audio Corporation | Method and apparatus for encoding and storing audio/video information for subsequent predetermined retrieval |
DE19623279C1 (en) * | 1996-06-11 | 1997-12-11 | Nokia Mobile Phones Ltd | Cordless telecommunication method using TDMA between first and second stations |
US6023460A (en) * | 1996-06-28 | 2000-02-08 | Harris Corporation | Wireless communications system and method using a reusable control channel |
US5960331A (en) * | 1996-07-01 | 1999-09-28 | Harris Corporation | Device and method for maintaining synchronization and frequency stability in a wireless telecommunication system |
US5896375A (en) * | 1996-07-23 | 1999-04-20 | Ericsson Inc. | Short-range radio communications system and method of use |
GB2357020B (en) | 1996-07-31 | 2001-08-22 | Inmarsat Ltd | Method and apparatus for transmitting data |
US5926755A (en) * | 1996-08-07 | 1999-07-20 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson | Method and an arrangement for conducting multiple calls simultaneously |
JPH1056434A (en) * | 1996-08-09 | 1998-02-24 | Nippon Denki Ido Tsushin Kk | Communication method in mobile communication |
US5956629A (en) * | 1996-08-14 | 1999-09-21 | Command Audio Corporation | Method and apparatus for transmitter identification and selection for mobile information signal services |
US6728784B1 (en) * | 1996-08-21 | 2004-04-27 | Netspeak Corporation | Collaborative multimedia architecture for packet-switched data networks |
FI111428B (en) * | 1996-08-29 | 2003-07-15 | Nokia Corp | Gallup that utilizes a wireless data communication connection |
EP1058439A3 (en) * | 1996-09-09 | 2001-01-03 | Home Wireless Networks, Inc. | Home personal communication system |
US5905719A (en) * | 1996-09-19 | 1999-05-18 | Bell Communications Research, Inc. | Method and system for wireless internet access |
AU4752797A (en) * | 1996-10-09 | 1998-05-05 | Alcatel Usa Sourcing, L.P. | Call routing in a wireless telecommunications system |
AU4752697A (en) * | 1996-10-09 | 1998-05-05 | Dsc Telecom L.P. | Call management in a wireless telecommunications system |
GB2320649B (en) * | 1996-12-20 | 2001-07-11 | Dsc Telecom Lp | Call logging in a wireless telecommunication system |
EP0841763B1 (en) * | 1996-10-25 | 2003-12-10 | Nokia Corporation | Method for radio resource control |
FI104142B1 (en) * | 1996-10-25 | 1999-11-15 | Nokia Mobile Phones Ltd | Control method for the use of radio resources |
US6597668B1 (en) * | 1996-11-07 | 2003-07-22 | Harris Broadband Wireless Access, Inc. | System and method for maximizing efficiency in a time division duplex system employing dynamic asymmetry |
US6111870A (en) | 1996-11-07 | 2000-08-29 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Method and apparatus for compressing and transmitting high speed data |
US5905733A (en) * | 1996-12-03 | 1999-05-18 | Ericsson Inc. | Method and apparatus for distinguishing in-band signaling from user data |
US6169789B1 (en) * | 1996-12-16 | 2001-01-02 | Sanjay K. Rao | Intelligent keyboard system |
US6389057B1 (en) * | 1996-12-23 | 2002-05-14 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Access technique of channel hopping communications system |
JP3666155B2 (en) * | 1996-12-26 | 2005-06-29 | ソニー株式会社 | COMMUNICATION METHOD, TRANSMISSION DEVICE, AND RECEPTION DEVICE |
US5950136A (en) * | 1997-01-08 | 1999-09-07 | Paradyne Corporation | System and method for routing data calls in a cellular network |
US7031391B1 (en) | 1997-02-18 | 2006-04-18 | Harris Corporation | Narrowband video codec |
US5953374A (en) * | 1997-03-03 | 1999-09-14 | Pc-Tel, Inc. | Bandpass spectral shaping of data signals |
US5870134A (en) * | 1997-03-04 | 1999-02-09 | Com21, Inc. | CATV network and cable modem system having a wireless return path |
IL131831A (en) | 1997-03-12 | 2002-12-01 | Nomadix Inc | Nomadic translator or router |
KR100222413B1 (en) | 1997-03-14 | 1999-10-01 | 윤종용 | Signaling matching device for matching analog exchange and digital exchange |
US6282228B1 (en) | 1997-03-20 | 2001-08-28 | Xircom, Inc. | Spread spectrum codes for use in communication |
US5995830A (en) * | 1997-04-09 | 1999-11-30 | At&T Wireless Services Inc. | System and method for processing dropped calls |
US6370375B1 (en) | 1997-04-14 | 2002-04-09 | At&T Corp. | Voice-response paging device and method |
US6185195B1 (en) * | 1997-05-16 | 2001-02-06 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods for preventing and detecting message collisions in a half-duplex communication system |
FR2764468A1 (en) * | 1997-06-10 | 1998-12-11 | Philips Electronics Nv | WIRELESS TELEPHONE DEVICE |
WO1998057449A2 (en) * | 1997-06-11 | 1998-12-17 | Airspan Communications Corporation | Establishing a wireless link between a subscriber terminal and a central terminal of a telecommunications system |
GB2326311B (en) * | 1997-06-11 | 2002-04-03 | Dsc Telecom Lp | Allocating channels for a wireless link between a central terminal and a subscriber terminal of a wireless telecommunications system |
GB2326310B (en) | 1997-06-11 | 2002-04-17 | Dsc Telecom Lp | Establishing a wireless link between a central terminal and a subscriber terminal of a wireless telecommunications system |
US6081536A (en) * | 1997-06-20 | 2000-06-27 | Tantivy Communications, Inc. | Dynamic bandwidth allocation to transmit a wireless protocol across a code division multiple access (CDMA) radio link |
US6151332A (en) * | 1997-06-20 | 2000-11-21 | Tantivy Communications, Inc. | Protocol conversion and bandwidth reduction technique providing multiple nB+D ISDN basic rate interface links over a wireless code division multiple access communication system |
US6388999B1 (en) | 1997-12-17 | 2002-05-14 | Tantivy Communications, Inc. | Dynamic bandwidth allocation for multiple access communications using buffer urgency factor |
US6542481B2 (en) * | 1998-06-01 | 2003-04-01 | Tantivy Communications, Inc. | Dynamic bandwidth allocation for multiple access communication using session queues |
JP3048964B2 (en) * | 1997-06-24 | 2000-06-05 | 邦彦 小池 | Telephone transmitting / receiving unit and mobile communication terminal |
US6044268A (en) * | 1997-07-16 | 2000-03-28 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson Ab | System and method for providing intercom and multiple voice channels in a private telephone system |
JPH1155720A (en) * | 1997-07-29 | 1999-02-26 | Matsushita Electric Ind Co Ltd | Controller for radio communication system |
JP3190859B2 (en) | 1997-07-29 | 2001-07-23 | 松下電器産業株式会社 | CDMA radio transmitting apparatus and CDMA radio receiving apparatus |
US6115142A (en) * | 1997-08-04 | 2000-09-05 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for supporting analog fax calls in a tandem configuration |
GB2329553B (en) * | 1997-08-22 | 2002-08-28 | Olivetti Telemedia Spa | Radio communication system |
US6456627B1 (en) | 1997-08-29 | 2002-09-24 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Method for communicating information in a communication system that supports multiple modulation schemes |
JP4236377B2 (en) | 1997-08-29 | 2009-03-11 | クゥアルコム・インコーポレイテッド | Apparatus and method for supporting analog fax calls in tandem structure |
KR100237569B1 (en) * | 1997-08-30 | 2000-01-15 | 서평원 | Voice / data simultaneous service method for vocoder usability improvement |
US6044486A (en) * | 1997-09-11 | 2000-03-28 | Uniden America Corporation | Method and device for majority vote optimization over wireless communication channels |
DE19742378A1 (en) * | 1997-09-25 | 1999-04-22 | Siemens Ag | Ring memory for a TDMA data transmission station and corresponding data transmission station |
US6108560A (en) * | 1997-09-26 | 2000-08-22 | Nortel Networks Corporation | Wireless communications system |
US6445733B1 (en) * | 1997-10-03 | 2002-09-03 | Conexant Systems, Inc. | Method of and apparatus for performing line characterization in a non-idle mode in a subscriber line communication system |
US6400966B1 (en) * | 1997-10-07 | 2002-06-04 | Telefonaktie Bolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Base station architecture for a mobile communications system |
US6678255B1 (en) * | 1997-10-09 | 2004-01-13 | Mci Communications Corporation | Wireless data interface system for fixed point-to-point communications |
US6567416B1 (en) * | 1997-10-14 | 2003-05-20 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | Method for access control in a multiple access system for communications networks |
AU1083799A (en) * | 1997-10-20 | 1999-05-10 | Comsat Corporation | Method and system for transport of frame relay traffic over satellite/wireless networks |
US7184426B2 (en) * | 2002-12-12 | 2007-02-27 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Method and apparatus for burst pilot for a time division multiplex system |
US9118387B2 (en) | 1997-11-03 | 2015-08-25 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Pilot reference transmission for a wireless communication system |
JP3307573B2 (en) * | 1997-11-12 | 2002-07-24 | 沖電気工業株式会社 | Wireless communication device |
US5995849A (en) * | 1997-11-26 | 1999-11-30 | Direct Wireless Communication Corp. | Direct wireless communication system and method of operation |
US20040160910A1 (en) * | 1997-12-17 | 2004-08-19 | Tantivy Communications, Inc. | Dynamic bandwidth allocation to transmit a wireless protocol across a code division multiple access (CDMA) radio link |
US9525923B2 (en) | 1997-12-17 | 2016-12-20 | Intel Corporation | Multi-detection of heartbeat to reduce error probability |
US8175120B2 (en) | 2000-02-07 | 2012-05-08 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Minimal maintenance link to support synchronization |
US7394791B2 (en) | 1997-12-17 | 2008-07-01 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Multi-detection of heartbeat to reduce error probability |
US7936728B2 (en) | 1997-12-17 | 2011-05-03 | Tantivy Communications, Inc. | System and method for maintaining timing of synchronization messages over a reverse link of a CDMA wireless communication system |
US7496072B2 (en) * | 1997-12-17 | 2009-02-24 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | System and method for controlling signal strength over a reverse link of a CDMA wireless communication system |
US7079523B2 (en) * | 2000-02-07 | 2006-07-18 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Maintenance link using active/standby request channels |
US6222832B1 (en) * | 1998-06-01 | 2001-04-24 | Tantivy Communications, Inc. | Fast Acquisition of traffic channels for a highly variable data rate reverse link of a CDMA wireless communication system |
FI106607B (en) * | 1998-01-07 | 2001-02-28 | Nokia Mobile Phones Ltd | Cell Selection in a Multi Modulation Cellular Radio System |
IL123045A0 (en) * | 1998-01-25 | 1998-09-24 | Eci Telecom Ltd | Apparatus and method for digital telephony |
JP2928224B1 (en) * | 1998-02-26 | 1999-08-03 | 静岡日本電気株式会社 | Antenna switching diversity receiving apparatus and receiving method |
US6724891B1 (en) | 1998-03-04 | 2004-04-20 | Silicon Laboratories Inc. | Integrated modem and line-isolation circuitry and associated method powering caller ID circuitry with power provided across an isolation barrier |
US6714590B1 (en) | 1999-07-23 | 2004-03-30 | Silicon Laboratories, Inc. | Integrated modem and line-isolation circuitry and associated method |
US6333937B1 (en) * | 1998-03-05 | 2001-12-25 | At&T Wireless Services, Inc. | Access retry method for shared channel wireless communications links |
US6201796B1 (en) | 1998-05-14 | 2001-03-13 | Broadcom Corporation | Startup protocol for high throughput communications systems |
US6212225B1 (en) | 1998-05-14 | 2001-04-03 | Bradcom Corporation | Startup protocol for high throughput communications systems |
CA2237289C (en) * | 1998-03-24 | 2006-07-11 | Vistar Telecommunications Inc. | Packet data communication system |
US6310870B1 (en) | 1998-03-30 | 2001-10-30 | Oki Telecom, Inc. | Method for transmitting high data rate information in code division multiple access systems |
SE9801172D0 (en) * | 1998-04-01 | 1998-04-01 | Ericsson Telefon Ab L M | Cell selection in a system with different cell capabilities |
US6320850B1 (en) | 1998-04-24 | 2001-11-20 | Trw Inc. | Satellite communication adaptive control coding |
DE69911837T2 (en) * | 1998-04-30 | 2004-08-19 | Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd., Kadoma | Method of distributing video information on a mobile object through digital radio transmission |
USD419160S (en) * | 1998-05-14 | 2000-01-18 | Northrop Grumman Corporation | Personal communications unit docking station |
US6141426A (en) * | 1998-05-15 | 2000-10-31 | Northrop Grumman Corporation | Voice operated switch for use in high noise environments |
US6041243A (en) * | 1998-05-15 | 2000-03-21 | Northrop Grumman Corporation | Personal communications unit |
US6169730B1 (en) | 1998-05-15 | 2001-01-02 | Northrop Grumman Corporation | Wireless communications protocol |
US6304559B1 (en) | 1998-05-15 | 2001-10-16 | Northrop Grumman Corporation | Wireless communications protocol |
USD421002S (en) * | 1998-05-15 | 2000-02-22 | Northrop Grumman Corporation | Personal communications unit handset |
US6243573B1 (en) | 1998-05-15 | 2001-06-05 | Northrop Grumman Corporation | Personal communications system |
US6223062B1 (en) | 1998-05-15 | 2001-04-24 | Northrop Grumann Corporation | Communications interface adapter |
CN1302502A (en) * | 1998-05-22 | 2001-07-04 | 家庭无线网络公司 | Communications web for PSTN subscribers |
US7773566B2 (en) | 1998-06-01 | 2010-08-10 | Tantivy Communications, Inc. | System and method for maintaining timing of synchronization messages over a reverse link of a CDMA wireless communication system |
US8134980B2 (en) | 1998-06-01 | 2012-03-13 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Transmittal of heartbeat signal at a lower level than heartbeat request |
US7221664B2 (en) * | 1998-06-01 | 2007-05-22 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Transmittal of heartbeat signal at a lower level than heartbeat request |
US6259676B1 (en) * | 1998-06-17 | 2001-07-10 | Nokia Telecommunications Oy | Upgrading of subscriber connection |
US6735437B2 (en) * | 1998-06-26 | 2004-05-11 | Hughes Electronics Corporation | Communication system employing reuse of satellite spectrum for terrestrial communication |
US6452915B1 (en) | 1998-07-10 | 2002-09-17 | Malibu Networks, Inc. | IP-flow classification in a wireless point to multi-point (PTMP) transmission system |
US6862622B2 (en) | 1998-07-10 | 2005-03-01 | Van Drebbel Mariner Llc | Transmission control protocol/internet protocol (TCP/IP) packet-centric wireless point to multi-point (PTMP) transmission system architecture |
DE69834483T2 (en) * | 1998-07-21 | 2007-04-19 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | Signaling method and system |
US6836515B1 (en) | 1998-07-24 | 2004-12-28 | Hughes Electronics Corporation | Multi-modulation radio communications |
FR2781957A1 (en) * | 1998-07-28 | 2000-02-04 | Canon Kk | Network communication procedure |
US6574452B1 (en) | 1998-07-28 | 2003-06-03 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Method and device for communication on a network |
WO2000007178A1 (en) | 1998-07-31 | 2000-02-10 | Conexant Systems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for noise elimination through transformation of the output of the speech decoder |
US6011548A (en) * | 1998-09-04 | 2000-01-04 | Cyberstar, L.P. | System for integrating satellite boardband data distributed over a cable TV network with legacy corporate local area networks |
US6510467B1 (en) | 1998-09-16 | 2003-01-21 | International Business Machines Corporation | Method for transferring data files between a user and an internet server |
US6996088B1 (en) | 1998-09-18 | 2006-02-07 | Harris Corporation | Distributed trunking mechanism for VHF networking |
EP1114542B1 (en) * | 1998-09-18 | 2008-03-12 | Harris Corporation | Distributed trunking mechanism for a vhf network |
US6304992B1 (en) | 1998-09-24 | 2001-10-16 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Technique for correcting single-bit errors in caches with sub-block parity bits |
US6661848B1 (en) * | 1998-09-25 | 2003-12-09 | Intel Corporation | Integrated audio and modem device |
US6502138B2 (en) * | 1998-09-25 | 2002-12-31 | Intel Corporation | Modem with code execution adapted to symbol rate |
US6490628B2 (en) * | 1998-09-25 | 2002-12-03 | Intel Corporation | Modem using a digital signal processor and a signal based command set |
US6625208B2 (en) * | 1998-09-25 | 2003-09-23 | Intel Corporation | Modem using batch processing of signal samples |
DE19848116A1 (en) * | 1998-10-19 | 2000-05-04 | Siemens Ag | Method and radio communication system for signaling control |
AU750201B2 (en) * | 1998-11-06 | 2002-07-11 | Citibank, N.A. | Systems and methods for integrating video, audio, and mobile radiophone technology |
US6128330A (en) | 1998-11-24 | 2000-10-03 | Linex Technology, Inc. | Efficient shadow reduction antenna system for spread spectrum |
US7194554B1 (en) | 1998-12-08 | 2007-03-20 | Nomadix, Inc. | Systems and methods for providing dynamic network authorization authentication and accounting |
US8713641B1 (en) | 1998-12-08 | 2014-04-29 | Nomadix, Inc. | Systems and methods for authorizing, authenticating and accounting users having transparent computer access to a network using a gateway device |
US8266266B2 (en) | 1998-12-08 | 2012-09-11 | Nomadix, Inc. | Systems and methods for providing dynamic network authorization, authentication and accounting |
US6600734B1 (en) * | 1998-12-17 | 2003-07-29 | Symbol Technologies, Inc. | Apparatus for interfacing a wireless local network and a wired voice telecommunications system |
US7216348B1 (en) | 1999-01-05 | 2007-05-08 | Net2Phone, Inc. | Method and apparatus for dynamically balancing call flow workloads in a telecommunications system |
US6404408B1 (en) * | 1999-01-07 | 2002-06-11 | Surfer Network.Com, Inc. | Enhanced radio graphic data system |
US6600908B1 (en) | 1999-02-04 | 2003-07-29 | Hark C. Chan | Method and system for broadcasting and receiving audio information and associated audio indexes |
EP1153516B1 (en) * | 1999-02-25 | 2007-01-31 | Nokia Corporation | An outband signaling method for transparent data services |
US6567395B1 (en) * | 1999-03-10 | 2003-05-20 | Rockwell Collins, Inc. | Display for a high frequency (HF) radio |
US6950441B1 (en) | 1999-03-30 | 2005-09-27 | Sonus Networks, Inc. | System and method to internetwork telecommunication networks of different protocols |
US6169912B1 (en) | 1999-03-31 | 2001-01-02 | Pericom Semiconductor Corp. | RF front-end with signal cancellation using receiver signal to eliminate duplexer for a cordless phone |
DE19914742A1 (en) * | 1999-03-31 | 2000-10-12 | Siemens Ag | Method of transferring data |
US6965778B1 (en) | 1999-04-08 | 2005-11-15 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Maintenance of channel usage in a wireless communication system |
CN1186893C (en) * | 1999-04-12 | 2005-01-26 | 三星电子株式会社 | Apparatus and method for gated transmission in CDMA communication system |
US6947469B2 (en) | 1999-05-07 | 2005-09-20 | Intel Corporation | Method and Apparatus for wireless spread spectrum communication with preamble processing period |
JP3531526B2 (en) * | 1999-05-13 | 2004-05-31 | 日本電気株式会社 | Communications system |
US6154636A (en) * | 1999-05-14 | 2000-11-28 | Harris Corporation | System and method of providing OOOI times of an aircraft |
US6285662B1 (en) * | 1999-05-14 | 2001-09-04 | Nokia Mobile Phones Limited | Apparatus, and associated method for selecting a size of a contention window for a packet of data system |
US6532279B1 (en) * | 1999-06-11 | 2003-03-11 | David D. Goodman | High-speed data communication over a residential telephone wiring network |
US6345251B1 (en) * | 1999-06-15 | 2002-02-05 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Low-rate speech coder for non-speech data transmission |
FI107676B (en) * | 1999-06-21 | 2001-09-14 | Nokia Mobile Phones Ltd | Method and arrangement for utilizing a particular approach in signal management to convey information |
US7720468B1 (en) | 1999-06-23 | 2010-05-18 | Clearwire Legacy Llc | Polling methods for use in a wireless communication system |
DE19928662A1 (en) * | 1999-06-23 | 2000-12-28 | Sel Verteidigungssysteme Gmbh | Quasi-periodic signaling data transmission involves combining transmission frames into super-frame with similar signaling data of same data class combined into super-frame window(s) |
US6163681A (en) * | 1999-06-25 | 2000-12-19 | Harris Corporation | Wireless spread spectrum ground link-based aircraft data communication system with variable data rate |
US6650630B1 (en) * | 1999-06-25 | 2003-11-18 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Resource management and traffic control in time-division-duplex communication systems |
US6148179A (en) * | 1999-06-25 | 2000-11-14 | Harris Corporation | Wireless spread spectrum ground link-based aircraft data communication system for engine event reporting |
US6160998A (en) * | 1999-06-25 | 2000-12-12 | Harris Corporation | Wireless spread spectrum ground link-based aircraft data communication system with approach data messaging download |
US6167239A (en) * | 1999-06-25 | 2000-12-26 | Harris Corporation | Wireless spread spectrum ground link-based aircraft data communication system with airborne airline packet communications |
US6173159B1 (en) | 1999-06-25 | 2001-01-09 | Harris Corporation | Wireless spread spectrum ground link-based aircraft data communication system for updating flight management files |
US6167238A (en) * | 1999-06-25 | 2000-12-26 | Harris Corporation | Wireless-based aircraft data communication system with automatic frequency control |
US7024168B1 (en) * | 1999-07-07 | 2006-04-04 | Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson (Publ) | Controlled antenna diversity |
KR100877633B1 (en) * | 1999-07-09 | 2009-02-06 | 말리부 네트웍스, 인코퍼레이티드 | TC / IP packet-centric wireless transmission system architecture |
US6826225B1 (en) | 1999-07-23 | 2004-11-30 | Silicon Laboratories, Inc. | Integrated modem and line-isolation circuitry with selective raw data or modem data communication and associated method |
US6735246B1 (en) | 1999-07-23 | 2004-05-11 | Silicon Laboratories Inc. | Integrated modem and line-isolation circuitry with data flow control and associated method |
US6662238B1 (en) | 1999-07-23 | 2003-12-09 | Silicon Laboratories Inc. | Integrated modem and line-isolation circuitry with command mode and data mode control and associated method |
US6304597B1 (en) * | 1999-07-23 | 2001-10-16 | Silicon Laboratories, Inc. | Integrated modem and line-isolation circuitry with selective modem processing and associated method |
US7020187B1 (en) | 1999-07-23 | 2006-03-28 | Silicon Laboratories Inc. | Integrated modem and line-isolation circuitry with HDLC framing and associated method |
US20040230710A1 (en) * | 1999-07-27 | 2004-11-18 | Inline Connection Corporation | System and method of automatic installation of computer peripherals |
US6704824B1 (en) * | 1999-07-27 | 2004-03-09 | Inline Connection Corporation | Universal serial bus adapter with automatic installation |
US8064409B1 (en) | 1999-08-25 | 2011-11-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus using a multi-carrier forward link in a wireless communication system |
US6553032B1 (en) | 1999-09-01 | 2003-04-22 | Tantivy Communications, Inc. | Packeting timeout spoofing in a wireless data communications network |
US7023833B1 (en) * | 1999-09-10 | 2006-04-04 | Pulse-Link, Inc. | Baseband wireless network for isochronous communication |
US6944148B1 (en) | 1999-09-10 | 2005-09-13 | Pulse-Link, Inc. | Apparatus and method for managing variable-sized data slots within a time division multiple access frame |
US6526034B1 (en) | 1999-09-21 | 2003-02-25 | Tantivy Communications, Inc. | Dual mode subscriber unit for short range, high rate and long range, lower rate data communications |
US6621804B1 (en) | 1999-10-07 | 2003-09-16 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for predicting favored supplemental channel transmission slots using transmission power measurements of a fundamental channel |
US8190708B1 (en) | 1999-10-22 | 2012-05-29 | Nomadix, Inc. | Gateway device having an XML interface and associated method |
US6268827B1 (en) | 1999-10-29 | 2001-07-31 | Ball Aerospace & Technologies Corp. | Method and apparatus for carrying signals having different frequencies in a space-deployed antenna system |
US6931370B1 (en) * | 1999-11-02 | 2005-08-16 | Digital Theater Systems, Inc. | System and method for providing interactive audio in a multi-channel audio environment |
US6631124B1 (en) * | 1999-11-03 | 2003-10-07 | Ericsson Inc. | Methods and apparatus for allocating resources in hybrid TDMA communication systems |
US7088795B1 (en) | 1999-11-03 | 2006-08-08 | Pulse-Link, Inc. | Ultra wide band base band receiver |
KR100375145B1 (en) * | 1999-11-10 | 2003-03-19 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Device and method for communicating data using multicarrier in cdma communication system |
US6278742B1 (en) * | 1999-11-19 | 2001-08-21 | Siemens Information And Communication Mobile Llc. | Method and system for power-conserving interference avoidance in communication between a mobile unit and a base unit in a wireless telecommunication system |
US6373839B1 (en) | 1999-12-10 | 2002-04-16 | Siemens Information And Communication Networks, Inc. | Bandwidth biased codec selection system and method |
GB9930089D0 (en) * | 1999-12-20 | 2000-02-09 | Nokia Networks Oy | Communications networks |
US8463255B2 (en) | 1999-12-20 | 2013-06-11 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Method and apparatus for a spectrally compliant cellular communication system |
US6584113B1 (en) * | 1999-12-22 | 2003-06-24 | Pitney Bowes Inc. | Data transfer module and system using same |
US6956844B2 (en) * | 1999-12-22 | 2005-10-18 | Pitney Bowes Inc. | Facsimile machine having multi-purpose data ports for signal routing and data management |
US6463133B1 (en) | 1999-12-22 | 2002-10-08 | Pitney Bowes Inc. | Method and apparatus for telecommunications signal routing and data management |
US6501947B1 (en) * | 1999-12-23 | 2002-12-31 | Denso Corporation | Efficient resource management for packet data services |
US6658620B1 (en) | 2000-01-11 | 2003-12-02 | Northrop Grumman Corporation | Burst and packet wireless transmission using product codes with iterative decoding |
EP1117191A1 (en) * | 2000-01-13 | 2001-07-18 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson | Echo cancelling method |
US7512409B1 (en) | 2000-01-13 | 2009-03-31 | Zion Hadad Communications Ltd. | Cellular network system |
US8285292B1 (en) | 2000-02-11 | 2012-10-09 | At&T Mobility Ii Llc | Detection of cross-connection between a wireless loop network and another loop network at a subscriber's premises |
US7110531B2 (en) | 2000-02-17 | 2006-09-19 | Analog Devices, Inc. | Isolation system with analog communication across an isolation barrier |
KR100773794B1 (en) | 2000-02-23 | 2007-11-07 | 아이피알 라이센싱, 인코포레이티드 | Access Probe Response with Collision Detection |
US20020197989A1 (en) * | 2000-02-25 | 2002-12-26 | Olivier Cruder | Wireless telephony interface and method |
US6658255B1 (en) * | 2000-03-02 | 2003-12-02 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | Enhanced wireless radio channel utilization |
US6456851B1 (en) | 2000-03-06 | 2002-09-24 | Aurora Networks, Inc. | Wireless communications architecture |
US6704346B1 (en) | 2000-03-16 | 2004-03-09 | Sharp Laboratories Of America, Inc. | Method and apparatus to provide improved microwave interference robustness in RF communications devices |
EP1269723B1 (en) | 2000-03-22 | 2013-08-28 | Mlr, Llc | A tiered wireless, multi-modal access system |
GB0008119D0 (en) * | 2000-04-03 | 2000-05-24 | Nokia Networks Oy | Estimating communication quality |
US6842459B1 (en) | 2000-04-19 | 2005-01-11 | Serconet Ltd. | Network combining wired and non-wired segments |
EP1148750A1 (en) * | 2000-04-22 | 2001-10-24 | Deutsche Thomson-Brandt Gmbh | Channel preselection method for a RF communication system |
US8321542B1 (en) | 2000-05-05 | 2012-11-27 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Wireless channel allocation in a base station processor |
DE60026454T2 (en) * | 2000-05-19 | 2006-11-09 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | Wireless local area network with load sharing |
US6804252B1 (en) * | 2000-05-19 | 2004-10-12 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Automatic reverse channel assignment in a two-way TDM communication system |
AU2001275342A1 (en) * | 2000-06-06 | 2001-12-17 | Altratek Inc. | System and method for detection and tracking of targets |
CA2311687A1 (en) * | 2000-06-06 | 2001-12-06 | Michael Stumm | Call progress management |
US6970448B1 (en) * | 2000-06-21 | 2005-11-29 | Pulse-Link, Inc. | Wireless TDMA system and method for network communications |
US6952456B1 (en) * | 2000-06-21 | 2005-10-04 | Pulse-Link, Inc. | Ultra wide band transmitter |
DE60038369T2 (en) * | 2000-06-28 | 2009-03-05 | Sony Deutschland Gmbh | DEVICE FOR MODULATION DETECTION |
FI20001705A (en) * | 2000-07-24 | 2002-01-25 | Nokia Networks Oy | A cleavage slip of a communications system |
US6778513B2 (en) * | 2000-09-29 | 2004-08-17 | Arraycomm, Inc. | Method and apparatus for separting multiple users in a shared-channel communication system |
US7433340B1 (en) * | 2000-10-19 | 2008-10-07 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Staggering forward and reverse wireless channel allocation timing |
US8842642B2 (en) | 2000-10-19 | 2014-09-23 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Transmitting acknowledgement messages using a staggered uplink time slot |
US6973098B1 (en) | 2000-10-25 | 2005-12-06 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Method and apparatus for determining a data rate in a high rate packet data wireless communications system |
US7068683B1 (en) | 2000-10-25 | 2006-06-27 | Qualcomm, Incorporated | Method and apparatus for high rate packet data and low delay data transmissions |
US6807165B2 (en) | 2000-11-08 | 2004-10-19 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Time division protocol for an ad-hoc, peer-to-peer radio network having coordinating channel access to shared parallel data channels with separate reservation channel |
US6873839B2 (en) | 2000-11-13 | 2005-03-29 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Prioritized-routing for an ad-hoc, peer-to-peer, mobile radio access system |
US7072650B2 (en) * | 2000-11-13 | 2006-07-04 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Ad hoc peer-to-peer mobile radio access system interfaced to the PSTN and cellular networks |
KR100847187B1 (en) * | 2000-11-16 | 2008-07-17 | 소니 가부시끼 가이샤 | Information processing device and communication device |
US6736322B2 (en) | 2000-11-20 | 2004-05-18 | Ecrio Inc. | Method and apparatus for acquiring, maintaining, and using information to be communicated in bar code form with a mobile communications device |
US8155096B1 (en) | 2000-12-01 | 2012-04-10 | Ipr Licensing Inc. | Antenna control system and method |
US20020071402A1 (en) * | 2000-12-01 | 2002-06-13 | Siemens Information And Communication Products, Llc. | Bit error rate in a TDMA frequency hopping spread spectrum system by using additional transmit slots |
EP1213872A3 (en) * | 2000-12-05 | 2002-07-03 | Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V. | Recovery of a packet in a packet transmission system with return link |
US6748329B2 (en) * | 2000-12-08 | 2004-06-08 | Halliburton Energy Services, Inc. | Acoustic signal processing method using array coherency |
US7397867B2 (en) * | 2000-12-14 | 2008-07-08 | Pulse-Link, Inc. | Mapping radio-frequency spectrum in a communication system |
US6947748B2 (en) | 2000-12-15 | 2005-09-20 | Adaptix, Inc. | OFDMA with adaptive subcarrier-cluster configuration and selective loading |
US7433683B2 (en) * | 2000-12-28 | 2008-10-07 | Northstar Acquisitions, Llc | System for fast macrodiversity switching in mobile wireless networks |
US6775540B2 (en) | 2000-12-29 | 2004-08-10 | Bellsouth Intellectual Property Corporation | Method for automated retune of telecommunications data in a wireless network using ericsson equipment |
US6957064B2 (en) * | 2000-12-29 | 2005-10-18 | Bellsouth Intellectual Property Corporation | Method for automated retune of telecommunications data in a wireless network using lucent equipment |
US6895244B2 (en) * | 2000-12-29 | 2005-05-17 | Bellsouth Intellectual Property Corporation | Method for automated update of telecommunications data in a wireless network |
US6895243B2 (en) * | 2000-12-29 | 2005-05-17 | Bellsouth Intellectual Property Corporation | Method for reverse path mapping in a wireless network using Comarco and Hughes telecommunications equipment |
US6904278B2 (en) * | 2000-12-29 | 2005-06-07 | Bellsouth Intellectual Property Corporation | Method for mapping tear down data in a wireless network |
US6983142B2 (en) | 2000-12-29 | 2006-01-03 | Bellsouth Intellectual Property Corporation | Method for reverse path mapping in a wireless network using Xtel and ericsson telecommunications equipment |
US6987968B2 (en) * | 2000-12-29 | 2006-01-17 | Bellsouth Intellectual Property Corporation | Method for reverse path mapping in a wireless network using Xtel and Lucent telecommunications equipment |
US6680930B2 (en) * | 2001-01-16 | 2004-01-20 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and apparatus for determining and reserving bandwidth for transmitting delay-sensitive streaming data over a radio frequency channel |
US7551663B1 (en) * | 2001-02-01 | 2009-06-23 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Use of correlation combination to achieve channel detection |
US6954448B2 (en) | 2001-02-01 | 2005-10-11 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Alternate channel for carrying selected message types |
US20020159434A1 (en) * | 2001-02-12 | 2002-10-31 | Eleven Engineering Inc. | Multipoint short range radio frequency system |
US6823178B2 (en) | 2001-02-14 | 2004-11-23 | Ydi Wireless, Inc. | High-speed point-to-point modem-less microwave radio frequency link using direct frequency modulation |
US7035246B2 (en) * | 2001-03-13 | 2006-04-25 | Pulse-Link, Inc. | Maintaining a global time reference among a group of networked devices |
EP1244250A1 (en) * | 2001-03-21 | 2002-09-25 | Siemens Aktiengesellschaft | Method and telecommunication system for monitoring data streams in a data network |
US7151769B2 (en) | 2001-03-22 | 2006-12-19 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Prioritized-routing for an ad-hoc, peer-to-peer, mobile radio access system based on battery-power levels and type of service |
GB0110125D0 (en) | 2001-04-25 | 2001-06-20 | Koninkl Philips Electronics Nv | Radio communication system |
US6853646B2 (en) * | 2001-05-02 | 2005-02-08 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Fast switching of forward link in wireless system |
DE10121335A1 (en) * | 2001-05-02 | 2002-11-14 | Tenovis Gmbh & Co Kg | Method for realizing a system time and telecommunication system |
TW507442B (en) * | 2001-05-04 | 2002-10-21 | Winbond Electronics Corp | Packet data transmission method |
DE60121731T2 (en) * | 2001-05-08 | 2007-08-02 | Agere Systems Guardian Corp., Miami Lakes | Cordless network system which includes access points |
US6741139B2 (en) | 2001-05-22 | 2004-05-25 | Ydi Wirelesss, Inc. | Optical to microwave converter using direct modulation phase shift keying |
US20020183009A1 (en) * | 2001-06-01 | 2002-12-05 | Cruz-Albrecht Jose M. | Radio communication within a computer system |
EP2479905B1 (en) | 2001-06-13 | 2017-03-15 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatuses for transmittal of heartbeat signal at a lower level than heartbeat request |
WO2002103610A2 (en) | 2001-06-14 | 2002-12-27 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Routing algorithms in a mobile ad-hoc network |
JP3816356B2 (en) * | 2001-06-21 | 2006-08-30 | 株式会社東芝 | Wireless transmitter |
US7130337B2 (en) | 2001-07-02 | 2006-10-31 | Phonex Broadband Corporation | Method and system for sample and recreation synchronization for digital transmission of analog modem signal |
US20050271280A1 (en) * | 2003-07-23 | 2005-12-08 | Farmer Michael E | System or method for classifying images |
US20030014254A1 (en) * | 2001-07-11 | 2003-01-16 | You Zhang | Load-shared distribution of a speech system |
US7577118B2 (en) * | 2001-07-24 | 2009-08-18 | Intel Corporation | System and method of classifying remote users according to link quality, and scheduling wireless transmission of information to the to the users based upon the classifications |
US7206294B2 (en) * | 2001-08-15 | 2007-04-17 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Movable access points and repeaters for minimizing coverage and capacity constraints in a wireless communications network and a method for using the same |
US7349380B2 (en) * | 2001-08-15 | 2008-03-25 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for providing an addressing and proxy scheme for facilitating mobility of wireless nodes between wired access points on a core network of a communications network |
US7072323B2 (en) * | 2001-08-15 | 2006-07-04 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for performing soft handoff in a wireless data network |
US20030039226A1 (en) * | 2001-08-24 | 2003-02-27 | Kwak Joseph A. | Physical layer automatic repeat request (ARQ) |
US7613458B2 (en) * | 2001-08-28 | 2009-11-03 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for enabling a radio node to selectably function as a router in a wireless communications network |
US7145903B2 (en) * | 2001-09-06 | 2006-12-05 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Multi-master bus architecture for system-on-chip designs |
WO2003023992A1 (en) * | 2001-09-07 | 2003-03-20 | Pulse-Link, Inc. | System and method for transmitting data in ultra wide band frequencies in a de-centralized system |
US7039400B2 (en) * | 2001-09-14 | 2006-05-02 | Atc Technologies, Llc | Systems and methods for monitoring terrestrially reused satellite frequencies to reduce potential interference |
US7593724B2 (en) * | 2001-09-14 | 2009-09-22 | Atc Technologies, Llc | Systems and methods for terrestrial reuse of cellular satellite frequency spectrum in a time-division duplex mode |
US7155340B2 (en) * | 2001-09-14 | 2006-12-26 | Atc Technologies, Llc | Network-assisted global positioning systems, methods and terminals including doppler shift and code phase estimates |
US7664460B2 (en) * | 2001-09-14 | 2010-02-16 | Atc Technologies, Llc | Systems and methods for terrestrial reuse of cellular satellite frequency spectrum in a time-division duplex and/or frequency-division duplex mode |
US7792069B2 (en) * | 2001-09-14 | 2010-09-07 | Atc Technologies, Llc | Systems and methods for terrestrial reuse of cellular satellite frequency spectrum using different channel separation technologies in forward and reverse links |
US7031702B2 (en) * | 2001-09-14 | 2006-04-18 | Atc Technologies, Llc | Additional systems and methods for monitoring terrestrially reused satellite frequencies to reduce potential interference |
US7603117B2 (en) | 2001-09-14 | 2009-10-13 | Atc Technologies, Llc | Systems and methods for terrestrial use of cellular satellite frequency spectrum |
US7062267B2 (en) * | 2001-09-14 | 2006-06-13 | Atc Technologies, Llc | Methods and systems for modifying satellite antenna cell patterns in response to terrestrial reuse of satellite frequencies |
US6684057B2 (en) * | 2001-09-14 | 2004-01-27 | Mobile Satellite Ventures, Lp | Systems and methods for terrestrial reuse of cellular satellite frequency spectrum |
WO2003028257A1 (en) * | 2001-09-24 | 2003-04-03 | Ydi Wireless, Inc. | Optical to microwave converter using direct modulation |
CA2461021A1 (en) * | 2001-09-25 | 2003-04-03 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | A system and method employing algorithms and protocols for optimizing carrier sense multiple access (csma) protocols in wireless networks |
US6754188B1 (en) | 2001-09-28 | 2004-06-22 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for enabling a node in an ad-hoc packet-switched wireless communications network to route packets based on packet content |
US8977284B2 (en) | 2001-10-04 | 2015-03-10 | Traxcell Technologies, LLC | Machine for providing a dynamic data base of geographic location information for a plurality of wireless devices and process for making same |
US6768730B1 (en) | 2001-10-11 | 2004-07-27 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for efficiently performing two-way ranging to determine the location of a wireless node in a communications network |
US6982964B2 (en) | 2001-10-15 | 2006-01-03 | Beering David R | High performance ECL-to-ATM protocol network gateway |
US7248559B2 (en) | 2001-10-17 | 2007-07-24 | Nortel Networks Limited | Scattered pilot pattern and channel estimation method for MIMO-OFDM systems |
US6982982B1 (en) | 2001-10-23 | 2006-01-03 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for providing a congestion optimized address resolution protocol for wireless ad-hoc networks |
US6771666B2 (en) | 2002-03-15 | 2004-08-03 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for trans-medium address resolution on an ad-hoc network with at least one highly disconnected medium having multiple access points to other media |
US6937602B2 (en) * | 2001-10-23 | 2005-08-30 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for providing a congestion optimized address resolution protocol for wireless ad-hoc networks |
US7130592B2 (en) * | 2001-10-31 | 2006-10-31 | Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. | Radio transmission apparatus and radio communication method |
US7181214B1 (en) | 2001-11-13 | 2007-02-20 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for determining the measure of mobility of a subscriber device in an ad-hoc wireless network with fixed wireless routers and wide area network (WAN) access points |
US7136587B1 (en) | 2001-11-15 | 2006-11-14 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for providing simulated hardware-in-the-loop testing of wireless communications networks |
US6728545B1 (en) | 2001-11-16 | 2004-04-27 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for computing the location of a mobile terminal in a wireless communications network |
US7221686B1 (en) | 2001-11-30 | 2007-05-22 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for computing the signal propagation time and the clock correction for mobile stations in a wireless network |
US6973296B2 (en) * | 2001-12-04 | 2005-12-06 | Intersil Americas Inc. | Soft decision gain compensation for receive filter attenuation |
JP3486618B2 (en) * | 2001-12-12 | 2004-01-13 | Smk株式会社 | Transmission / reception system with multiple remote controllers |
US7190672B1 (en) | 2001-12-19 | 2007-03-13 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for using destination-directed spreading codes in a multi-channel metropolitan area wireless communications network |
US6856953B1 (en) * | 2001-12-19 | 2005-02-15 | Globespanvirata, Inc. | Method and system for testing algorithm compliancy |
US7180875B1 (en) | 2001-12-20 | 2007-02-20 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for performing macro-diversity selection and distribution of routes for routing data packets in Ad-Hoc networks |
US7106707B1 (en) | 2001-12-20 | 2006-09-12 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for performing code and frequency channel selection for combined CDMA/FDMA spread spectrum communication systems |
US7280545B1 (en) | 2001-12-20 | 2007-10-09 | Nagle Darragh J | Complex adaptive routing system and method for a nodal communication network |
US7072618B1 (en) | 2001-12-21 | 2006-07-04 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Adaptive threshold selection system and method for detection of a signal in the presence of interference |
US7035628B2 (en) * | 2001-12-31 | 2006-04-25 | Xm Satellite Radio, Inc. | Method and apparatus for content blocking |
CA2480645C (en) | 2002-01-22 | 2016-09-06 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Allocating traffic channels in a communications system |
US10420097B2 (en) | 2002-01-22 | 2019-09-17 | Ipr Licensing, Inc. | Techniques for setting up traffic channels in a communications system |
US6674790B1 (en) | 2002-01-24 | 2004-01-06 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method employing concatenated spreading sequences to provide data modulated spread signals having increased data rates with extended multi-path delay spread |
US20050120208A1 (en) * | 2002-01-25 | 2005-06-02 | Albert Dobson Robert W. | Data transmission systems |
GB2384947B (en) * | 2002-02-01 | 2006-01-18 | Sendo Int Ltd | Enabling and/or inhibiting an operation of a wireless communicatons unit |
US6617990B1 (en) | 2002-03-06 | 2003-09-09 | Meshnetworks | Digital-to-analog converter using pseudo-random sequences and a method for using the same |
US7058018B1 (en) | 2002-03-06 | 2006-06-06 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for using per-packet receive signal strength indication and transmit power levels to compute path loss for a link for use in layer II routing in a wireless communication network |
US6714769B2 (en) * | 2002-03-08 | 2004-03-30 | Interdigital Technology Corporation | Method and system for implementing smart antennas and diversity techniques |
US6904021B2 (en) | 2002-03-15 | 2005-06-07 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for providing adaptive control of transmit power and data rate in an ad-hoc communication network |
EP1486085B1 (en) | 2002-03-15 | 2008-07-02 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for auto-configuration and discovery of ip to mac address mapping and gateway presence |
KR100449102B1 (en) * | 2002-03-19 | 2004-09-18 | 삼성전자주식회사 | System on chip processor for multimedia |
US20050097140A1 (en) * | 2002-03-22 | 2005-05-05 | Patrik Jarl | Method for processing data streams divided into a plurality of process steps |
US7463616B1 (en) * | 2002-03-28 | 2008-12-09 | Nortel Networks Limited | Scheduling based on channel change indicia |
US6987795B1 (en) | 2002-04-08 | 2006-01-17 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for selecting spreading codes based on multipath delay profile estimation for wireless transceivers in a communication network |
US7200149B1 (en) | 2002-04-12 | 2007-04-03 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for identifying potential hidden node problems in multi-hop wireless ad-hoc networks for the purpose of avoiding such potentially problem nodes in route selection |
US6580981B1 (en) | 2002-04-16 | 2003-06-17 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for providing wireless telematics store and forward messaging for peer-to-peer and peer-to-peer-to-infrastructure a communication network |
US7107498B1 (en) | 2002-04-16 | 2006-09-12 | Methnetworks, Inc. | System and method for identifying and maintaining reliable infrastructure links using bit error rate data in an ad-hoc communication network |
US6918489B2 (en) * | 2002-04-22 | 2005-07-19 | Ranpak Corp. | Dunnage converter system |
US7142524B2 (en) * | 2002-05-01 | 2006-11-28 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for using an ad-hoc routing algorithm based on activity detection in an ad-hoc network |
US6970444B2 (en) | 2002-05-13 | 2005-11-29 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for self propagating information in ad-hoc peer-to-peer networks |
US7284268B2 (en) | 2002-05-16 | 2007-10-16 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for a routing device to securely share network data with a host utilizing a hardware firewall |
US7016306B2 (en) | 2002-05-16 | 2006-03-21 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for performing multiple network routing and provisioning in overlapping wireless deployments |
US7167715B2 (en) * | 2002-05-17 | 2007-01-23 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for determining relative positioning in AD-HOC networks |
US7106703B1 (en) | 2002-05-28 | 2006-09-12 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for controlling pipeline delays by adjusting the power levels at which nodes in an ad-hoc network transmit data packets |
US6687259B2 (en) | 2002-06-05 | 2004-02-03 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | ARQ MAC for ad-hoc communication networks and a method for using the same |
US7054126B2 (en) * | 2002-06-05 | 2006-05-30 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for improving the accuracy of time of arrival measurements in a wireless ad-hoc communications network |
US6744766B2 (en) | 2002-06-05 | 2004-06-01 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Hybrid ARQ for a wireless Ad-Hoc network and a method for using the same |
US7610027B2 (en) * | 2002-06-05 | 2009-10-27 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Method and apparatus to maintain specification absorption rate at a wireless node |
US9125061B2 (en) * | 2002-06-07 | 2015-09-01 | Apple Inc. | Systems and methods for channel allocation for forward-link multi-user systems |
US6928065B2 (en) * | 2002-06-11 | 2005-08-09 | Motorola, Inc. | Methods of addressing and signaling a plurality of subscriber units in a single slot |
US7215638B1 (en) | 2002-06-19 | 2007-05-08 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method to provide 911 access in voice over internet protocol systems without compromising network security |
KR100548312B1 (en) * | 2002-06-20 | 2006-02-02 | 엘지전자 주식회사 | Signal Processing Method in Multiple Input / Output Mobile Communication System |
KR100487234B1 (en) * | 2002-07-02 | 2005-05-03 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Base station system for mobile telecommunication system |
US7072432B2 (en) * | 2002-07-05 | 2006-07-04 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for correcting the clock drift and maintaining the synchronization of low quality clocks in wireless networks |
US7118877B2 (en) * | 2002-07-08 | 2006-10-10 | Wyeth | Caspase 9 activation and uses therefor |
US7796570B1 (en) | 2002-07-12 | 2010-09-14 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Method for sparse table accounting and dissemination from a mobile subscriber device in a wireless mobile ad-hoc network |
US7046962B1 (en) | 2002-07-18 | 2006-05-16 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for improving the quality of range measurement based upon historical data |
US7042867B2 (en) | 2002-07-29 | 2006-05-09 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for determining physical location of a node in a wireless network during an authentication check of the node |
WO2004014001A1 (en) * | 2002-08-02 | 2004-02-12 | Nms Communications | Methods and apparatus for network signal aggregation and bandwidth reduction |
AU2003285138A1 (en) | 2002-11-04 | 2004-06-07 | Vivato Inc | Directed wireless communication |
KR100524735B1 (en) * | 2002-11-19 | 2005-10-31 | 엘지전자 주식회사 | Automatic control apparatus and method for td-scdma mobile terminal |
US7421342B2 (en) * | 2003-01-09 | 2008-09-02 | Atc Technologies, Llc | Network-assisted global positioning systems, methods and terminals including doppler shift and code phase estimates |
EP1584160B1 (en) | 2003-01-13 | 2011-07-06 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for achieving continuous connectivity to an access point or gateway in a wireless network following and on-demand routing protocol |
US6836227B2 (en) * | 2003-02-25 | 2004-12-28 | Advantest Corporation | Digitizer module, a waveform generating module, a converting method, a waveform generating method and a recording medium for recording a program thereof |
WO2004084022A2 (en) * | 2003-03-13 | 2004-09-30 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Real-time system and method for computing location of mobile subcriber in a wireless ad-hoc network |
US7171220B2 (en) | 2003-03-14 | 2007-01-30 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for analyzing the precision of geo-location services in a wireless network terminal |
KR100532311B1 (en) * | 2003-03-26 | 2005-11-29 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Apparatus for transmit diversity demodulation in mobile communication system and method thereof |
US20050002375A1 (en) * | 2003-05-07 | 2005-01-06 | Gokhale Dilip Shyamsundar | Advanced TDMA resource management architecture |
US7734809B2 (en) * | 2003-06-05 | 2010-06-08 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method to maximize channel utilization in a multi-channel wireless communication network |
WO2004110082A1 (en) * | 2003-06-05 | 2004-12-16 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for determining location of a device in a wireless communication network |
EP1652207A4 (en) * | 2003-06-05 | 2011-12-28 | Meshnetworks Inc | System and method for determining synchronization point in ofdm modems for accurate time of flight measurement |
EP1629677B1 (en) | 2003-06-05 | 2014-12-31 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Optimal routing in ad hoc wireless communication network |
EP1631915A4 (en) | 2003-06-06 | 2012-04-25 | Meshnetworks Inc | System and method for characterizing the quality of a link in a wireless network |
EP1632045B1 (en) | 2003-06-06 | 2013-08-21 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method to provide fairness and service differentiation in ad-hoc networks |
ATE529962T1 (en) * | 2003-06-06 | 2011-11-15 | Meshnetworks Inc | METHOD FOR IMPROVING THE OVERALL PERFORMANCE OF A WIRELESS COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK |
EP1632057B1 (en) | 2003-06-06 | 2014-07-23 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | Mac protocol for accurately computing the position of wireless devices inside buildings |
US7512103B1 (en) * | 2003-06-19 | 2009-03-31 | Rockwell Collins, In.C | Virtual channel communications system |
US20050224596A1 (en) * | 2003-07-08 | 2005-10-13 | Panopoulos Peter J | Machine that is an automatic pesticide, insecticide, repellant, poison, air freshener, disinfectant or other type of spray delivery system |
US6943699B2 (en) | 2003-07-23 | 2005-09-13 | Harris Corporation | Wireless engine monitoring system |
NZ545246A (en) * | 2003-08-13 | 2007-08-31 | Qualcomm Flarion Tech | Methods and apparatus of transmitting user data using traffic channels |
US20050100114A1 (en) * | 2003-09-12 | 2005-05-12 | Airbee Wireless, Inc. | System and method for data transmission |
US7881191B2 (en) * | 2003-11-12 | 2011-02-01 | Utstarcom (China) Co. Ltd. | Method and apparatus for downlink multi-channel packet combined scheduling in mobile communication system |
US7366202B2 (en) * | 2003-12-08 | 2008-04-29 | Colubris Networks, Inc. | System and method for interference mitigation for wireless communication |
US20070146157A1 (en) * | 2004-01-09 | 2007-06-28 | Michel Ramus | Method for communicating between an order transmitter and an order receiver-transmitter |
IL159838A0 (en) | 2004-01-13 | 2004-06-20 | Yehuda Binder | Information device |
US20050170808A1 (en) * | 2004-01-29 | 2005-08-04 | Hamilton Gordon E. | Radio interoperability system |
US7532673B2 (en) * | 2004-01-30 | 2009-05-12 | Scientific-Atlanta, Inc. | Transport of modulation symbols in a communications system |
JP3829851B2 (en) * | 2004-03-09 | 2006-10-04 | セイコーエプソン株式会社 | Data transfer control device and electronic device |
KR100989314B1 (en) * | 2004-04-09 | 2010-10-25 | 삼성전자주식회사 | Display device |
US20050238113A1 (en) * | 2004-04-26 | 2005-10-27 | John Santhoff | Hybrid communication method and apparatus |
IL161869A (en) | 2004-05-06 | 2014-05-28 | Serconet Ltd | System and method for carrying a wireless based signal over wiring |
US20060029017A1 (en) * | 2004-07-26 | 2006-02-09 | Beceem Communications Inc. | Method and system for transmitting training information in a block transmission system |
US7586097B2 (en) * | 2006-01-05 | 2009-09-08 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Switching micro-resonant structures using at least one director |
US7626179B2 (en) * | 2005-09-30 | 2009-12-01 | Virgin Island Microsystems, Inc. | Electron beam induced resonance |
US7791290B2 (en) * | 2005-09-30 | 2010-09-07 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Ultra-small resonating charged particle beam modulator |
EP1715612B1 (en) * | 2004-09-09 | 2011-08-10 | Panasonic Corporation | Transmitting apparatus, relaying apparatus, receiving apparatus and network system including these apparatus |
US7155214B2 (en) * | 2004-09-09 | 2006-12-26 | Dana Innovations | I-port controller |
US9576404B2 (en) | 2004-09-16 | 2017-02-21 | Harris Corporation | System and method of transmitting data from an aircraft |
US7620374B2 (en) * | 2004-09-16 | 2009-11-17 | Harris Corporation | System and method of transmitting data from an aircraft |
JP4411166B2 (en) * | 2004-09-21 | 2010-02-10 | 株式会社ケンウッド | Wireless communication system, wireless communication control device, wireless communication device, and wireless communication method |
US7167463B2 (en) * | 2004-10-07 | 2007-01-23 | Meshnetworks, Inc. | System and method for creating a spectrum agile wireless multi-hopping network |
JP4342425B2 (en) * | 2004-11-12 | 2009-10-14 | 富士通株式会社 | Wireless communication device |
DE102004057766B4 (en) * | 2004-11-30 | 2007-06-21 | Advanced Micro Devices, Inc., Sunnyvale | Radio interface control based on an event list specification |
US7573851B2 (en) | 2004-12-07 | 2009-08-11 | Adaptix, Inc. | Method and system for switching antenna and channel assignments in broadband wireless networks |
US7328012B2 (en) * | 2005-02-11 | 2008-02-05 | Harris Corporation | Aircraft communications system and related method for communicating between portable wireless communications device and ground |
US8462858B2 (en) * | 2005-02-18 | 2013-06-11 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Wireless communications with transceiver-integrated frequency shift control and power control |
US20060237384A1 (en) * | 2005-04-20 | 2006-10-26 | Eric Neumann | Track unit with removable partitions |
US7787411B2 (en) * | 2005-05-10 | 2010-08-31 | Microsoft Corporation | Gaming console wireless protocol for peripheral devices |
WO2006133268A2 (en) * | 2005-06-06 | 2006-12-14 | Signal Labs, Inc. | System and method for detection and discrimination of targets in the presence of interference |
KR100796941B1 (en) | 2005-07-05 | 2008-02-20 | 정영철 | Multi-signal remote control system for wireless communication and remote control method |
US20070025468A1 (en) * | 2005-07-28 | 2007-02-01 | Weidong Li | GMSK/8-PSK mix-mode support for GSM/GPRS/EDGE compliant handsets |
KR101199752B1 (en) | 2005-09-08 | 2012-11-08 | 더 유니버시티 코트 오브 더 유니버시티 오브 에딘버그 | Hybrid wireless communication system and communicating method thereof |
WO2007064358A2 (en) | 2005-09-30 | 2007-06-07 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Structures and methods for coupling energy from an electromagnetic wave |
US7664091B2 (en) * | 2005-10-03 | 2010-02-16 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and apparatus for control channel transmission and reception |
US8259840B2 (en) | 2005-10-24 | 2012-09-04 | General Motors Llc | Data communication via a voice channel of a wireless communication network using discontinuities |
US8194779B2 (en) * | 2005-10-24 | 2012-06-05 | General Motors Llc | Method for data communication via a voice channel of a wireless communication network |
US8194526B2 (en) * | 2005-10-24 | 2012-06-05 | General Motors Llc | Method for data communication via a voice channel of a wireless communication network |
US7545309B1 (en) * | 2005-11-03 | 2009-06-09 | L-3 Communications, Corp. | System and method for communicating low data rate information with a radar system |
CN100499613C (en) * | 2005-12-12 | 2009-06-10 | 傅岳 | Modulation/demodulation process and apparatus for transmitting data with PSTN channel using GSM voice channel |
US7579609B2 (en) * | 2005-12-14 | 2009-08-25 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Coupling light of light emitting resonator to waveguide |
EP1804540A1 (en) * | 2005-12-29 | 2007-07-04 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and apparatus for synchronizing adjacent communication cells |
US7619373B2 (en) * | 2006-01-05 | 2009-11-17 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Selectable frequency light emitter |
US7813451B2 (en) | 2006-01-11 | 2010-10-12 | Mobileaccess Networks Ltd. | Apparatus and method for frequency shifting of a wireless signal and systems using frequency shifting |
US8611300B2 (en) * | 2006-01-18 | 2013-12-17 | Motorola Mobility Llc | Method and apparatus for conveying control channel information in OFDMA system |
US7844879B2 (en) * | 2006-01-20 | 2010-11-30 | Marvell World Trade Ltd. | Method and system for error correction in flash memory |
CN101405811B (en) * | 2006-01-20 | 2012-01-04 | 马维尔国际贸易有限公司 | Flash memory with coding and signal processing |
US20070190794A1 (en) * | 2006-02-10 | 2007-08-16 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Conductive polymers for the electroplating |
US7847740B2 (en) * | 2006-02-13 | 2010-12-07 | Kyocera Corporation | Antenna system having receiver antenna diversity and configurable transmission antenna and method of management thereof |
US20070190950A1 (en) * | 2006-02-15 | 2007-08-16 | General Motors Corporation | Method of configuring voice and data communication over a voice channel |
US7605835B2 (en) * | 2006-02-28 | 2009-10-20 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Electro-photographic devices incorporating ultra-small resonant structures |
US7443358B2 (en) * | 2006-02-28 | 2008-10-28 | Virgin Island Microsystems, Inc. | Integrated filter in antenna-based detector |
US20070200646A1 (en) * | 2006-02-28 | 2007-08-30 | Virgin Island Microsystems, Inc. | Method for coupling out of a magnetic device |
US8045992B2 (en) * | 2006-03-20 | 2011-10-25 | Intel Corporation | Uplink and downlink control signaling in wireless networks |
US7558490B2 (en) * | 2006-04-10 | 2009-07-07 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Resonant detector for optical signals |
EP1848135B1 (en) | 2006-04-19 | 2012-02-22 | Motorola Mobility, Inc. | Multislot packet data transfer method |
US20070252089A1 (en) * | 2006-04-26 | 2007-11-01 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Charged particle acceleration apparatus and method |
US7646991B2 (en) * | 2006-04-26 | 2010-01-12 | Virgin Island Microsystems, Inc. | Selectable frequency EMR emitter |
US7876793B2 (en) * | 2006-04-26 | 2011-01-25 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Micro free electron laser (FEL) |
US20070264023A1 (en) * | 2006-04-26 | 2007-11-15 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Free space interchip communications |
US7656094B2 (en) | 2006-05-05 | 2010-02-02 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Electron accelerator for ultra-small resonant structures |
US7728397B2 (en) | 2006-05-05 | 2010-06-01 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Coupled nano-resonating energy emitting structures |
US7583370B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2009-09-01 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Resonant structures and methods for encoding signals into surface plasmons |
US7728702B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2010-06-01 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Shielding of integrated circuit package with high-permeability magnetic material |
US7746532B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2010-06-29 | Virgin Island Microsystems, Inc. | Electro-optical switching system and method |
US7710040B2 (en) | 2006-05-05 | 2010-05-04 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Single layer construction for ultra small devices |
US7569836B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2009-08-04 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Transmission of data between microchips using a particle beam |
US8188431B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2012-05-29 | Jonathan Gorrell | Integration of vacuum microelectronic device with integrated circuit |
US7586167B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2009-09-08 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Detecting plasmons using a metallurgical junction |
US20070272931A1 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2007-11-29 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Methods, devices and systems producing illumination and effects |
US7723698B2 (en) | 2006-05-05 | 2010-05-25 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Top metal layer shield for ultra-small resonant structures |
US7554083B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2009-06-30 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Integration of electromagnetic detector on integrated chip |
US7732786B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2010-06-08 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Coupling energy in a plasmon wave to an electron beam |
US7718977B2 (en) | 2006-05-05 | 2010-05-18 | Virgin Island Microsystems, Inc. | Stray charged particle removal device |
US20070257273A1 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2007-11-08 | Virgin Island Microsystems, Inc. | Novel optical cover for optical chip |
US7557647B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2009-07-07 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Heterodyne receiver using resonant structures |
US7986113B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2011-07-26 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Selectable frequency light emitter |
US7741934B2 (en) * | 2006-05-05 | 2010-06-22 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Coupling a signal through a window |
US7573045B2 (en) * | 2006-05-15 | 2009-08-11 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Plasmon wave propagation devices and methods |
US7679067B2 (en) * | 2006-05-26 | 2010-03-16 | Virgin Island Microsystems, Inc. | Receiver array using shared electron beam |
US7655934B2 (en) | 2006-06-28 | 2010-02-02 | Virgin Island Microsystems, Inc. | Data on light bulb |
DE102006032495A1 (en) * | 2006-07-13 | 2008-02-07 | Nokia Siemens Networks Gmbh & Co.Kg | Method and apparatus for avoiding interference in a cellular radio communication system |
US7925230B2 (en) | 2006-08-25 | 2011-04-12 | Infineon Technologies Ag | Diversity receiver with channel estimator |
TWI371925B (en) * | 2006-09-08 | 2012-09-01 | Via Tech Inc | Apparatus for processing multiple signals with a single analog-to-digital converter and method thereof |
US7560716B2 (en) * | 2006-09-22 | 2009-07-14 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Free electron oscillator |
US8031651B2 (en) | 2006-09-29 | 2011-10-04 | Broadcom Corporation | Method and system for minimizing power consumption in a communication system |
US8396044B2 (en) * | 2006-09-29 | 2013-03-12 | Broadcom Corporation | Method and system for antenna architecture for WCDMA/HSDPA/HSUDPA diversity and enhanced GSM/GPRS/edge performance |
US7689188B2 (en) * | 2006-09-29 | 2010-03-30 | Broadcom Corporation | Method and system for dynamically tuning and calibrating an antenna using antenna hopping |
US8116259B2 (en) * | 2006-09-29 | 2012-02-14 | Broadcom Corporation | Method and system for diversity processing based on antenna switching |
US20080084853A1 (en) | 2006-10-04 | 2008-04-10 | Motorola, Inc. | Radio resource assignment in control channel in wireless communication systems |
US7778307B2 (en) * | 2006-10-04 | 2010-08-17 | Motorola, Inc. | Allocation of control channel for radio resource assignment in wireless communication systems |
JP4847270B2 (en) * | 2006-10-12 | 2011-12-28 | キヤノン株式会社 | Facsimile device, control method therefor, program, and storage medium |
KR101386211B1 (en) * | 2006-11-02 | 2014-04-17 | 한국전자통신연구원 | Method of access-uplink power control using mobile multi-hop relay and system thereof |
US7659513B2 (en) * | 2006-12-20 | 2010-02-09 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Low terahertz source and detector |
WO2008094701A1 (en) * | 2007-01-31 | 2008-08-07 | Signal Labs, Inc. | System and methods for multistep target detection and parameter estimation |
US8948757B2 (en) | 2007-03-21 | 2015-02-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for RF handoff in a multi-frequency network |
US8737353B2 (en) * | 2007-03-21 | 2014-05-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for RF handoff in a multi-frequency network |
US8457064B2 (en) * | 2007-03-21 | 2013-06-04 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for RF handoff in a multi-frequency network |
US8737350B2 (en) * | 2007-03-21 | 2014-05-27 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for RF handoff in a multi-frequency network |
US8750248B2 (en) * | 2007-03-21 | 2014-06-10 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for RF handoff in a multi-frequency network |
US9048784B2 (en) | 2007-04-03 | 2015-06-02 | General Motors Llc | Method for data communication via a voice channel of a wireless communication network using continuous signal modulation |
US8565799B2 (en) * | 2007-04-04 | 2013-10-22 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and apparatus for flow data acquisition in a multi-frequency network |
US7912149B2 (en) * | 2007-05-03 | 2011-03-22 | General Motors Llc | Synchronization and segment type detection method for data transmission via an audio communication system |
US7990336B2 (en) * | 2007-06-19 | 2011-08-02 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Microwave coupled excitation of solid state resonant arrays |
US7936705B1 (en) * | 2007-08-16 | 2011-05-03 | Avaya Inc. | Multiplexing VoIP streams for conferencing and selective playback of audio streams |
US7791053B2 (en) | 2007-10-10 | 2010-09-07 | Virgin Islands Microsystems, Inc. | Depressed anode with plasmon-enabled devices such as ultra-small resonant structures |
JP5185390B2 (en) * | 2007-10-20 | 2013-04-17 | エアビクティ インコーポレイテッド | Wireless in-band signaling method and system using in-vehicle system |
WO2009053910A2 (en) | 2007-10-22 | 2009-04-30 | Mobileaccess Networks Ltd. | Communication system using low bandwidth wires |
US8175649B2 (en) | 2008-06-20 | 2012-05-08 | Corning Mobileaccess Ltd | Method and system for real time control of an active antenna over a distributed antenna system |
US7953028B2 (en) * | 2008-01-14 | 2011-05-31 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Methods and apparatus for improved receiver performance in half-duplex wireless terminals |
US7978610B1 (en) | 2008-01-24 | 2011-07-12 | L-3 Communications Corp. | Method for asynchronous transmission of communication data between periodically blanked terminals |
US8130680B1 (en) | 2008-01-24 | 2012-03-06 | L-3 Communications, Corp. | Method for timing a pulsed communication system |
US8570939B2 (en) * | 2008-03-07 | 2013-10-29 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Methods and systems for choosing cyclic delays in multiple antenna OFDM systems |
US8315229B2 (en) * | 2008-07-07 | 2012-11-20 | Research In Motion Limited | Methods and apparatus for wireless communication |
US8811339B2 (en) * | 2008-07-07 | 2014-08-19 | Blackberry Limited | Handover schemes for wireless systems |
US8355387B2 (en) * | 2008-07-24 | 2013-01-15 | Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. | System and method for bandwidth reservation protocol for spatial reuse in a wireless communication network |
CN102209942A (en) * | 2008-09-06 | 2011-10-05 | 洛德公司 | Motion control system with digital processing link |
US8594138B2 (en) | 2008-09-15 | 2013-11-26 | Airbiquity Inc. | Methods for in-band signaling through enhanced variable-rate codecs |
US20100093389A1 (en) * | 2008-10-14 | 2010-04-15 | Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications Ab | Responding to a paging request from a gsm network by setting up the call through a umts network |
US8332264B1 (en) * | 2008-10-22 | 2012-12-11 | Sprint Communications Company L.P. | Method and system for visualizing and analyzing spectrum assets |
US8514793B2 (en) | 2008-10-31 | 2013-08-20 | Interdigital Patent Holdings, Inc. | Method and apparatus for monitoring and processing component carriers |
WO2010089719A1 (en) | 2009-02-08 | 2010-08-12 | Mobileaccess Networks Ltd. | Communication system using cables carrying ethernet signals |
US11223459B2 (en) | 2009-02-10 | 2022-01-11 | Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) | Mapping user data onto a time-frequency resource grid in a coordinated multi-point wireless communication system |
US8837396B2 (en) | 2009-02-10 | 2014-09-16 | Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson (Publ) | Mapping user data onto a time-frequency resource grid in a coordinated multi-point wireless communication sytem |
US8743823B2 (en) * | 2009-02-12 | 2014-06-03 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Transmission with collision detection and mitigation for wireless communication |
US20100252514A1 (en) * | 2009-04-03 | 2010-10-07 | Min-Ju Chung | Foldable baseball equipment rack |
US8374214B2 (en) * | 2009-04-13 | 2013-02-12 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Frequency-hopping scheme |
US8073440B2 (en) | 2009-04-27 | 2011-12-06 | Airbiquity, Inc. | Automatic gain control in a personal navigation device |
US8964720B2 (en) * | 2009-06-03 | 2015-02-24 | Via Telecom Co., Ltd. | MIMO OFDMA and preamble design |
US8418039B2 (en) | 2009-08-03 | 2013-04-09 | Airbiquity Inc. | Efficient error correction scheme for data transmission in a wireless in-band signaling system |
US8811200B2 (en) | 2009-09-22 | 2014-08-19 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Physical layer metrics to support adaptive station-dependent channel state information feedback rate in multi-user communication systems |
US8249865B2 (en) * | 2009-11-23 | 2012-08-21 | Airbiquity Inc. | Adaptive data transmission for a digital in-band modem operating over a voice channel |
ES2566974T3 (en) | 2010-02-23 | 2016-04-18 | Alcatel Lucent | Feedback of channel status information |
US20110248823A1 (en) * | 2010-04-07 | 2011-10-13 | Kristian Silberbauer | Asset identification and tracking system and method |
US8644295B2 (en) | 2010-04-30 | 2014-02-04 | Motorola Solutions, Inc. | Methods for fade detection and fade recovery in a wireless communication system |
US8694703B2 (en) | 2010-06-09 | 2014-04-08 | Brocade Communications Systems, Inc. | Hardware-accelerated lossless data compression |
US9401967B2 (en) | 2010-06-09 | 2016-07-26 | Brocade Communications Systems, Inc. | Inline wire speed deduplication system |
WO2012019080A1 (en) * | 2010-08-06 | 2012-02-09 | Acquire Media Ventures Inc. | Method and system for pacing, ack'ing, timing, and handicapping (path) for simultaneous receipt of documents |
US9225509B2 (en) | 2010-11-02 | 2015-12-29 | Motorola Solutions, Inc. | Method and apparatus for achieving synchronization in a wireless communication system |
US8437334B2 (en) * | 2010-11-30 | 2013-05-07 | Motorola Solutions, Inc. | Methods and apparatus for method for maintaining a radio link at a mobile radio |
JP2012195687A (en) * | 2011-03-15 | 2012-10-11 | Tokai Rika Co Ltd | Transmitter, receiver, and communication system |
EP2570931A1 (en) * | 2011-09-14 | 2013-03-20 | VEGA Grieshaber KG | Method for asynchronous-serial data transfer over a synchronous-serial interface |
US8848825B2 (en) | 2011-09-22 | 2014-09-30 | Airbiquity Inc. | Echo cancellation in wireless inband signaling modem |
WO2013142662A2 (en) | 2012-03-23 | 2013-09-26 | Corning Mobile Access Ltd. | Radio-frequency integrated circuit (rfic) chip(s) for providing distributed antenna system functionalities, and related components, systems, and methods |
US9816897B2 (en) | 2012-06-06 | 2017-11-14 | Harris Corporation | Wireless engine monitoring system and associated engine wireless sensor network |
US9152146B2 (en) | 2012-06-06 | 2015-10-06 | Harris Corporation | Wireless engine monitoring system and associated engine wireless sensor network |
US9026279B2 (en) | 2012-06-06 | 2015-05-05 | Harris Corporation | Wireless engine monitoring system and configurable wireless engine sensors |
US9026273B2 (en) | 2012-06-06 | 2015-05-05 | Harris Corporation | Wireless engine monitoring system with multiple hop aircraft communications capability and on-board processing of engine data |
CN103596106B (en) * | 2012-08-16 | 2016-09-21 | 立锜科技股份有限公司 | Audio signal processing circuit and method |
US9219938B2 (en) * | 2012-11-01 | 2015-12-22 | Wheatstone Corporation | System and method for routing digital audio data using highly stable clocks |
US9526074B2 (en) | 2013-03-15 | 2016-12-20 | Google Technology Holdings LLC | Methods and apparatus for determining a transmit antenna gain and a spatial mode of a device |
CN103167490B (en) * | 2013-04-12 | 2016-03-02 | 中国人民解放军信息工程大学 | Wireless key distribution method, Apparatus and system |
FR3008265B1 (en) * | 2013-07-02 | 2015-07-03 | Bluwan | SYSTEM FOR PRODUCING SIMULTANEOUS MULTI LINK DIRECTIVE BEAMS |
US9287920B2 (en) * | 2013-07-05 | 2016-03-15 | Broadcom Corporation | Diplexer elimination in microwave point-to-point FDD systems |
US9166627B2 (en) * | 2013-08-07 | 2015-10-20 | International Business Machines Corporation | Combination error and erasure decoding for product codes |
DE102013108713B8 (en) | 2013-08-12 | 2016-10-13 | WebID Solutions GmbH | Method for verifying the identity of a user |
US9184960B1 (en) | 2014-09-25 | 2015-11-10 | Corning Optical Communications Wireless Ltd | Frequency shifting a communications signal(s) in a multi-frequency distributed antenna system (DAS) to avoid or reduce frequency interference |
GB2531803B (en) * | 2014-10-31 | 2017-12-20 | Cirrus Logic Int Semiconductor Ltd | Digital accessory interface |
US10152442B2 (en) * | 2015-02-27 | 2018-12-11 | Google Llc | Multi-function ports on a computing device |
US10282337B2 (en) | 2015-02-27 | 2019-05-07 | Google Llc | Multi-function ports on a computing device |
US9491758B2 (en) * | 2015-04-07 | 2016-11-08 | Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. | System for alignment of RF signals |
US9517803B2 (en) * | 2015-04-14 | 2016-12-13 | GM Global Technology Operations LLC | Vehicle having rear spoiler with active vertical side plates, and method of controlling the same |
US10663558B2 (en) | 2015-05-22 | 2020-05-26 | Schneider Electric It Corporation | Systems and methods for detecting physical asset locations |
GB2539443B (en) * | 2015-06-16 | 2020-02-12 | Advanced Risc Mach Ltd | A transmitter, a receiver, a data transfer system and a method of data transfer |
PL3107218T3 (en) * | 2015-06-19 | 2023-10-09 | Gwf Ag | Method and device for transmitting data and counter unit |
JP7003658B2 (en) * | 2015-10-01 | 2022-01-20 | ソニーグループ株式会社 | Equipment, methods and programs |
US10149226B2 (en) * | 2016-03-15 | 2018-12-04 | King Fahd University Of Petroleum And Minerals | ID-based routing protocol for wireless network with a grid topology |
US10664745B2 (en) | 2016-06-29 | 2020-05-26 | International Business Machines Corporation | Resistive processing units and neural network training methods |
US10154539B2 (en) * | 2016-08-19 | 2018-12-11 | Sony Corporation | System and method for sharing cellular network for call routing |
CN106647432A (en) * | 2016-08-31 | 2017-05-10 | 中国人民解放军63892部队 | Multi-channel radio frequency signal delay device and multi-channel radio frequency signal delay method based on radio frequency signals |
US20180213547A1 (en) * | 2017-01-26 | 2018-07-26 | Electronics And Telecommunications Research Instit Ute | Communication node for scheduling and interference control in wireless communication network, and operation method therefor |
CN108633055B (en) * | 2017-03-24 | 2022-02-25 | 华为技术有限公司 | Information transmission method and communication equipment |
JP6744343B2 (en) * | 2018-02-15 | 2020-08-19 | 日本電信電話株式会社 | Communication transmission apparatus and voice quality determination method for communication transmission apparatus |
USD905059S1 (en) | 2018-07-25 | 2020-12-15 | Square, Inc. | Card reader device |
US10937443B2 (en) * | 2018-09-04 | 2021-03-02 | Babblelabs Llc | Data driven radio enhancement |
GB201820161D0 (en) * | 2018-12-11 | 2019-01-23 | Nordic Semiconductor Asa | Radio devices with switchable antennas |
US11239874B2 (en) * | 2020-01-30 | 2022-02-01 | Deeyook Location Technologies Ltd. | System, apparatus, and method for providing wireless communication and a location tag |
US10976709B1 (en) | 2020-03-30 | 2021-04-13 | Stmicroelectronics (Research & Development) Limited | Latched gray code for ToF applications |
Citations (93)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US2070418A (en) * | 1933-05-19 | 1937-02-09 | Rca Corp | Multiplex cable code telegraphy with diversity reception |
US2941038A (en) * | 1953-10-26 | 1960-06-14 | Iwatsu Electric Co Ltd | Multiplex telephone system |
US3230458A (en) * | 1962-05-18 | 1966-01-18 | Collins Radio Co | Automatic gain control circuit with fast change of time constant |
US3497627A (en) * | 1966-04-15 | 1970-02-24 | Ibm | Rate conversion system |
US3499995A (en) * | 1966-06-22 | 1970-03-10 | British Telecommunications Res | Frequency and time division multiplex signalling systems using successive changes of frequency band and time slot |
US3505479A (en) * | 1967-12-21 | 1970-04-07 | Us Army | Multiplex system with number of channels controlled according to signal-to-noise ratio |
US3564147A (en) * | 1968-04-05 | 1971-02-16 | Communications Satellite Corp | Local routing channel sharing system and method for communications via a satellite relay |
US3573379A (en) * | 1969-03-03 | 1971-04-06 | Bendix Corp | Communications system with frequency and time division techniques |
US3576398A (en) * | 1966-07-26 | 1971-04-27 | Int Standard Electric Corp | Path hunting circuit in a telephone network with a centralized control unit |
US3634627A (en) * | 1969-07-23 | 1972-01-11 | Sits Soc It Telecom Siemens | Channel-allocation system for a channel-addressing multiple-access telecommunication system |
US3639739A (en) * | 1969-02-05 | 1972-02-01 | North American Rockwell | Digital low pass filter |
US3641274A (en) * | 1968-10-11 | 1972-02-08 | Kokusai Denshin Denwa Co Ltd | Synchronization system for communication information in pcm time division multiple access communication system |
US3643031A (en) * | 1968-09-16 | 1972-02-15 | Kokusai Denshin Denwa Co Ltd | Time division multiplexing communication system |
US3644678A (en) * | 1969-03-21 | 1972-02-22 | Communications Satellite Corp | Channel reallocation system and method |
US3654395A (en) * | 1969-10-15 | 1972-04-04 | Communications Satellite Corp | Synchronization of tdma space division satellite system |
US3710027A (en) * | 1969-11-22 | 1973-01-09 | Int Standard Electric Corp | System of time-division multiplex transmission via communications satellites |
US3740476A (en) * | 1971-07-09 | 1973-06-19 | Bell Telephone Labor Inc | Speech signal pitch detector using prediction error data |
US3742495A (en) * | 1966-11-07 | 1973-06-26 | Goodyear Aerospace Corp | Drone guidance system and method |
US3806879A (en) * | 1971-08-11 | 1974-04-23 | Communications Satellite Corp | Tdma satellite communication system with multi-pcm frames per tdma frame |
US3812430A (en) * | 1971-08-11 | 1974-05-21 | Communications Satellite Corp | Tdma satellite communications system with improved acquisition |
US3818453A (en) * | 1971-08-11 | 1974-06-18 | Communications Satellite Corp | Tdma satellite communications system |
US3820112A (en) * | 1973-10-01 | 1974-06-25 | A Roth | High speed analog-to-digital conversion system |
US3864524A (en) * | 1971-10-30 | 1975-02-04 | Electronic Communications | Asynchronous multiplexing of digitized speech |
US3889063A (en) * | 1971-08-19 | 1975-06-10 | Phonplex Corp | Multiplexed digital data communication system |
US3891959A (en) * | 1972-12-29 | 1975-06-24 | Fujitsu Ltd | Coding system for differential phase modulation |
US3932821A (en) * | 1974-11-08 | 1976-01-13 | Narco Scientific Industries, Inc. | Out of lock detector for phase lock loop synthesizer |
US3959595A (en) * | 1975-01-09 | 1976-05-25 | Sperry Rand Corporation | Digital signal multiplexer/concentrator |
US4004226A (en) * | 1975-07-23 | 1977-01-18 | Codex Corporation | QAM receiver having automatic adaptive equalizer |
US4009347A (en) * | 1974-12-30 | 1977-02-22 | International Business Machines Corporation | Modular branch exchange and nodal access units for multiple access systems |
US4009344A (en) * | 1974-12-30 | 1977-02-22 | International Business Machines Corporation | Inter-related switching, activity compression and demand assignment |
US4009343A (en) * | 1974-12-30 | 1977-02-22 | International Business Machines Corporation | Switching and activity compression between telephone lines and digital communication channels |
US4009345A (en) * | 1974-12-30 | 1977-02-22 | International Business Machines Corporation | External management of satellite linked exchange network |
US4013840A (en) * | 1972-05-15 | 1977-03-22 | Teleplex, Inc. | Tdm and fdm telephone communication |
US4020461A (en) * | 1975-11-18 | 1977-04-26 | Trw Inc. | Method of and apparatus for transmitting and receiving coded digital signals |
US4020332A (en) * | 1975-09-24 | 1977-04-26 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Interpolation-decimation circuit for increasing or decreasing digital sampling frequency |
US4021616A (en) * | 1976-01-08 | 1977-05-03 | Ncr Corporation | Interpolating rate multiplier |
US4027243A (en) * | 1975-05-12 | 1977-05-31 | General Electric Company | Message generator for a controlled radio transmitter and receiver |
US4031330A (en) * | 1974-06-10 | 1977-06-21 | U.S. Philips Corporation | Digital radio transmission system |
US4071711A (en) * | 1974-08-02 | 1978-01-31 | Farinon Electric Of Canada Ltd. | Telephone subscriber distribution system |
US4079371A (en) * | 1975-05-24 | 1978-03-14 | Nippon Electric Company, Ltd. | Rate converter for digital signals having a negative feedback phase lock loop |
US4086536A (en) * | 1975-06-24 | 1978-04-25 | Honeywell Inc. | Single sideband transmitter apparatus |
US4133976A (en) * | 1978-04-07 | 1979-01-09 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Predictive speech signal coding with reduced noise effects |
US4143246A (en) * | 1977-09-06 | 1979-03-06 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Time division line interface circuit |
US4184049A (en) * | 1978-08-25 | 1980-01-15 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Transform speech signal coding with pitch controlled adaptive quantizing |
US4193031A (en) * | 1978-03-13 | 1980-03-11 | Purdue Research Foundation | Method of signal transmission and reception utilizing wideband signals |
US4208632A (en) * | 1978-06-30 | 1980-06-17 | Raytheon Company | Radar receiver |
US4251865A (en) * | 1978-12-08 | 1981-02-17 | Motorola, Inc. | Polling system for a duplex communications link |
US4253188A (en) * | 1979-06-07 | 1981-02-24 | Ford Motor Company | Clock synchronization for data communication receiver |
US4256925A (en) * | 1978-12-12 | 1981-03-17 | Satellite Business Systems | Capacity reallocation method and apparatus for a TDMA satellite communication network with demand assignment of channels |
US4272845A (en) * | 1978-10-18 | 1981-06-09 | Societa Italiana Telecomunicazion Siemens Spa | Receiver for data-transmission system operating with single-sideband amplitude modulation |
US4309764A (en) * | 1979-06-22 | 1982-01-05 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Technique for increasing the rain margin of a satellite communication system |
US4320517A (en) * | 1980-03-19 | 1982-03-16 | International Business Machines Corp. | Method and device for effecting the initial adjustment of the clock in a synchronous data receiver |
US4328585A (en) * | 1980-04-02 | 1982-05-04 | Signatron, Inc. | Fast adapting fading channel equalizer |
US4335446A (en) * | 1977-05-02 | 1982-06-15 | Cselt - Centro Studi E Laboratori Telecomunicazioni S.P.A. | Terminal equipment for data-transmission network including digitally operating modem |
US4377860A (en) * | 1981-01-05 | 1983-03-22 | American Microsystems, Inc. | Bandwidth reduction method and structure for combining voice and data in a PCM channel |
US4389722A (en) * | 1979-09-13 | 1983-06-21 | Licentia Patent-Verwaltungs-Gmbh | Method for the simultaneous transmission of a plurality of data stream over one transmission channel |
US4425639A (en) * | 1981-01-12 | 1984-01-10 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Satellite communications system with frequency channelized beams |
US4430743A (en) * | 1980-11-17 | 1984-02-07 | Nippon Electric Co., Ltd. | Fast start-up system for transversal equalizers |
US4437087A (en) * | 1982-01-27 | 1984-03-13 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Adaptive differential PCM coding |
US4437183A (en) * | 1981-01-12 | 1984-03-13 | General Datacomm Industries, Inc. | Method and apparatus for distributing control signals |
US4443661A (en) * | 1980-10-31 | 1984-04-17 | Nippon Electric Co., Ltd. | Method of detecting troubles in a receiver for a common control channel of a mobile radio telephone communication system and a system therefor |
US4445213A (en) * | 1979-07-31 | 1984-04-24 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Communication line interface for controlling data information having differing transmission characteristics |
US4449250A (en) * | 1981-12-21 | 1984-05-15 | Motorola, Inc. | Radio-frequency synthesizer for duplex radios |
US4455649A (en) * | 1982-01-15 | 1984-06-19 | International Business Machines Corporation | Method and apparatus for efficient statistical multiplexing of voice and data signals |
US4495619A (en) * | 1981-10-23 | 1985-01-22 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Transmitter and receivers using resource sharing and coding for increased capacity |
US4503510A (en) * | 1980-10-31 | 1985-03-05 | Sri International | Method and apparatus for digital data compression |
US4507781A (en) * | 1980-03-14 | 1985-03-26 | Ibm Corporation | Time domain multiple access broadcasting, multipoint, and conferencing communication apparatus and method |
US4510595A (en) * | 1983-10-03 | 1985-04-09 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Modified time-division transmission technique for digital mobile radio systems |
US4519073A (en) * | 1983-06-20 | 1985-05-21 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Bit compression multiplexer |
US4525835A (en) * | 1981-10-13 | 1985-06-25 | International Standard Electric Corporation | Duplex radio system utilizing time compression expansion |
US4567591A (en) * | 1983-08-01 | 1986-01-28 | Gray James S | Digital audio satellite transmission system |
US4578815A (en) * | 1983-12-07 | 1986-03-25 | Motorola, Inc. | Wide area coverage radio communication system and method |
US4584693A (en) * | 1982-11-23 | 1986-04-22 | Compagnie Industrielle Des Telecommunications Cit-Alcatel | QPSK system with one cycle per Baud period |
US4587662A (en) * | 1983-01-28 | 1986-05-06 | International Standard Electric Corporation | TDMA spread-spectrum receiver with coherent detection |
US4597105A (en) * | 1982-11-12 | 1986-06-24 | Motorola Inc. | Data communications system having overlapping receiver coverage zones |
US4637036A (en) * | 1983-05-20 | 1987-01-13 | Victor Company Of Japan, Limited | Circuit arrangement for a data acquisition circuit of a PCM processor and a method for improving waveform of PCM signal eye pattern |
US4638479A (en) * | 1983-12-09 | 1987-01-20 | U.S. Philips Corporation | Method of two-way radiocommunication between fixed stations and mobile stations |
US4639914A (en) * | 1984-12-06 | 1987-01-27 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Wireless PBX/LAN system with optimum combining |
US4642806A (en) * | 1983-09-07 | 1987-02-10 | British Telecommunications Public Limited Company | Communications network having a single node and a plurality of outstations |
US4644534A (en) * | 1984-07-03 | 1987-02-17 | Ant Nachrichtentechnik Gmbh | TDMA point-to-multipoint communications system and its use |
US4644535A (en) * | 1984-04-26 | 1987-02-17 | Data General Corp. | PCM channel multiplexer/demultiplexer |
US4656653A (en) * | 1985-04-30 | 1987-04-07 | Nec Corporation | Cordless telephone apparatus having means for synchronizing channel scanning of fixed and portable units |
US4675863A (en) * | 1985-03-20 | 1987-06-23 | International Mobile Machines Corp. | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US4741018A (en) * | 1987-04-24 | 1988-04-26 | Motorola, Inc. | Speakerphone using digitally compressed audio to control voice path gain |
US4742550A (en) * | 1984-09-17 | 1988-05-03 | Motorola, Inc. | 4800 BPS interoperable relp system |
US4754450A (en) * | 1986-03-25 | 1988-06-28 | Motorola, Inc. | TDM communication system for efficient spectrum utilization |
US4797947A (en) * | 1987-05-01 | 1989-01-10 | Motorola, Inc. | Microcellular communications system using macrodiversity |
US4811420A (en) * | 1987-07-08 | 1989-03-07 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Initialization of communication channel between a subsciber station and a base station in a subscriber communication system |
US4825448A (en) * | 1986-08-07 | 1989-04-25 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Subscriber unit for wireless digital telephone system |
US4843621A (en) * | 1987-04-24 | 1989-06-27 | Motorola, Inc. | Speakerphone using digitally compressed audio to detect acoustic feedback |
US4843612A (en) * | 1980-06-23 | 1989-06-27 | Siemens Aktiengesellschaft | Method for jam-resistant communication transmission |
US4918746A (en) * | 1987-05-15 | 1990-04-17 | Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba | Communication system with mobile stations |
US5124985A (en) * | 1988-12-13 | 1992-06-23 | Small Power Communication Systems Research Laboratories Co., Ltd. | Radiocommunication system using time-division digital frames |
Family Cites Families (174)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US32580A (en) * | 1861-06-18 | Water-elevatok | ||
US2808504A (en) * | 1955-03-22 | 1957-10-01 | Rca Corp | Single sideband transmitting and receiving unit |
US3150374A (en) * | 1959-06-25 | 1964-09-22 | David E Sunstein | Multichannel signaling system and method |
US3332016A (en) * | 1963-11-05 | 1967-07-18 | Viktor J Pokorny | Single sideband transceiver system |
US3341776A (en) * | 1964-01-13 | 1967-09-12 | Collins Radio Co | Error sensitive binary transmission system wherein four channels are transmitted via one carrier wave |
US3348150A (en) * | 1964-07-27 | 1967-10-17 | Bell Telephone Labor Inc | Diversity transmission system |
US3370235A (en) | 1964-09-11 | 1968-02-20 | Nippon Electric Co | Dual pilot frequency-correcting terminal stations for satellite repeater system |
US3471646A (en) * | 1965-02-08 | 1969-10-07 | Motorola Inc | Time division multiplex system with prearranged carrier frequency shifts |
US3363193A (en) | 1966-02-18 | 1968-01-09 | Varian Associates | Adjustable frequency atomic frequency standard |
US3534264A (en) * | 1966-04-15 | 1970-10-13 | Ibm | Adaptive digital communication system |
US3529243A (en) * | 1967-10-11 | 1970-09-15 | Us Army | Synchronous tactical radio communication system |
US3532985A (en) * | 1968-03-13 | 1970-10-06 | Nasa | Time division radio relay synchronizing system using different sync code words for "in sync" and "out of sync" conditions |
US3631520A (en) * | 1968-08-19 | 1971-12-28 | Bell Telephone Labor Inc | Predictive coding of speech signals |
US3546684A (en) * | 1968-08-20 | 1970-12-08 | Nasa | Programmable telemetry system |
JPS5125688B1 (en) * | 1968-12-10 | 1976-08-02 | ||
JPS5011735B1 (en) * | 1968-12-10 | 1975-05-06 | ||
US3683116A (en) * | 1969-07-16 | 1972-08-08 | Communications Satellite Corp | Terrestrial interface unit |
NL7000939A (en) | 1970-01-23 | 1970-03-23 | Philips Nv | |
DE2020094C3 (en) * | 1970-04-24 | 1973-11-22 | Siemens Ag, 1000 Berlin U. 8000 Muenchen | Time division multiplex system for night transmission between several ground stations via at least one satellite equipped with a relay station |
US3742498A (en) * | 1970-05-06 | 1973-06-26 | Itt | Synchronization and position location system |
US3750024A (en) * | 1971-06-16 | 1973-07-31 | Itt Corp Nutley | Narrow band digital speech communication system |
US3836726A (en) * | 1971-10-25 | 1974-09-17 | Martin Marietta Corp | Data transmission method and apparatus |
GB1364808A (en) * | 1971-12-08 | 1974-08-29 | Sendai Television Broadcasting | Simultaneous radio communication system |
LU67187A1 (en) | 1972-03-10 | 1973-06-15 | ||
US3829670A (en) * | 1972-04-10 | 1974-08-13 | Massachusetts Inst Technology | Digital filter to realize efficiently the filtering required when multiplying or dividing the sampling rate of a digital signal by a composite integer |
GB1371185A (en) | 1972-05-03 | 1974-10-23 | Gen Motors Corp | Vehicle crash recorders |
US3843843A (en) | 1972-10-30 | 1974-10-22 | Rca Corp | A time division multiple access synchronization technique |
US3894194A (en) * | 1973-02-16 | 1975-07-08 | Edward G Frost | Automatic mobile radio telephone system |
DE2308736C2 (en) | 1973-02-22 | 1982-04-08 | Robert Bosch Gmbh, 7000 Stuttgart | Device for transmitting data telegrams via a first radio channel and voice information via a second radio channel |
US3824543A (en) * | 1973-06-26 | 1974-07-16 | Bell Telephone Labor Inc | Digital data interchange circuit for a multiplexer/demultiplexer |
JPS5045508A (en) | 1973-08-01 | 1975-04-23 | ||
DE2340136C1 (en) | 1973-08-08 | 1978-04-27 | Siemens Ag | Radio transmission system |
US4051332A (en) * | 1973-08-20 | 1977-09-27 | Nippon Telegraph And Telephone Public Corporation | Multiplex digital echo suppression system |
CA1035476A (en) | 1973-11-13 | 1978-07-25 | Farinon Electric Of Canada Ltd. | Telephone subscriber distribution system |
DE2362855B2 (en) * | 1973-12-18 | 1977-12-01 | Kabel- und Metallwerke Gutehoffnungshütte AG, 3000 Hannover | METHOD FOR TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL SIGNALS |
US3922496A (en) * | 1974-02-11 | 1975-11-25 | Digital Communications Corp | TDMA satellite communications system with guard band obviating ongoing propagation delay calculation |
FR2275944A1 (en) * | 1974-06-21 | 1976-01-16 | Suchard Jean | MESSAGE TRANSMISSION SYSTEM BETWEEN SEVERAL STATIONS |
US3982241A (en) * | 1974-08-19 | 1976-09-21 | Digital Equipment Corporation | Self-zeroing analog-to-digital conversion system |
GB1526005A (en) | 1975-03-17 | 1978-09-27 | Ns Electronics | Multiplexing communication system |
JPS51144167A (en) * | 1975-06-04 | 1976-12-10 | Nec Corp | Digital phase modulation method |
JPS51144111A (en) * | 1975-06-05 | 1976-12-10 | Kokusai Denshin Denwa Co Ltd <Kdd> | Echo cancelling method |
US4054753A (en) * | 1975-10-20 | 1977-10-18 | Digital Communications Corporation | Double sync burst TDMA system |
US4121158A (en) * | 1975-10-24 | 1978-10-17 | Siemens Aktiengesellschaft | Radio system |
US4048443A (en) * | 1975-12-12 | 1977-09-13 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Digital speech communication system for minimizing quantizing noise |
US4129749A (en) * | 1976-06-24 | 1978-12-12 | Goldman Stephen R | Radio telephone communications system |
GB1584622A (en) | 1976-08-02 | 1981-02-18 | Motorola Inc | Multichannel communication device with manual and automatic scanning electronic channel selection |
US4058713A (en) * | 1976-09-20 | 1977-11-15 | General Signal Corporation | Equalization by adaptive processing operating in the frequency domain |
US4398062A (en) * | 1976-11-11 | 1983-08-09 | Harris Corporation | Apparatus for privacy transmission in system having bandwidth constraint |
IT1071840B (en) * | 1976-11-12 | 1985-04-10 | Olivetti & Co Spa | MULTIPROCESSOR SYSTEM FOR AUTOMATIC SWITCHING OF TELEGRAPHIC LINES AND METHOD OF TRANSFER OF INFORMATION CHARACTERS |
DE2659596C2 (en) | 1976-12-30 | 1978-07-20 | Siemens Ag, 1000 Berlin Und 8000 Muenchen | Radio switching system between radio stations and telephone subscribers |
DE2659635B2 (en) | 1976-12-30 | 1979-06-13 | Siemens Ag, 1000 Berlin Und 8000 Muenchen | Method for digital information transmission via radio |
US4112372A (en) * | 1977-01-11 | 1978-09-05 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Spread spectrum communication system |
US4222114A (en) * | 1977-01-27 | 1980-09-09 | The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Navy | Cylindrical array radiator |
US4128740A (en) | 1977-02-14 | 1978-12-05 | Motorola, Inc. | Antenna array for a cellular RF communications system |
DE2715332C2 (en) * | 1977-04-06 | 1985-08-01 | Standard Elektrik Lorenz Ag, 7000 Stuttgart | System for the wireless transmission of digital information |
US4100377A (en) * | 1977-04-28 | 1978-07-11 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Packet transmission of speech |
US4154980A (en) | 1977-08-29 | 1979-05-15 | Motorola, Inc. | Noise blanker with variable rate-shut-off and/or variable blanking threshold level |
US4229822A (en) * | 1977-09-06 | 1980-10-21 | Motorola, Inc. | Data detector for a data communication system |
US4397019A (en) * | 1977-10-13 | 1983-08-02 | Ibm Corporation | TDMA Intertransponder communication |
US4302530A (en) | 1977-12-08 | 1981-11-24 | University Of Pennsylvania | Method for making substance-sensitive electrical structures by processing substance-sensitive photoresist material |
FR2412987A1 (en) * | 1977-12-23 | 1979-07-20 | Ibm France | PROCESS FOR COMPRESSION OF DATA RELATING TO THE VOICE SIGNAL AND DEVICE IMPLEMENTING THIS PROCEDURE |
EP0003633B2 (en) * | 1978-02-13 | 1986-05-21 | Motorola, Inc. | A method of and an apparatus for a radiotelephone communications system |
US4222115A (en) * | 1978-03-13 | 1980-09-09 | Purdue Research Foundation | Spread spectrum apparatus for cellular mobile communication systems |
DE2812009C2 (en) * | 1978-03-18 | 1984-08-02 | Standard Elektrik Lorenz Ag, 7000 Stuttgart | Messaging system |
US4236254A (en) * | 1978-03-27 | 1980-11-25 | Motorola, Inc. | Radio receiver blanker inhibit circuit |
JPS54158810A (en) | 1978-06-06 | 1979-12-15 | Nec Corp | Time-division multidirectional multiplex communication system |
JPS5523603A (en) * | 1978-06-22 | 1980-02-20 | Nec Corp | Method and apparatus for coding and decoding of telephone signal |
US4171467A (en) * | 1978-07-20 | 1979-10-16 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Signal multiplexing circuit |
US4357700A (en) * | 1978-08-10 | 1982-11-02 | International Business Machines Corp. | Adaptive error encoding in multiple access systems |
US4301530A (en) * | 1978-12-18 | 1981-11-17 | The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Army | Orthogonal spread spectrum time division multiple accessing mobile subscriber access system |
US4215244A (en) * | 1978-12-18 | 1980-07-29 | The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Army | Self-adaptive mobile subscriber access system employing time division multiple accessing |
US4220819A (en) * | 1979-03-30 | 1980-09-02 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Residual excited predictive speech coding system |
CA1176336A (en) | 1979-04-23 | 1984-10-16 | Motorola, Inc. | Noise blanker which tracks average noise level |
EP0018702A1 (en) | 1979-04-30 | 1980-11-12 | Motorola, Inc. | Improvements in and relating to noise blanking circuitry in a radio receiver |
GB2052216B (en) | 1979-06-08 | 1983-09-21 | Plessey Co Ltd | Duplex transceivers |
GB2063011B (en) * | 1979-11-09 | 1983-10-12 | Philips Electronic Associated | Information transmission system |
DE2950339C2 (en) | 1979-12-14 | 1984-06-07 | ANT Nachrichtentechnik GmbH, 7150 Backnang | Method and arrangement for digital control of the carrier phase in receivers of data transmission systems |
NL190093C (en) * | 1979-12-17 | 1993-10-18 | Victor Company Of Japan | COMPRESSING AND EXPANDING SYSTEM. |
JPS56116341A (en) * | 1980-02-19 | 1981-09-12 | Nec Corp | Radio channel switching system in communication |
EP0035230B1 (en) | 1980-02-29 | 1985-06-12 | International Business Machines Corporation | Time division multiple access broadcasting, multipoint, and conferencing communication apparatus and method |
US4418409A (en) * | 1980-03-07 | 1983-11-29 | Ibm Corporation | Byte data activity compression |
DE3009309C2 (en) | 1980-03-11 | 1982-06-24 | Siemens AG, 1000 Berlin und 8000 München | Mobile radio network |
US4354057A (en) * | 1980-04-08 | 1982-10-12 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Predictive signal coding with partitioned quantization |
US4488144A (en) * | 1980-05-01 | 1984-12-11 | Analogic Corporation | High linearity digital to analog converter |
NZ197059A (en) * | 1980-05-23 | 1983-11-30 | Post Office | Nationwide radiopaging:selective zone transmissions |
US4365338A (en) * | 1980-06-27 | 1982-12-21 | Harris Corporation | Technique for high rate digital transmission over a dynamic dispersive channel |
DE3036739A1 (en) | 1980-09-29 | 1982-06-03 | Siemens AG, 1000 Berlin und 8000 München | TELEPHONE MOBILE RADIO SYSTEM FOR DIGITAL VOICE TRANSFER |
DE3036655A1 (en) | 1980-09-29 | 1982-05-13 | Siemens AG, 1000 Berlin und 8000 München | METHOD FOR DETECTING DIGITAL INFORMATION IN DIGITAL INFORMATION TRANSFER, IN PARTICULAR INFORMATION TRANSFER IN MOBILE RADIO COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS |
US4363002A (en) * | 1980-11-13 | 1982-12-07 | Fuller Robert M | Clock recovery apparatus for phase shift keyed encoded data |
IT1130545B (en) * | 1980-12-03 | 1986-06-18 | Cselt Centro Studi Lab Telecom | PROCEDURE AND SYSTEM FOR ACCESS TO A SATELLITE FOR TELECOMMUNICATIONS WITH COMMUNICATION ON BOARD |
CA1180472A (en) * | 1981-01-12 | 1985-01-02 | Masaaki Atobe | Circuit for eliminating spurious components resulting from burst control in a tdma system |
FR2502423A1 (en) | 1981-03-17 | 1982-09-24 | Thomson Brandt | DIGITAL DEMODULATOR OF SIGNALS AND TELEVISION SYSTEM COMPRISING SUCH A DEMODULATOR |
FR2502426A1 (en) | 1981-03-20 | 1982-09-24 | Trt Telecom Radio Electr | SYSTEM FOR TRANSMITTING INFORMATION BETWEEN A MAIN STATION AND SECONDARY STATIONS OPERATING IN ACCORDANCE WITH A TDMA METHOD |
JPS57173232A (en) * | 1981-04-17 | 1982-10-25 | Hitachi Ltd | Automatic equalizer |
US4411007A (en) | 1981-04-29 | 1983-10-18 | The Manitoba Telephone System | Distributed network synchronization system |
DE3265045D1 (en) * | 1981-05-07 | 1985-09-05 | Int Standard Electric Corp | Message transmission system |
DE3118018A1 (en) * | 1981-05-07 | 1982-11-25 | Standard Elektrik Lorenz Ag, 7000 Stuttgart | Communications system |
JPS57201351A (en) | 1981-06-03 | 1982-12-09 | Nec Corp | Digital burst signal communicating system |
US4414661A (en) * | 1981-07-02 | 1983-11-08 | Trancom Ab | Apparatus for communicating with a fleet of vehicles |
DE3130176A1 (en) | 1981-07-30 | 1983-02-17 | Siemens AG, 1000 Berlin und 8000 München | Method for dynamic time slot allocation of the organisation channel of cellular mobile radio networks depending on traffic volume |
US4418425A (en) * | 1981-08-31 | 1983-11-29 | Ibm Corporation | Encryption using destination addresses in a TDMA satellite communications network |
JPS5854740A (en) | 1981-09-28 | 1983-03-31 | Nec Corp | Frequency synthesizer |
JPS5921039B2 (en) | 1981-11-04 | 1984-05-17 | 日本電信電話株式会社 | Adaptive predictive coding method |
JPS5881349U (en) | 1981-11-30 | 1983-06-02 | いすゞ自動車株式会社 | Polymerized seal ring |
USRE32580E (en) | 1981-12-01 | 1988-01-19 | American Telephone And Telegraph Company, At&T Bell Laboratories | Digital speech coder |
US4472832A (en) | 1981-12-01 | 1984-09-18 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Digital speech coder |
US4439756A (en) | 1982-01-20 | 1984-03-27 | International Telephone And Telegraph Corporation | Delta-Sigma modulator with switch capacitor implementation |
JPS58141059A (en) | 1982-02-15 | 1983-08-22 | Nec Corp | Multilevel digital radio communication system |
US4466129A (en) | 1982-05-06 | 1984-08-14 | Motorola, Inc. | Noise reducing circuitry for single sideband receivers |
CA1191905A (en) | 1982-06-30 | 1985-08-13 | Canadian Patents And Development Limited/Societe Canadienne Des Brevets Et D'exploitation Limitee | Spread spectrum modem |
DE3224922A1 (en) * | 1982-07-03 | 1984-01-05 | Standard Elektrik Lorenz Ag, 7000 Stuttgart | Communication system |
US4651104A (en) | 1982-07-07 | 1987-03-17 | Fujitsu Limited | Frequency converter with automatic frequency control |
US4489413A (en) | 1982-07-19 | 1984-12-18 | M/A-Com Dcc, Inc. | Apparatus for controlling the receive and transmit frequency of a transceiver |
US4462108A (en) * | 1982-08-02 | 1984-07-24 | Trw Inc. | Modem signal acquisition technique |
GB2125653B (en) | 1982-08-04 | 1986-08-13 | Plessey Co Plc | Improved time slot arrangements for local area network systems |
US4500912A (en) | 1982-08-04 | 1985-02-19 | Rca Corporation | FIR Chrominance bandpass sampled data filter with internal decimation |
GB2125654B (en) | 1982-08-13 | 1986-01-29 | Hazeltine Corp | Intranetwork code division multiple access communication system |
US4630314A (en) | 1982-09-27 | 1986-12-16 | Meteor Communications Corporation, Inc. | Meteor burst communication system |
US4550443A (en) * | 1982-11-12 | 1985-10-29 | Motorola, Inc. | Method and apparatus for dynamically selecting transmitters for communications between a primary station and remote stations of a data communications system |
US4625308A (en) | 1982-11-30 | 1986-11-25 | American Satellite Company | All digital IDMA dynamic channel allocated satellite communications system and method |
DE3245344C2 (en) | 1982-12-08 | 1986-07-17 | ANT Nachrichtentechnik GmbH, 7150 Backnang | Circuit arrangement for a receiver for data transmission by means of four-stage phase shift keying |
US4476575A (en) * | 1982-12-13 | 1984-10-09 | General Electric Company | Radio transceiver |
JPS59117838A (en) | 1982-12-24 | 1984-07-07 | Sony Corp | Marker signal detecting circuit |
US4562572A (en) * | 1983-01-11 | 1985-12-31 | International Telephone And Telegraph Corporation | Cellular mobile radio service telephone system |
JPS59181734A (en) | 1983-03-30 | 1984-10-16 | Nec Corp | Radio telephone system |
GB2138652B (en) | 1983-04-23 | 1986-04-23 | Standard Telephones Cables Ltd | Distributed pabx |
US4513412A (en) * | 1983-04-25 | 1985-04-23 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Time division adaptive retransmission technique for portable radio telephones |
US4800574A (en) | 1983-05-10 | 1989-01-24 | Ricoh Company, Ltd. | Digital modulator/demodulator including non-linear analog-to-digital converter and circuitry compensating for the non-linearity of the converter |
US4531235A (en) * | 1983-06-20 | 1985-07-23 | Motorola, Inc. | Diversity signal strength indicator and site selection apparatus for using same |
JPS6027241A (en) | 1983-07-25 | 1985-02-12 | Nec Corp | Battery saving system of radio relay system |
GB2144310A (en) * | 1983-08-01 | 1985-02-27 | Philips Electronic Associated | Multiple-access communications system |
DE3332220C1 (en) | 1983-09-07 | 1985-02-28 | Rohde & Schwarz GmbH & Co KG, 8000 München | Time-compressing time-division multiplex transmission system |
DE3375351D1 (en) | 1983-10-21 | 1988-02-18 | Ant Nachrichtentech | Process for the transmission of information services by satellites |
GB2151436A (en) | 1983-12-09 | 1985-07-17 | Philips Electronic Associated | Duplex speech transmission method and a system therefor |
US4599490A (en) * | 1983-12-19 | 1986-07-08 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Control of telecommunication switching systems |
US4630267A (en) | 1983-12-23 | 1986-12-16 | International Business Machines Corporation | Programmable timing and synchronization circuit for a TDMA communications controller |
US4550424A (en) * | 1984-02-09 | 1985-10-29 | National Semiconductor Corporation | PM Decoder sample and hold circuit |
CH672384A5 (en) | 1984-03-07 | 1989-11-15 | Autophon Ascom Ag | |
US4613974A (en) | 1984-03-16 | 1986-09-23 | Vokac Peter R | Method and system for modulating a carrier signal |
US4709390A (en) | 1984-05-04 | 1987-11-24 | American Telephone And Telegraph Company, At&T Bell Laboratories | Speech message code modifying arrangement |
DE3417233A1 (en) * | 1984-05-10 | 1985-11-14 | Standard Elektrik Lorenz Ag, 7000 Stuttgart | Radio communications system |
US4608711A (en) * | 1984-06-21 | 1986-08-26 | Itt Corporation | Cellular mobile radio hand-off utilizing voice channel |
US4613990A (en) * | 1984-06-25 | 1986-09-23 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Radiotelephone transmission power control |
DE3423640A1 (en) | 1984-06-27 | 1986-01-09 | Standard Elektrik Lorenz Ag, 7000 Stuttgart | RADIO SYSTEM |
DE3423780C2 (en) | 1984-06-28 | 1994-05-19 | Aeg Mobile Communication | Simplex radio system |
DE3483476D1 (en) * | 1984-08-08 | 1990-11-29 | Toshiba Kawasaki Kk | INFORMATION MEDIUM. |
US4622680A (en) | 1984-10-17 | 1986-11-11 | General Electric Company | Hybrid subband coder/decoder method and apparatus |
US5051991A (en) | 1984-10-17 | 1991-09-24 | Ericsson Ge Mobile Communications Inc. | Method and apparatus for efficient digital time delay compensation in compressed bandwidth signal processing |
US4771425A (en) * | 1984-10-29 | 1988-09-13 | Stratacom, Inc. | Synchoronous packet voice/data communication system |
IT1179803B (en) | 1984-10-30 | 1987-09-16 | Cselt Centro Studi Lab Telecom | METHOD AND DEVICE FOR THE CORRECTION OF ERRORS CAUSED BY IMPULSIVE NOISE ON VOICE SIGNALS CODED WITH LOW SPEED BETWEEN CI AND TRANSMITTED ON RADIO COMMUNICATION CHANNELS |
WO1986002726A1 (en) * | 1984-11-01 | 1986-05-09 | M/A-Com Government Systems, Inc. | Relp vocoder implemented in digital signal processors |
DE3443974A1 (en) | 1984-12-01 | 1986-06-05 | Robert Bosch Gmbh, 7000 Stuttgart | METHOD FOR TRANSMITTING DIGITAL INFORMATION IN A RADIO TELEPHONE NETWORK |
DE3502942A1 (en) * | 1985-01-30 | 1986-07-31 | ANT Nachrichtentechnik GmbH, 7150 Backnang | DIGITAL MOBILE RADIO SYSTEM |
DE3527330A1 (en) * | 1985-07-31 | 1987-02-05 | Philips Patentverwaltung | DIGITAL RADIO TRANSMISSION SYSTEM WITH CONNECTING ORGANIZATION CHANNEL IN THE TIME MULTIPLEX FRAME |
JPH0138802Y2 (en) | 1985-08-20 | 1989-11-20 | ||
US4755994A (en) | 1985-09-06 | 1988-07-05 | Republic Telcom Systems Corporation | Capacity expander for telephone line |
GB8609499D0 (en) | 1986-04-18 | 1986-05-21 | Gen Electric Co Plc | Digital transmission system |
FR2599202A1 (en) | 1986-05-23 | 1987-11-27 | Girard Patrick | Method and system of communication with several sets functioning as transmitter and as receiver operating on a single frequency |
US4864566A (en) * | 1986-09-26 | 1989-09-05 | Cycomm Corporation | Precise multiplexed transmission and reception of analog and digital data through a narrow-band channel |
US4777633A (en) * | 1987-08-14 | 1988-10-11 | International Mobile Machines Corp. | Base station for wireless digital telephone system |
US4785450B1 (en) | 1987-08-06 | 1999-10-12 | Interdigital Tech Corp | Apparatus and method for obtaining frequency agility in digital communication system |
DE3736020A1 (en) | 1987-10-23 | 1989-05-03 | Bosch Gmbh Robert | RADIO NETWORK |
US4882770A (en) | 1987-12-14 | 1989-11-21 | H. M. Electronics, Inc. | Wireless optical communication system |
FR2630277B1 (en) | 1988-04-15 | 1992-10-16 | Thomson Csf | BLOCK INFORMATION CODING AND DECODING METHOD, AND CODING AND DECODING DEVICES FOR CARRYING OUT SAID METHOD |
SE8802229D0 (en) | 1988-06-14 | 1988-06-14 | Ericsson Telefon Ab L M | MOBILE RADIO STATION PROCEDURE |
US4914649A (en) * | 1988-09-12 | 1990-04-03 | Motorola, Inc. | Multiple frequency message system |
US4967407A (en) * | 1989-01-23 | 1990-10-30 | Motorola, Inc. | Continuous transmission mode radio with control information monitoring capability |
US4974099A (en) | 1989-06-21 | 1990-11-27 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Communication signal compression system and method |
US5355516A (en) * | 1990-09-28 | 1994-10-11 | Motorola, Inc. | Method for reducing superfluous channel allocation in a cellular radiotelephone communication system |
GB2249918A (en) | 1990-11-14 | 1992-05-20 | Philips Electronic Associated | Channel scanning in tdd cordless telephone system |
DE4107660C2 (en) | 1991-03-09 | 1995-05-04 | Bosch Gmbh Robert | Process for mounting silicon wafers on metallic mounting surfaces |
US5608429A (en) | 1993-08-02 | 1997-03-04 | Nippon Kayaku Kabushiki Kaisha | Laser marking method, laser marking composition and articles having color developing layer made of said composition |
US5539730A (en) * | 1994-01-11 | 1996-07-23 | Ericsson Ge Mobile Communications Inc. | TDMA/FDMA/CDMA hybrid radio access methods |
US6404751B1 (en) * | 1998-09-15 | 2002-06-11 | Crisco Technology, Inc. | Common control channel dynamic frequency assignment method and protocol |
-
1985
- 1985-03-20 US US06/713,925 patent/US4675863A/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1985-09-20 DK DK426985A patent/DK171304B1/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1985-09-23 AU AU47679/85A patent/AU576627B2/en not_active Expired
- 1985-10-09 IL IL76618A patent/IL76618A/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1985-10-09 SE SE8504662A patent/SE506944C2/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1985-10-15 IN IN855/DEL/85A patent/IN165724B/en unknown
- 1985-10-16 GB GB8525464A patent/GB2174571C/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1985-10-23 CA CA000493609A patent/CA1250673A/en not_active Expired
- 1985-10-30 ES ES548366A patent/ES8707831A1/en not_active Expired
- 1985-11-04 IE IE2731/85A patent/IE56780B1/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1985-11-07 BR BR8505598A patent/BR8505598A/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1985-11-11 KR KR1019850008416A patent/KR900007130B1/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1985-11-18 NO NO854603A patent/NO854603L/en unknown
- 1985-12-10 NL NL8503400A patent/NL195021C/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1985-12-30 FI FI855175A patent/FI81940B/en not_active Application Discontinuation
-
1986
- 1986-01-14 FR FR868600440A patent/FR2579391B1/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1986-01-16 CH CH159/86A patent/CH675333A5/fr not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1986-01-20 BE BE0/216151A patent/BE904065A/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1986-02-13 CN CN86100949A patent/CN1008962B/en not_active Expired
- 1986-02-26 JP JP61039331A patent/JP2816349B2/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1986-03-17 IT IT47781/86A patent/IT1191300B/en active
- 1986-03-19 AT AT0073186A patent/AT404202B/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1986-03-20 DE DE3645360A patent/DE3645360C2/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1986-03-20 DE DE3645383A patent/DE3645383B4/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1986-03-20 DE DE3609395A patent/DE3609395C3/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1986-03-20 MX MX1939A patent/MX162175A/en unknown
- 1986-03-20 DE DE3645394A patent/DE3645394B4/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
-
1987
- 1987-02-20 MY MYPI87000086A patent/MY100722A/en unknown
- 1987-03-27 US US07031045 patent/US4817089B1/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
-
1988
- 1988-10-14 MY MYPI88001152A patent/MY102335A/en unknown
- 1988-11-04 AU AU24710/88A patent/AU595139B2/en not_active Expired
-
1989
- 1989-03-16 US US07/324,651 patent/US4912705A/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1989-05-08 US US07349301 patent/US5022024B1/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1989-09-20 SG SG64989A patent/SG64989G/en unknown
- 1989-11-20 US US07/439,100 patent/US5121391A/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
-
1990
- 1990-01-04 HK HK3/90A patent/HK390A/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1990-12-27 US US07/634,770 patent/US5119375A/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
-
1993
- 1993-04-22 US US08/051,762 patent/US5687194A/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1993-04-22 US US08/052,013 patent/US5657358A/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
-
1994
- 1994-06-20 NO NO942346A patent/NO304090B1/en unknown
- 1994-12-29 NO NO945085A patent/NO308879B1/en unknown
-
1995
- 1995-11-27 DK DK199501337A patent/DK174058B1/en not_active IP Right Cessation
-
1996
- 1996-09-16 FI FI963647A patent/FI104676B/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 1996-10-02 US US08/724,930 patent/US5734678A/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
-
1997
- 1997-07-11 JP JP9236592A patent/JP2979064B2/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1997-09-09 US US08/926,405 patent/US6014374A/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 1997-12-18 SE SE9704730A patent/SE521707C2/en not_active IP Right Cessation
-
1999
- 1999-02-05 JP JP06535599A patent/JP3186733B2/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1999-11-04 US US09/433,430 patent/US6282180B1/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
-
2000
- 2000-05-15 JP JP2000142479A patent/JP4059419B2/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
-
2001
- 2001-08-06 US US09/923,171 patent/US6393002B1/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2001-08-15 JP JP2001246767A patent/JP2002204483A/en active Pending
-
2002
- 2002-02-12 DK DK200200209A patent/DK175353B1/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 2002-04-25 US US10/132,670 patent/US6842440B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2002-05-14 US US10/145,551 patent/US6954470B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
-
2003
- 2003-01-15 JP JP2003007452A patent/JP2003244756A/en active Pending
- 2003-02-26 US US10/374,208 patent/US6771667B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2003-02-27 DK DK200300306A patent/DK176157B1/en not_active IP Right Cessation
- 2003-06-30 SE SE0301915A patent/SE524940C2/en not_active IP Right Cessation
-
2004
- 2004-08-20 US US10/922,427 patent/US20050018636A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2004-08-20 US US10/923,285 patent/US20050025094A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2004-08-20 US US10/922,361 patent/US20050025101A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2004-08-24 US US10/925,027 patent/US20050025097A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2004-09-16 SE SE0402229A patent/SE526967C2/en not_active IP Right Cessation
Patent Citations (101)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US2070418A (en) * | 1933-05-19 | 1937-02-09 | Rca Corp | Multiplex cable code telegraphy with diversity reception |
US2941038A (en) * | 1953-10-26 | 1960-06-14 | Iwatsu Electric Co Ltd | Multiplex telephone system |
US3230458A (en) * | 1962-05-18 | 1966-01-18 | Collins Radio Co | Automatic gain control circuit with fast change of time constant |
US3497627A (en) * | 1966-04-15 | 1970-02-24 | Ibm | Rate conversion system |
US3499995A (en) * | 1966-06-22 | 1970-03-10 | British Telecommunications Res | Frequency and time division multiplex signalling systems using successive changes of frequency band and time slot |
US3576398A (en) * | 1966-07-26 | 1971-04-27 | Int Standard Electric Corp | Path hunting circuit in a telephone network with a centralized control unit |
US3742495A (en) * | 1966-11-07 | 1973-06-26 | Goodyear Aerospace Corp | Drone guidance system and method |
US3505479A (en) * | 1967-12-21 | 1970-04-07 | Us Army | Multiplex system with number of channels controlled according to signal-to-noise ratio |
US3564147A (en) * | 1968-04-05 | 1971-02-16 | Communications Satellite Corp | Local routing channel sharing system and method for communications via a satellite relay |
US3643031A (en) * | 1968-09-16 | 1972-02-15 | Kokusai Denshin Denwa Co Ltd | Time division multiplexing communication system |
US3641274A (en) * | 1968-10-11 | 1972-02-08 | Kokusai Denshin Denwa Co Ltd | Synchronization system for communication information in pcm time division multiple access communication system |
US3639739A (en) * | 1969-02-05 | 1972-02-01 | North American Rockwell | Digital low pass filter |
US3573379A (en) * | 1969-03-03 | 1971-04-06 | Bendix Corp | Communications system with frequency and time division techniques |
US3644678A (en) * | 1969-03-21 | 1972-02-22 | Communications Satellite Corp | Channel reallocation system and method |
US3634627A (en) * | 1969-07-23 | 1972-01-11 | Sits Soc It Telecom Siemens | Channel-allocation system for a channel-addressing multiple-access telecommunication system |
US3654395A (en) * | 1969-10-15 | 1972-04-04 | Communications Satellite Corp | Synchronization of tdma space division satellite system |
US3710027A (en) * | 1969-11-22 | 1973-01-09 | Int Standard Electric Corp | System of time-division multiplex transmission via communications satellites |
US3740476A (en) * | 1971-07-09 | 1973-06-19 | Bell Telephone Labor Inc | Speech signal pitch detector using prediction error data |
US3806879A (en) * | 1971-08-11 | 1974-04-23 | Communications Satellite Corp | Tdma satellite communication system with multi-pcm frames per tdma frame |
US3812430A (en) * | 1971-08-11 | 1974-05-21 | Communications Satellite Corp | Tdma satellite communications system with improved acquisition |
US3818453A (en) * | 1971-08-11 | 1974-06-18 | Communications Satellite Corp | Tdma satellite communications system |
US3889063A (en) * | 1971-08-19 | 1975-06-10 | Phonplex Corp | Multiplexed digital data communication system |
US3864524A (en) * | 1971-10-30 | 1975-02-04 | Electronic Communications | Asynchronous multiplexing of digitized speech |
US4013840A (en) * | 1972-05-15 | 1977-03-22 | Teleplex, Inc. | Tdm and fdm telephone communication |
US3891959A (en) * | 1972-12-29 | 1975-06-24 | Fujitsu Ltd | Coding system for differential phase modulation |
US3820112A (en) * | 1973-10-01 | 1974-06-25 | A Roth | High speed analog-to-digital conversion system |
US4031330A (en) * | 1974-06-10 | 1977-06-21 | U.S. Philips Corporation | Digital radio transmission system |
US4071711A (en) * | 1974-08-02 | 1978-01-31 | Farinon Electric Of Canada Ltd. | Telephone subscriber distribution system |
US3932821A (en) * | 1974-11-08 | 1976-01-13 | Narco Scientific Industries, Inc. | Out of lock detector for phase lock loop synthesizer |
US4009345A (en) * | 1974-12-30 | 1977-02-22 | International Business Machines Corporation | External management of satellite linked exchange network |
US4009344A (en) * | 1974-12-30 | 1977-02-22 | International Business Machines Corporation | Inter-related switching, activity compression and demand assignment |
US4009343A (en) * | 1974-12-30 | 1977-02-22 | International Business Machines Corporation | Switching and activity compression between telephone lines and digital communication channels |
US4009347A (en) * | 1974-12-30 | 1977-02-22 | International Business Machines Corporation | Modular branch exchange and nodal access units for multiple access systems |
US3959595A (en) * | 1975-01-09 | 1976-05-25 | Sperry Rand Corporation | Digital signal multiplexer/concentrator |
US4027243A (en) * | 1975-05-12 | 1977-05-31 | General Electric Company | Message generator for a controlled radio transmitter and receiver |
US4079371A (en) * | 1975-05-24 | 1978-03-14 | Nippon Electric Company, Ltd. | Rate converter for digital signals having a negative feedback phase lock loop |
US4086536A (en) * | 1975-06-24 | 1978-04-25 | Honeywell Inc. | Single sideband transmitter apparatus |
US4004226A (en) * | 1975-07-23 | 1977-01-18 | Codex Corporation | QAM receiver having automatic adaptive equalizer |
US4020332A (en) * | 1975-09-24 | 1977-04-26 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Interpolation-decimation circuit for increasing or decreasing digital sampling frequency |
US4020461A (en) * | 1975-11-18 | 1977-04-26 | Trw Inc. | Method of and apparatus for transmitting and receiving coded digital signals |
US4021616A (en) * | 1976-01-08 | 1977-05-03 | Ncr Corporation | Interpolating rate multiplier |
US4335446A (en) * | 1977-05-02 | 1982-06-15 | Cselt - Centro Studi E Laboratori Telecomunicazioni S.P.A. | Terminal equipment for data-transmission network including digitally operating modem |
US4143246A (en) * | 1977-09-06 | 1979-03-06 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Time division line interface circuit |
US4193031A (en) * | 1978-03-13 | 1980-03-11 | Purdue Research Foundation | Method of signal transmission and reception utilizing wideband signals |
US4133976A (en) * | 1978-04-07 | 1979-01-09 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Predictive speech signal coding with reduced noise effects |
US4208632A (en) * | 1978-06-30 | 1980-06-17 | Raytheon Company | Radar receiver |
US4184049A (en) * | 1978-08-25 | 1980-01-15 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Transform speech signal coding with pitch controlled adaptive quantizing |
US4272845A (en) * | 1978-10-18 | 1981-06-09 | Societa Italiana Telecomunicazion Siemens Spa | Receiver for data-transmission system operating with single-sideband amplitude modulation |
US4251865A (en) * | 1978-12-08 | 1981-02-17 | Motorola, Inc. | Polling system for a duplex communications link |
US4256925A (en) * | 1978-12-12 | 1981-03-17 | Satellite Business Systems | Capacity reallocation method and apparatus for a TDMA satellite communication network with demand assignment of channels |
US4253188A (en) * | 1979-06-07 | 1981-02-24 | Ford Motor Company | Clock synchronization for data communication receiver |
US4309764A (en) * | 1979-06-22 | 1982-01-05 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Technique for increasing the rain margin of a satellite communication system |
US4445213A (en) * | 1979-07-31 | 1984-04-24 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Communication line interface for controlling data information having differing transmission characteristics |
US4389722A (en) * | 1979-09-13 | 1983-06-21 | Licentia Patent-Verwaltungs-Gmbh | Method for the simultaneous transmission of a plurality of data stream over one transmission channel |
US4507781A (en) * | 1980-03-14 | 1985-03-26 | Ibm Corporation | Time domain multiple access broadcasting, multipoint, and conferencing communication apparatus and method |
US4320517A (en) * | 1980-03-19 | 1982-03-16 | International Business Machines Corp. | Method and device for effecting the initial adjustment of the clock in a synchronous data receiver |
US4328585A (en) * | 1980-04-02 | 1982-05-04 | Signatron, Inc. | Fast adapting fading channel equalizer |
US4843612A (en) * | 1980-06-23 | 1989-06-27 | Siemens Aktiengesellschaft | Method for jam-resistant communication transmission |
US4503510A (en) * | 1980-10-31 | 1985-03-05 | Sri International | Method and apparatus for digital data compression |
US4443661A (en) * | 1980-10-31 | 1984-04-17 | Nippon Electric Co., Ltd. | Method of detecting troubles in a receiver for a common control channel of a mobile radio telephone communication system and a system therefor |
US4430743A (en) * | 1980-11-17 | 1984-02-07 | Nippon Electric Co., Ltd. | Fast start-up system for transversal equalizers |
US4377860A (en) * | 1981-01-05 | 1983-03-22 | American Microsystems, Inc. | Bandwidth reduction method and structure for combining voice and data in a PCM channel |
US4425639A (en) * | 1981-01-12 | 1984-01-10 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Satellite communications system with frequency channelized beams |
US4437183A (en) * | 1981-01-12 | 1984-03-13 | General Datacomm Industries, Inc. | Method and apparatus for distributing control signals |
US4525835A (en) * | 1981-10-13 | 1985-06-25 | International Standard Electric Corporation | Duplex radio system utilizing time compression expansion |
US4495619A (en) * | 1981-10-23 | 1985-01-22 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Transmitter and receivers using resource sharing and coding for increased capacity |
US4449250A (en) * | 1981-12-21 | 1984-05-15 | Motorola, Inc. | Radio-frequency synthesizer for duplex radios |
US4455649A (en) * | 1982-01-15 | 1984-06-19 | International Business Machines Corporation | Method and apparatus for efficient statistical multiplexing of voice and data signals |
US4437087A (en) * | 1982-01-27 | 1984-03-13 | Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated | Adaptive differential PCM coding |
US4597105A (en) * | 1982-11-12 | 1986-06-24 | Motorola Inc. | Data communications system having overlapping receiver coverage zones |
US4584693A (en) * | 1982-11-23 | 1986-04-22 | Compagnie Industrielle Des Telecommunications Cit-Alcatel | QPSK system with one cycle per Baud period |
US4587662A (en) * | 1983-01-28 | 1986-05-06 | International Standard Electric Corporation | TDMA spread-spectrum receiver with coherent detection |
US4637036A (en) * | 1983-05-20 | 1987-01-13 | Victor Company Of Japan, Limited | Circuit arrangement for a data acquisition circuit of a PCM processor and a method for improving waveform of PCM signal eye pattern |
US4519073A (en) * | 1983-06-20 | 1985-05-21 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Bit compression multiplexer |
US4567591A (en) * | 1983-08-01 | 1986-01-28 | Gray James S | Digital audio satellite transmission system |
US4642806A (en) * | 1983-09-07 | 1987-02-10 | British Telecommunications Public Limited Company | Communications network having a single node and a plurality of outstations |
US4510595A (en) * | 1983-10-03 | 1985-04-09 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Modified time-division transmission technique for digital mobile radio systems |
US4578815A (en) * | 1983-12-07 | 1986-03-25 | Motorola, Inc. | Wide area coverage radio communication system and method |
US4638479A (en) * | 1983-12-09 | 1987-01-20 | U.S. Philips Corporation | Method of two-way radiocommunication between fixed stations and mobile stations |
US4644535A (en) * | 1984-04-26 | 1987-02-17 | Data General Corp. | PCM channel multiplexer/demultiplexer |
US4644534A (en) * | 1984-07-03 | 1987-02-17 | Ant Nachrichtentechnik Gmbh | TDMA point-to-multipoint communications system and its use |
US4742550A (en) * | 1984-09-17 | 1988-05-03 | Motorola, Inc. | 4800 BPS interoperable relp system |
US4639914A (en) * | 1984-12-06 | 1987-01-27 | At&T Bell Laboratories | Wireless PBX/LAN system with optimum combining |
US4817089A (en) * | 1985-03-20 | 1989-03-28 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US4817089B1 (en) * | 1985-03-20 | 2000-02-01 | Titan Corp | Subscriber rf telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of rf channels |
US5022024B1 (en) * | 1985-03-20 | 1999-06-22 | Interdigital Tech Corp | Subscriber rf telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a signal or a plurality of rf channels |
US5121391A (en) * | 1985-03-20 | 1992-06-09 | International Mobile Machines | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data singals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US4912705A (en) * | 1985-03-20 | 1990-03-27 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US4675863A (en) * | 1985-03-20 | 1987-06-23 | International Mobile Machines Corp. | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US5119375A (en) * | 1985-03-20 | 1992-06-02 | International Mobile Machines Corp. | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US5022024A (en) * | 1985-03-20 | 1991-06-04 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels |
US4656653A (en) * | 1985-04-30 | 1987-04-07 | Nec Corporation | Cordless telephone apparatus having means for synchronizing channel scanning of fixed and portable units |
US4754450A (en) * | 1986-03-25 | 1988-06-28 | Motorola, Inc. | TDM communication system for efficient spectrum utilization |
US4825448A (en) * | 1986-08-07 | 1989-04-25 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Subscriber unit for wireless digital telephone system |
US4893317A (en) * | 1986-08-07 | 1990-01-09 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Digital signals and frequency correction in a digital wireless system |
US4843621A (en) * | 1987-04-24 | 1989-06-27 | Motorola, Inc. | Speakerphone using digitally compressed audio to detect acoustic feedback |
US4741018A (en) * | 1987-04-24 | 1988-04-26 | Motorola, Inc. | Speakerphone using digitally compressed audio to control voice path gain |
US4797947A (en) * | 1987-05-01 | 1989-01-10 | Motorola, Inc. | Microcellular communications system using macrodiversity |
US4918746A (en) * | 1987-05-15 | 1990-04-17 | Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba | Communication system with mobile stations |
US4811420A (en) * | 1987-07-08 | 1989-03-07 | International Mobile Machines Corporation | Initialization of communication channel between a subsciber station and a base station in a subscriber communication system |
US5124985A (en) * | 1988-12-13 | 1992-06-23 | Small Power Communication Systems Research Laboratories Co., Ltd. | Radiocommunication system using time-division digital frames |
Cited By (8)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20080045153A1 (en) * | 2006-06-05 | 2008-02-21 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for providing beamforming feedback in wireless communication systems |
US8542589B2 (en) | 2006-06-05 | 2013-09-24 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Method and apparatus for providing beamforming feedback in wireless communication systems |
US20080316978A1 (en) * | 2007-06-19 | 2008-12-25 | Levi Ronen | Transmit and receive transition accelerator |
US7826429B2 (en) * | 2007-06-19 | 2010-11-02 | Intel Corporation | Transmit and receive transition accelerator |
US20090171658A1 (en) * | 2007-12-26 | 2009-07-02 | Maor Margalit | Selection of speech encoding scheme in wireless communication terminals |
WO2009081398A3 (en) * | 2007-12-26 | 2010-03-11 | Marvell Israel (Misl) Ltd. | Selection of speech encoding scheme in wireless communication terminals |
US8972247B2 (en) | 2007-12-26 | 2015-03-03 | Marvell World Trade Ltd. | Selection of speech encoding scheme in wireless communication terminals |
WO2022256916A1 (en) * | 2021-06-07 | 2022-12-15 | Lakhani Abdul Karim | Full duplex wireless communication system with single master clock |
Also Published As
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US6842440B2 (en) | Subscriber RF telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of RF channels | |
CA1307064C (en) | Subscriber rf telephone system for providing multiple speech and/or data signals simultaneously over either a single or a plurality of rf channels |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
STCB | Information on status: application discontinuation |
Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION |